Home
        Operating Instructions - FTP Directory Listing
         Contents
1.                                                                                                                                                                        Unit  m   Lens type Zoom lens  Projection lens Model No  ET D75LE1 ET D75LE2   ET D75LE3   ET D75LE4   ET D75LE8   ET D75LE6  Throw ratio     1 4 1 8 1 1 8 2 8 1 2 8 4 6 1 4 6 7 4 1 7 3 13 8 1 0 9 1 1 1  Projection screen size Projection distance  L     Height   Min    Max    Min    Max    Min    Max    Min    Max    Min    Max    Min    Max   Diagonal  SP     sq  Width SW wy   an   aw   an   aw   an   aw   an   aw   an   aw   an  1 78  70   0 942 1 508 2 01   2 69   2 72   4 10   4 11   6 90   6 91   11 06   10 78   20 56   1 35   1 62  2 03  80   1 077 1 723 2 31   3 09   3 12   4 70   4 71   7 90   7 91   12 66   12 37   23 55   1 55   1 86  2 29  90   1 212 1 939 2 61   3 49   3 52   5 30   5 31   8 91   8 91   14 25   13 97   26 54   1 76   2 10  2 54  100   1 346 2 154 2 91   3 89   3 92   5 90   5 91   9 91   9 91   15 85   15 57   29 53   1 96   2 34  3 05  120   1 615 2 585 3 51   4 68   4 73   7 10   7 11   11 91   11 92   19 04   18 76   35 50   2 36   2 82  3 81  150   2 019 3 231 4 40   5 88   5 93   8 90   8 91   14 92   14 93   23 82   23 54   44 47   2 96   3 55  5 08  200   2 692 4 308 5 89   7 87   7 93   11 91   11 92   19 94   19 95   31 80   31 52   59 41   3 97   4 75  6 35  250   3 365 5 385 7 39   9 87   9 93   14 91   14 92   24 95   24 96   39 77   39 49   74 36   4 98   5 96  7 62  300
2.                                                                                                                                                 500 mm  20   or longer  l                                                                                                                            100 mm  4   or longer      Do not install the projector in a confined space   When it is necessary to install the projector in a confined space  install the air conditioning or ventilation separately  Exhaust  heat may accumulate when the ventilation is not enough  triggering the protection circuit of the projector        When using this product  take safety measures against the following incidents      Personal information being leaked via this product     Unauthorized operation of this product by a malicious third party     Interfering or stopping of this product by a malicious third party   Take sufficient security measures    pages 133  153      Make your password difficult to guess as much as possible      Change your password periodically      Panasonic Corporation or its affiliate companies will never ask for your password directly  Do not divulge your password in  case you receive such inquiries      The connecting network must be secured by a firewall  etc    e Set a password for the web control and restrict the users who can log in      Art Net  is an Ethernet communication protocol based on the TCP IP protocol   By using the DMX controller or application software  illumination 
3.                                                                                   1  Press AY to select  GEOMETRY    2  Press 4b to select  CORNER CORRECTION    3  Press the   ENTER  button     The  GEOMETRY CORNER CORRECTION  screen is displayed   4  Press A V to select the item to adjust  and press the   ENTER  button   5  Press A V 4  to adjust    CORNER CORRECTION    UPPER LEFT   UPPER RIGHT   LOWER LEFT   LOWER RIGHT          LLLEJ  F HE HE  HH LV  LLLA  AOE LULH   LINEARITY   Horizontal direction Vertical direction  Note      The menu or logo may run off the screen when  GEOMETRY  is set   e  f  EDGE BLENDING   9 page 87  adjustment and  GEOMETRY  are used together  correct edge blending adjustment may not be    possible in certain environments       The optional Upgrade Kit  Model No   ET UK20  can be used to expand the correctable range  To purchase the product  consult your dealer     ENGLISH   83    Chapter4 Settings      POSITION  menu           Only for PT DW11KE   You can correct the trapezoidal distortion that occurs when the projector is installed tilted or when the screen is tilted     1  Press AY to select  KEYSTONE    2  Press the  lt ENTER gt  button   3  Press A V to select the item to adjust     4  Press 4b to adjust         KEYSTONE   SUB KEYSTONE                                         H                                      LINEARITY                                                                                                                          
4.                             oo Mitew         a   oo                               Panasonic  PROJECTOR                                                                                  1  Press the power standby   d   button     The  POWER OFF STANDBY   confirmation screen is displayed     2  Press 4b to select  OK   and press the   ENTER  button      Or press the power standby  lt   gt  button again        Projection of the image will stop  and the power indicator   ON  G  STANDBY  R  gt  on the projector body lights in orange   The fan  keeps running      3  Wait until the power indicator   ON  G  STANDBY  R  gt  on the projector body lights in red  and the fan  stops  for 170 seconds     4  Press the   OFF   side of the   MAIN POWER  switch to turn off the power   Note      Do not switch on the projector and project images immediately after switching off the projector   Turning on the power while the lamp is still hot may shorten the lamp life      For about 75 seconds after the projector is switched off and the luminous lamp cooling is started  the lamp indicators will not light up even  if the power is switched on  Even after 75 seconds  the lamp may not light up if the projector is switched on  In such a case  after the power  indicator   ON  G  STANDBY  R  gt  lights in red  switch on the projector again      The projector consumes power even when the power standby   o   button is pressed and the projector is switched off if the main  power of the projector is on    Whe
5.                   Unit  m   Lens type Zoom lens  Projection lens Model No  ET D75LE1 ET D75LE2   ET D75LE3   ET D75LE4   ET D75LE8   ET D75LE6  Throw ratio   1 5 2 0 1 2 1 3 1 1 3 1 5 2 1 5 2 8 2 1 8 2 15 4 1 1 0 1 2 1  Projection screen size Projection distance  L     Height   Min    Max    Min    Max    Min    Max    Min    Max    Min    Max    Min    Max   Diagonal  SD    sey Width  SW  aw     v    aw     rr     iw     LT    aw    LT    aw    LT    aw    LT   1 78  70   0 872 1 550 2 32   3 10   3 14   4 72   4 73   7 94   7 94   12 71   12 43   23 65   1 56   1 87  2 03  80   0 996 1 771 2 66   3 56   3 60   5 41   5 42   9 09   9 09   14 54   14 26   27 08   1 79   2 14  2 29  90   1 121 1 992 3 01   4 02   4 06   6 10   6 11   10 24   10 25   16 37   16 09   30 51   2 02   242  2 54  100   1 245 2 214 3 35   4 48   4 52   6 79   6 80   11 39   11 40   18 21   17 92   33 94   225   2 70  3 05  120   1 494 2 657 4 03   5 39   5 44   8 17   8 18   13 69   13 70   21 87   21 58   40 80   2 72   325  3 81  150   1 868 3 321 5 06   6 76   6 81   10 23   10 24   17 15   17 15   27 36   27 08   51 09   3 41   4 08  5 08  200   2 491 4 428 6 77   9 05   9 11   13 68   13 69   22 90   22 91   36 51   36 23   68 25   4 56   5 47  6 35  250   3 113 5 535 8 49   11 34   11 41   17 13   17 14   28 66   28 67   45 67   45 39   85 40   5 72   6 85  7 62  300  3 736 6 641 10 20   13 63   13 71   20 57   20 58   34 42   34 42   54 82   54 54  102 55  6 87   8 24  8 89  350   4 358 7 748 
6.                Environment care information for users in China    This symbol is only valid in China        Panasonic Corporation    Web Site   http   panasonic net avc projector      Panasonic Corporation 2013 W0513HM3104  YI       
7.                Note      The menu or logo may run off the screen when adjustments are performed with  KEYSTONE     e Correcting up to  40   for the tilt in the vertical direction is available for adjustments with  KEYSTONE   However  the image quality will  degrade and it will get harder to focus with more correction  Install the projector so that the correction will be as small as possible    22    when using projection lens ET D75LE5 ET D75LE50  or  28   when using the projection lens ET D75LE6     Screen size will also change when  KEYSTONE  is used to perform various adjustments    When the keystone is corrected with  KEYSTONE   the edge blending cannot be adjusted together    Aspect ratio of the image size may shift depending on the correction or lens zoom value    For the portrait setting  keystone is corrected for horizontal tilt     84   ENGLISH    Chapter 4 Settings      ADVANCED MENU  menu     ADVANCED MENU  menu             On the menu screen  select  ADVANCED MENU  from the main menu  and select an item from  the sub menu    Refer to    Navigating through the menu    page 65  for the operation of the menu screen    e After selecting the item  press A V 4P to set                 You can increase the vertical resolution and enhance the image quality by performing cinema processing when the PAL  or SECAM  576i  signal  the NTSC 480i signal  and 1080 50i  1080 60i are input     1  Press A V to select  DIGITAL CINEMA REALITY    2  Press 4b to switch the item       The 
8.                Torque  4   0 5 N m                                        188   ENGLISH    Index       Index       0 9  3D COLOR MATCHING      3D FRAME DELAY       3D INPUT FORMAT       3D PICTURE BALANCE     3D SAFETY PRECAUTIONS    3D SETTINGS      3D SIMUL INPUT SETTING   3D SYNC SETTING          3D SYSTEM SETTING    3D TEST MODE         3D TEST PATTERN        A   Accessories    AC IN  terminal     Adjusting adjustable feet    ADVANCED MENU      Air filter unit                       160  Air filter unit compartmen                              Art Net   18  170   Art Net SE  138   ASPECT   T9         ASPECT  button   Remote control    24  63  Aspect function  Attaching removing the projection lens  Automatic setup function  AUTO SETUP     AUTO SETUP  button   Projector body   Remote control   AUTO SIGNAL           B  BACK COLOR   BACKUP INPUT SETTING    BLANKING   BRIGHTNESS   BRIGHTNESS CONTROL         03  Cautions on use       Cautions when installing    Cautions when transporting  Ceiling Mount Bracket for Projectors  CLAMP POSITION       CLOCK PHASE   COLOR               COLOR MATCHING    COLOR TEMPERATURE   Connecting the power cord  Connecting to the projector with a cable  Connection         CONTRAST       CONTROL DEVICE PASSWORD CHANGE      135  CONTROL DEVICE SETUP   COOLING CONDITION   Crestron RoomView   CUT OFF        D  DARK TIME SETTING     DATE AND TIME     DEFAULT  button  Remote control  Deleting the registered signal  DIGITAL CINEMA REALITY      Dimensions
9.               Sub menu item Factory default Page   CLAMP POSITION   24   86   EDGE BLENDING   OFF  87   FRAME RESPONSE   NORMAL  88   FRAME LOCK    OFF  89   RASTER POSITION      89   1 Depends on the signal input    2 Only for PT DZ13KE  PT DS12KE  PT DZ10KE  Note  e Sub menu items and factory default settings differ depending on the selected input terminal    DISPLAY LANGUAGE  IZ   Details   page 90    3D SETTINGS         Only for PT DZ13KE  PT DS12KE  PT DW11KE   Sub menu item Factory default Page   3D SYSTEM SETTING   SINGLE  91   3D SYNC SETTING      91   3D SIMUL INPUT SETTING      92   3D INPUT FORMAT   AUTOT   92   LEFT RIGHT SWAP   NORMAL  93   3D COLOR MATCHING   SHARED 2D 3D  93   3D PICTURE BALANCE      93   DARK TIME SETTING   1 5 ms  94   3D FRAME DELAY   Ous  94   3D TEST MODE   NORMAL  94   3D TEST PATTERN      95   SAFETY PRECAUTIONS MESSAGE   ON  95   3D SAFETY PRECAUTIONS      95   1 Depends on the selected input terminal    DISPLAY OPTION  Ce  Sub menu item Factory default Page   COLOR MATCHING   OFF  96   LARGE SCREEN CORRECTION   OFF  97   SCREEN SETTING       97   AUTO SIGNAL   OFF  98   AUTO SETUP      98   BACKUP INPUT SETTING      99   RGB IN      100   DVI D IN      101   HDMI IN      101   SDI IN       101   ON SCREEN DISPLAY      103   BACK COLOR   BLUE  104   STARTUP LOGO   DEFAULT LOGO  105   UNIFORMITY      105   SHUTTER SETTING      106   FREEZE      106   WAVEFORM MONITOR   OFF  106   CUT OFF      108                 1 Only for PT DZ13KE  PT 
10.            Sub menu item Factory default Page   NETWORK SETUP      137   NETWORK CONTROL      137   NETWORK STATUS      138   Art Net SETUP   OFF  138                Note    e Some items may not be adjusted or used for certain signal formats to be input to the projector   The menu items that cannot be adjusted or used are shown in gray characters  and they cannot be selected   e Sub menu items and factory default settings differ depending on the selected input terminal     70   ENGLISH    Chapter 4 Settings      PICTURE  menu     PICTURE  menu    On the menu screen  select  PICTURE  from the main menu  and select an item from the sub   menu    Refer to    Navigating through the menu    page 65  for the operation of the menu screen    e After selecting the item  press A V   b to set                             You can switch to the desired picture mode suitable for the image source and the environment in which the projector is used     1  Press A V to select  PICTURE MODE      2  Press the 4b     The  PICTURE MODE  individual adjustment screen is displayed     3  Press 4b to switch the item       The items will switch each time you press the button                                    STANDARD  The image becomes suitable for moving images in general    CINEMA  The image becomes suitable for movie contents    NATURAL  The image is sRGB compliant    DICOM SIM   The image becomes similar to that of DICOM Part 14 Grayscale Standard    DYNAMIC  The light output is maximized for use i
11.           ON G    STANDBY  R              Li    Ju                            Indicator status Projector status  Off The main power is switched off   The power is switched off  in standby mode    Red Lit Projection will start when the power on       button is pressed     The projector may not operate when the lamp indicators  lt LAMP1 gt   lt LAMP2 gt  or  temperature indicator   TEMP  are flashing    page 158    Green Lit Projecting    Orange Lit The projector is preparing to switch off the projector   The power is switched off after a while   Changes to the standby mode            52   ENGLISH    Chapter 3 Basic Operations     Switching on off the projector       Note      While the power indicator   ON  G  STANDBY  R  gt  is lit in orange  the fan is running to cool the projector      For about 75 seconds after the projector is switched off and the luminous lamp cooling is started  the lamp indicators will not light up even if  the power is switched on  After the power indicator   ON  G  STANDBY  R  gt  lights in red  turn on the power again      The projector consumes power even in standby mode  power indicator   ON  G  STANDBY  R  gt  lit in red   Refer to    Power consumption    9 page 184  for the power consumption      The power indicator   ON  G  STANDBY  R  gt  flashes if a remote control signal is received      The power indicator   ON  G  STANDBY  R  gt  flashes slowly in green while the shutter is closed    e  f the power indicator   ON  G  STANDBY  R  gt  is fla
12.      1 Only for PT DZ13KE  PT DS12KE  PT DW11KE       Main menu item Page    amp   PROJECTOR SETUP  109   d  P IN P  127  wg  TEST PATTERN  129  E  SIGNAL LIST  130  d  SECURITY  133   z    S  NETWORK  137       Submenu        0    The sub menu of the selected main menu item is displayed  and you can set and adjust items in the sub menu                                                                                                      PICTURE  L    Sub menu item Factory default Page   PICTURE MODE   STANDARD  71   CONTRAST   0  71   BRIGHTNESS   0  72   COLOR   0  72   TINT   0  72   COLOR TEMPERATURE   DEFAULT  72   GAMMA   DEFAULT  74   SYSTEM DAYLIGHT VIEW   OFF  75   SHARPNESS    6  75   NOISE REDUCTION   OFF  76   DYNAMIC IRIS   2  76   SYSTEM SELECTOR   Y PPR  77   1 Depends on the signal input   Note  e The factory default settings may vary depending on the picture mode    POSITION  I  Sub menu item Factory default Page   SHIFT      79   ASPECT   DEFAULT  79   ZOOM      80   CLOCK PHASE  Om 81   GEOMETRY    OFF  81   KEYSTONE    s     84   1 Depends on the signal input    2 Only for PT DZ13KE  PT DS12KE  PT DZ10KE   3 Only for PT DW11KE   ADVANCED MENU   Sub menu item Factory default Page   DIGITAL CINEMA REALITY   AUTOT   85   BLANKING      85   INPUT RESOLUTION      86                   ENGLISH   67    Chapter 4 Settings     Menu navigation                                                                                                                                
13.      By setting  AUTO TESTPATTERN  on the  EDGE BLENDING  screen to  ON   the black test pattern is displayed when you enter the   BRIGHTNESS ADJUST  screen     12  Press A V to select  NON OVERLAPPED BLACK LEVEL      13  Press the   ENTER  button       The  NON OVERLAPPED BLACK LEVEL  screen is displayed   e If  INTERLOCKED  is set to  OFF    RED    GREEN   and  BLUE  can be adjusted individually     14  Press A    to select an item  and press 4P to adjust the setting   e Once the adjustment is completed  press the   MENU  button to return to the  BRIGHTNESS ADJUST  screen     ENGLISH   87    Chapter 4 Settings      ADVANCED MENU  menu       15  Press A to select  UPPER    LOWER    LEFT   or  RIGHT  in  BLACK BORDER WIDTH      16  Press 4P to set the region  width  of the  BLACK BORDER WIDTH  adjustment       When PT DZ13KE  PT DS12KE  or PT DZ10KE is used  proceed to Step 17      When PT DW11KE is used  proceed to Step 19      17  Press A V to select  UPPER KEYSTONE AREA    LOWER KEYSTONE AREA    LEFT KEYSTONE  AREA   or  RIGHT KEYSTONE AREA      18  Press 4  to adjust the tilt of the border between  NON OVERLAPPED BLACK LEVEL  and  BLACK  BORDER LEVEL      19  Press A V to select  BLACK BORDER LEVEL      20  Press the   ENTER  button       The  BLACK BORDER LEVEL  screen is displayed     If  INTERLOCKED  is set to  OFF    RED    GREEN   and  BLUE  can be adjusted individually     21  Press A V to select an item  and press q gt  to adjust the setting      BLACK BORDER WIDTH
14.      SHARED 2D 3D  2D signals and 3D signals use the same correction data    SEPARATE 2D 3D  2D signals and 3D signals use different correction data                    Note    Switch the setting of  COLOR MATCHING   9 page 96  while inputting the signal to be adjusted      SD PICTURE BALANCE   gt  1 1    Correct a shift when the brightness or color differ in the right eye and left eye images   1  Press A V to select  3D PICTURE BALANCE      2  Press the   ENTER  button     The  3D PICTURE BALANCE  screen is displayed     3  Press A V to select an item  and press 4P to adjust the setting       Correct the setting value parts of the right eye image based on the left eye image     For  3D WAVEFORM MONITOR   the left eye and right eye images are divided and displayed in a waveform on the left and right                     CONTRAST  Adjusts the contrast of the colors    SE EALAR E Adjusts the high red white balance    RED    WHITE BALANCE HIGH         GREEN  Adjusts the high green white balance     WHITE BALANCE HIGH     F   BLUE  Adjusts the high blue white balance     BRIGHTNESS  Adjusts the dark  black  part of the projected image         WHITE BALANCE LOW RED    Adjusts the low red white balance    WHITE BALANCE LOW       Adjusts the low green white balance                 GREEN    WHITE a Low Adjusts the low blue white balance    COLOR  Adjusts the color saturation of the projected image    TINT  Adjusts the skin tone in the projected image    CLOCK PHASE  Adjusts when the sc
15.     3  B Pg  11  GND  ff   OOO A   4     12  DDC data   6    00 O C   10   E O00 QJ   5  GND  13  SYNC HD  T       34  6  GND  14  VD  1       5   7  GND  15  DDC clock   8  GND         HDMI IN   terminal pin assignments and signal names                                                                                                                                           Outside view Pin No  Signal name Pin No  Signal name   1  T M D S data 2   11  T M D S clock shield               2  T M D S data 2 shield  12  T M D S clock   vennumbersd RIRs orta  to  18   3  T M D S data 2   13  CEC   2   gt   18   4  T M D S data 1   14     MISTS SISTA  5  T M D S data 1 shield  15  SCL  LT BE BEBE BT B E Eg  s REDDUNT      6  T M D S data 1   16  SDA    DDC CEC  7 T M D S data 0  17   4            gt   19   7  ata  17  GND  8 T M D S data 0 shield 18  5 V  Odd numbered pins of  1  to  19   8  eee  18  i   9  T M D S data 0   19  Hot plug detection   10  T M D S clock                       48   ENGLISH    Chapter 2 Getting Started     Connecting         DVI D IN   terminal pin assignments and signal names                                                                                                                                     Outside view Pin No  Signal name Pin No  Signal name   1  T M D S data 2   13        2  T M D S data 2   14   5V   3  T M D S data 2 4 shield  15  GND   24        47   4       16  Hot plug detection   5       17  T M D S data 0    16   __  CEERERHBI o  6 
16.    1  Account   Displays the account to change     2  Current  User name   Enter the user name before the change     3  Current  Password   Enter the current password     4  New  User name     sex D   BCX f Aneto control wrda                                   3  Next   Used to change the setting of the password     Ee SASSLCHANGERIN D   It C X    dikeratector contri endow  x                            A          5  New  Password   Enter the desired new password   Up to 16 characters in single  byte   6  New  Password Retype    Enter the desired new password again   7  OK   Determines the change of password     Enter the desired new user name   Up to 16 characters in single    byte     ENGLISH   153    Chapter 4 Settings      NETWORK  menu        User  account                                             Wrrp   392 168 028    pene  5_CHANGERIN D   E O X   di  ertectoc control wnio  x  1    r   2  I  I 3    c  5  1  Account  3  New  Password   Displays the account to change  Enter the desired new password   Up to 16 characters in single  2  New  User name  byte   Enter the desired new user name   Up to 16 characters in single 4  New  Password Retype    byte  Enter the desired new password again   5  OK     Determines the change of password      Change password   For user rights   Only the change of password is enabled under the user rights     adl ico 102 168 0 8 9 on rsen rgo ERULINGUR Cranes D   RO X 3 rore oer mmo                               1  Old Password  3  Retype   Ent
17.    1 1425 x SD   0 0857    Max   LT  L   1 4767 x SD   0 1085  ET D75LE10 1 4 to 1 8 1    18 8 Min   LW  L   1 2446 x SD   0 0857  i Max   LT  L   1 6086 x SD   0 1085    ENGLISH   43       Chapter 2    Getting Started     Setting up                                                                                                                                                                            Projection lens Model No  Throw ratio Aspect ratio Projection distance  L  formula  p Min   LW  L   1 4618 x SD   0 0832  i Max   LT  L   2 1241 x SD   0 1162  ET D75LE20 1 8 to 2 6 1    iea Min   LW  L   1 5924 x SD   0 0832  i Max   LT  L   2 3137 x SD   0 1162  45 Min   LW  L   2 1089 x SD   0 1131    Max   LT  L   4 0899 x SD   0 1765  ET D75LE30 2 6 to 5 1 1    16 8 Min   LW  L   2 2972 x SD   0 1131  i Max   LT  L   4 4552 x SD   0 1765  m Min   LW  L   4 0379 x SD   0 1577    Max   LT  L   6 4377 x SD   0 1615  ET D75LE40 5 0 to 8 0 1    16 6 Min   LW  L   4 3985 x SD   0 1577  i Max   LT  L   7 0126 x SD   0 1615  E Fixed focus lens  Projection lens Model No  Throw ratio Aspect ratio Projection distance  L  formula  4 3 L   0 6220 x SD   0 0835  ET D75LE5 0 8 1  16 9 L   0 6772 x SD   0 0835  4 3 L   0 6202 x SD   0 0713  ET D75LE50 0 8 1  16 9 L   0 6755 x SD   0 0713  For PT DW11KE  B Zoom lens  Projection lens Model No  Throw ratio Aspect ratio Projection distance  L  formula  Min   LW  L   1 3504 x SD   0 0760  1 5 to 2 0 1 16 9  Max   LT  L   1 8031 x SD   0 1004  E
18.    1 4458 x SD   0 1085  Min   LW  L   1 1497 x SD   0 0857  ET D75LE10 1 3 to 1 7 1 16 9  Max   LT  L   1 4860 x SD   0 1085  Min   LW  L   1 2663 x SD   0 0857  1 6 to 2 0 1 4 3  Max   LT  L   1 6367 x SD   0 1085  Min   LW  L   1 4312 x SD   0 0832  1 7 to 2 4 1 16 10  Max   LT  L   2 0795 x SD   0 1162  Min   LW  L   1 4709 x SD   0 0832  ET D75LE20 1 7 to 2 4 1 16 9  Max   LT  L   2 1373 x SD   0 1162  Min   LW  L   1 6202 x SD   0 0832  2 0 to 2 9 1 4 3  Max   LT  L   2 3542 x SD   0 1162                      42   ENGLISH    Chapter 2    Getting Started     Setting up                                                                                                                                                                                                       Projection lens Model No  Throw ratio Aspect ratio Projection distance  L  formula  Min   LW  L   2 0647 x SD   0 1131  2 4 to 4 7 1 16 10  Max   LT  L   4 0041 x SD   0 1765  Min   LW  L   2 1221 x SD   0 1131  ET D75LE30 2 4 to 4 7 1 16 9  Max   LT  L  4 1155 x SD   0 1765  Min   LW  L   2 3374 x SD   0 1131  2 9 to 5 6 1 4 3  Max   LT  L   4 5330 x SD   0 1765  Min   LW  L   3 9532 x SD   0 1577  4 6 to 7 4 1 16 10  Max   LT  L   6 3027 x SD   0 1615  Min   LW  L   4 0631 x SD   0 1577  ET D75LE40 4 6 to 7 4 1 16 9  Max   LT  L   6 4779 x SD   0 1615  Min   LW  L   4 4754 x SD   0 1577  5 5 to 8 9 1 4 3  Max   LT  L  7 1351 x SD   0 1615  E Fixed focus lens  Projection lens Model No  Throw ratio Aspect ratio 
19.    17 22   17 02   27 23 2 56 2 57  5 08  200  2 491 4 428 6 40   8 27   8 21   11 93   11 85   23 03   22 75   36 36 3 44 3 45  6 35  250   3 113 5 535 8 02   10 36   10 28   14 95   14 84   28 83   28 48   45 49 4 33 4 33  7 62  300   3 736 6 641 9 64   12 46   12 36   17 96   17 83   34 63   34 20   54 62 5 21 5 21  8 89  350   4 358 7 748 11 26   14 55   14 43   20 97   20 82   40 43   39 93   63 75     6 09  10 16  400   4 981 8 855 12 88   16 65   16 50   23 98   23 81   46 23   45 66   72 88     6 96  12 70  500   6 226 11 069   16 12   20 83   20 65   30 01   29 80   57 83   57 11   91 14     8 72  15 24  600   7 472 13 283   19 36   25 02   24 80   36 03   35 78   69 43   68 56 1109 40     10 48  25 40  1000   12 453 22 138   32 32   41 78   41 38   60 13   59 70  115 83 114 38 182 44     17 52        1    40   ENGLISH    The throw ratio is based on the value during projection onto a 3 81 m  150   screen size     Chapter 2 Getting Started     Setting up       B When the screen aspect is 4 3                                                                                                                                                                                Unit  m   Lens type Zoom lens  Projection lens Model No  ET D75LE1 ET D75LE2   ET D75LE3   ET D75LE4   ET D75LE8   ET D75LE6  Throw ratio     2 0 2 7 1 2 7 4 1 1 4 1 6 9 1 6 9 11 0 1 10 9 20 5 1 1 4 1 6 1  Projection screen size Projection distance  L   5 Height  gt  Min    Max    Min    Max    Min    Max    
20.    4 039 6 462 8 88   11 86   11 93   17 91   17 92   29 97   29 98   47 75   47 47   89 30   5 99   7 17  8 89  350  4 712 7 539 10 37   13 86   13 93   20 91   20 92   34 98   34 99   55 72   55 44  104 24  6 99   8 37  10 16  400   5 385 8 616 11 86   15 85   15 94   23 92   23 93   40 00   40 01   63 70   63 42  119 19  8 00   9 58  12 70  500   6 731 10 770   14 85   19 84   19 94   29 92   29 93   50 03   50 04   79 65   79 37  149 08  10 01   11 99  15 24  600   8 077 12 923   17 83   23 82   23 94   35 93   35 94   60 06   60 07   95 60   95 32  178 96  12 03   14 40  25 40  1000   13 462 21 539   29 77   39 77   39 96   59 95   59 96  100 18 100 19 159 40  159 13        20 08   24 06  Lens type Zoom lens Fixed focus lens  Projection lens Model No  ET D75LE10   ET D75LE20   ET D75LE30   ET D75LE40   ET D75LE5   ET D75LE50  Throw ratio     1 3 1 7 1 1 7 2 4 1 2 4 4 7 1 4 6 7 4 1 0 7 1 0 7 1  Projection screen size Projection distance  L     Height   Min    Max    Min    Max    Min    Max    Min    Max    B    Diagonal  SD   SH  Width  SW   LW     LT     Lw     LT     w     LT    w     LT  Fixed Fixed  1 78  70   0 942 1 508 1 90   2 46   2 46   3 58   3 56   6 94   6 87   11 04 0 99 1 01  2 03  80   1 077 1 723 2 19   2 83   2 82   4 11   4 08   7 96   7 88   12 65 1 15 1 16  2 29  90   1 212 1 939 2 47   3 20   3 19   4 64   4 61   8 98   8 88   14 25 1 30 1 32  2 54  100   1 346 2 154 2 76   3 56   3 55   5 17   5 13   9 99   9 88   15 85 1 45 1 47  3 05  120   1 615
21.    5  Press the   ENTER  button     The  MEASURED DATA  screen is displayed     6  Measure the current luminance  Y  and the chromaticity coordinates  x  y  using the colorimeter     7  Press A to select a color  and press q gt  to adjust the setting   e Set  AUTO TESTPATTERN  to  ON  to display a test pattern of selected colors     8  Once all the input is completed  press the   MENU  button     The  709MODE  or  MEASURED MODE  screen is displayed     When  MEASURED  is selected in Step 2   proceed to Step 9  and enter the coordinates of desired colors     9  Press A V to select  TARGET DATA      10  Press the   ENTER  button     The  TARGET DATA  screen is displayed     11  Press A V to select a color and press 4P to input coordinates for desired colors   e Set  AUTO TESTPATTERN  to  ON  to display a test pattern of selected colors     12  Once all the input is completed  press the   MENU  button     Note    When  709MODE  is selected in  COLOR MATCHING   the ITU R BT 709 standard three primary colors are set as target data    Colors are not displayed properly when target data is a color outside the region of this projector    The  709MODE  may differ slightly from the ITU R BT 709 standard colors    Set the  AUTO TESTPATTERN  to  ON  to automatically display a test pattern for use in adjusting the selected adjustment colors    Before using a colorimeter or similar instrument to measure measurement data  set  PICTURE MODE  to  DYNAMIC     A difference in the color coordinat
22.    6 226 11 069 15 26   20 39   20 50   30 76   30 77   51 42   51 43   81 87   81 59  153 23  10 29   12 33  15 24  600   7 472 13 283   18 33   24 49   24 61   36 93   36 94   61 73   61 74   98 26   97 98  183 95  12 36   14 81  25 40  1000   12 453 22 138   30 60   40 88   41 07   61 62   61 63  102 97  102 98  163 83  163 56        20 64   24 73  Lens type Zoom lens Fixed focus lens  Projection lens Model No  ET D75LE10   ET D75LE20   ET D75LE30   ET D75LE40   ET D75LE5   ET D75LE50  Throw ratio     1 3 1 7 1 1 7 2 4 1 2 4 4 7 1 4 6 7 4 1 0 7 1 0 7 1  Projection screen size Projection distance  L     Height i Min    Max    Min    Max    Min    Max    Min    Max    A  Diagonal  SD   SH  Width  SW   LW     LT     Lw     LT     w     LT    w     LT  Fixed Fixed  1 78  70   0 872 1 550 1 96   2 53   2 53   3 68   3 66   7 14   7 07   11 36 1 02 1 04  2 03  80   0 996 1 771 2 25   2 91   2 91   4 23   4 20   8 19   8 10   13 00 1 18 1 20  2 29  90   1 121 1 992 2 54   3 29   3 28   477   4 74   923   9 13   14 65 1 34 1 36  2 54  100   1 245 2 214 2 83   3 67   3 65   5 31   5 28   10 28   10 16   16 29 1 50 1 51  3 05  120   1 494 2 657 3 42   4 42   4 40   640   6 35   12 37   12 23   19 58 1 81 1 83  3 81  150   1 968 3 321 4 29   5 55   5 52   8 03   7 97   15 50   15 32   24 52 2 29 2 31  5 08  200   2 491 4 428 5 75   7 44   7 39   10 74   10 67   20 73   2048   32 75 3 08 3 10  6 35  250  3 113 5 535 7 21   9 33   9 26   13 46   13 36   25 96   25 64   40 97 3 87 3 89 
23.    Adobe Flash Player is a trademark or registered trademark of Adobe Systems Inc  in the United Stated and or other  countries      RealD 3D is a trademark of RealD Inc     e Some of the fonts used in the on screen menu are Ricoh bitmap fonts  which are manufactured and sold by Ricoh Company   Ltd       All other names  company names  and product names mentioned in this manual are trademarks or registered trademarks of  their respective owners   Please note that the 9 and TM symbols are not specified in this manual     E Illustrations in this manual    e  llustrations of the projector  screen  and other parts may vary from the actual product     E Reference pages    e Reference pages in this manual are indicated as   page 00      B Term       n this manual  the  Wireless wired remote control unit  accessory is referred to as  Remote control      10   ENGLISH       _ Features of the Projector _    High luminance and high color  reproduction     gt  High luminance and high color  reproduction are achieved with a small size  by means of a unique optical system and  lamp drive system     Easy setup and improved  serviceability     gt  In addition to the extensive lineup of  optional lenses that allows more flexible  setup of the projector   portrait mode  is  supported     Improved cost performance in  maintenance fee     gt  The extended life filter reduces  maintenance costs     For details  refer to the corresponding pages     1  Setup the projector    9 page 31     i    2  A
24.    E  _  000 00   1 Power indicator   ON  G  STANDBY  R  gt   ERU Are Displays the status of the power   da  R   Oo MM   T DU niy 00  o le Es DRE 2 Lamp indicator  lt LAMP1 gt   Tem RA Displays the status of lamp 1   3 Lamp indicator  lt LAMP2 gt    T9    Displays the status of lamp 2   IF 4 Temperature indicator  lt TEMP gt   Displays the internal temperature status      5 Filter indicator  lt FILTER gt   Displays the status of the air filter unit   O   Q  6 Adjustable feet             Adjusts the projection angle    e   Projection direction 7 Remote control signal receiver  front   Air exhaust port   9 Lampunit cover   10 Remote control signal receiver  rear    11 Control panel      page 26    12 Connecting terminals   page 27     ENGLISH   25    Chapter 1    Preparation     About your projector       13 Security slot  This security slot is compatible with the Kensington security  cables     14 Air intake port    15   ACIN  terminal  Connect the supplied power cord     Attention      Do not block the ventilation ports  intake and exhaust  of the projector     E Control panel    POWER ONNSTANDBY       16    17    18      MAIN POWER  switch  Turns on off the main power     Air filter cover  The air filter unit is inside     Burglar hook port  Attaches a burglar prevention cable  etc                                      on O an    Q                               1 Power standby  lt b gt  button  Sets the projector to the state where the projector is switched  off  standby mode
25.    ENGLISH   165    Chapter 5 Maintenance     Troubleshooting       Troubleshooting    Review the following points  For details  see the corresponding pages                                                  Problems Points to be checked Page      s the power plug firmly inserted into the outlet          Is the   MAIN POWER  switch set to   OFF    55      s the wall outlet supplying electricity       Power does not turn on    Have the circuit breakers tripped        Are the lamp indicator  lt LAMP1 gt   lt LAMP2 gt  or the temperature indicator   TEMP  lit 458   or flashing       s the lamp unit cover attached  164     Are connections to external devices correctly performed  48      s the input selection setting correct  62      s the  BRIGHTNESS  adjustment setting at a minimum  72  No image appears     s the external device that is connected to the projector working properly           s the shutter function in use  61   e  f the power indicator   ON  G  STANDBY  R  gt  is flashing in red  consult your     dealer       s the lens cover still attached to the lens  53      s the lens focus set correctly  56  image isifuzzy  e  s the projection distance appropriate  32      s the lens dirty  19      s the projector installed perpendicular to the screen           s  COLOR  or  TINT  adjusted correctly  72  Color is pale or grayish     s the external device connected to the projector adjusted correctly  48      s the RGB cable damaged          Are the batteries depleted        e Is
26.    ENTER  button   e The  SDI IN  screen is displayed     Press A V to select  SDI LINK      Press 4P to switch the item         SINGLE LINK  Sets SDI1 input and SDI2 input to single link               DUAL LINK  Sets SDI1 input and SDI2 input to dual link        Note    When  BACKUP INPUT MODE  is set to  ON    1   or  2    SDI LINK  cannot be set     Setting  SIGNAL LEVEL     Select the amplitude of the signal to input     1   2     3   4     Press AY to select  SDI IN      Press the   ENTER  button     The  SDI IN  screen is displayed     Press A V to select  SIGNAL LEVEL      Press   b to switch the item         64 940  Normally use this setting               4 1019  Select when gray is displayed as black        Setting  BIT DEPTH     1   2     3   4     Press AY to select  SDI IN      Press the   ENTER  button     The  SDI IN  screen is displayed     Press AY to select  BIT DEPTH      Press 4P to switch the item               AUTO  Automatically select 12 bits or 10 bits    12 bit  Fix to 12 bits    10 bit  Fix to 10 bits              Setting  3G SDI MAPPING     1   2     3   4     Press AY to select  SDI IN      Press the   ENTER  button     The  SDI IN  screen is displayed     Press AY to select  3G SDI MAPPING      Press 4P to switch the item                     AUTO  Automatically select level A or level B    LEVEL A  Fix to level A    LEVEL B  Fix to level B     102   ENGLISH                Chapter 4 Settings      DISPLAY OPTION  menu       Note    Does not operate 
27.    FLOOR SETTING           Portrait setting and projecting from the rear    Using the translucent screen     Menu item    Method    Portrait setting and projecting forward          Menu item Method        PROJECTION METHOD   REAR FLOOR      PROJECTION METHOD   FRONT FLOOR            COOLING CONDITION   PORTRAIT SETTING             COOLING CONDITION   PORTRAIT SETTING          1 For the portrait setting  use the optional Replacement lamp unit  for portrait mode   Model No   ET LAD320P  1 pc   ET LAD320PW  2 pcs        2 Using the optional Replacement lamp unit  for portrait mode   Model No   ET LAD320P  1 pc   ET LAD320PW  2 pcs   will set the cooling condition    to  PORTRAIT SETTING    Note       n the portrait setting  the on screen menu is displayed sideways     ENGLISH   31       Chapter 2 Getting Started     Setting up          You can install the projector on the ceiling using the optional Ceiling Mount Bracket for Projectors  Model No   ET PKD310H  for High Ceilings      ET PKD3108  for Low Ceilings         Be sure to use the Ceiling Mount Bracket for Projectors specified for this projector     Refer to the Installation Instructions supplied with the Ceiling Mount Bracket for Projectors when installing the projector with the bracket     Attention      To ensure projector performance and security  installation of the Ceiling Mount Bracket for Projectors must be carried out by your dealer or a    qualified technician        Refer to the screen size and projection distanc
28.    ID transmission in RS 232C supports ZZ  ALL  and 01 to 64  as well as 0A to 0Z groups    If a command is sent with a specified ID  a response will be sent to the computer only in the following cases      t matches the projector ID     ID setting is set to ALL and  RESPONSE ID ALL   is  ON      ID setting is set to GROUP and  RESPONSE ID GROUP   is  ON    STX and ETX are character codes  STX shown in hexadecimal is 02  and ETX shown in hexadecimal is 03     When multiple projectors are controlled    When multiple projectors are all controlled    When controlling multiple projectors together via RS 232C  perform the following settings    1  Seta different ID for each projector    2  Set  RESPONSE ID ALL   to  ON  in only one projector    3  Set  RESPONSE ID ALL   to  OFF  for all other projectors set in Step 2      When multiple projectors are all controlled by group unit    When controlling multiple projectors by group unit via RS 232C  perform the following settings    1  Seta different ID for each projector    2  Set  RESPONSE ID GROUP   to  ON  in only one projector    3  Set  RESPONSE ID GROUP   to  OFF  for all other projectors set in Step 2      Note      There will be no response if two or more projectors have  RESPONSE ID ALL   set to  ON      There will be no response if two or more projectors of the same group have  RESPONSE ID GROUP   set to  ON      When setting multiple groups  set  RESPONSE ID ALL   to  ON  in only one projector in each group     Cable specifi
29.    L3   Projection distance  R3  Arc radius               L2      e   a 12  Projection distance    R2  Arc radius             e                   L3   Projection distance  R3  Arc radius       Standard status                                              Only for  KEYSTONE   KEYSTONE  and  CURVED  used together Only for  CURVED    Projection Vertical Horizontal Vertical Horizontal   lens Model keystone keystone keystone keystone   Min  value of   Min  value of   Min  value of   Min  value of  No  correction correction correction correction R2 L2 R3 L3 R2 L2 R3 L3   angle a      angle B      angle a      angle f       ET D75LE1 2 3 0 6 1 3  ET D75LE2 1 6 0 5 0 9  ET D75LE3 1 1 0 3 0 6  ET D75LE4 0 7 0 2 0 4  ET D75LE5 4 9 1 2 2 9  ET D75LE6 3 9 0 9 2 3  ET D75LE8 0 4 0 2 0 3  ET D75LE10 2 6 0 6 1 5  ET D75LE20 1 7 0 5 1 0  ET D75LE30  40  15  20  15 0 6 1 2 0 4 0 7  ET D75LE40  40  15  20  15 0 4 0 7 0 2 0 4  ET D75LE50  22  15  8  8 2 0 4 9 1 2 2 9                            ENGLISH   33       Chapter 2 Getting Started     Setting up       When using the optional Upgrade Kit  Model No   ET UK20      Only for PT DZ13KE  PT DS12KE                                               Only for  KEYSTONE   KEYSTONE  and  CURVED  used together Only for  CURVED   Projection Vertical Horizontal Vertical Horizontal  lens Model keystone keystone keystone keystone   Min  value of   Min  value of   Min  value of   Min  value of  No  correction correction correction correction R2 L2 R3 L3 R2 L2 R
30.    OK  OPTICS MODULE TEMPERATURE   OK  AROUND LAMP TEMPERATURE   OK  LAMP1 REMAIN TIME   OK    LAMP2 REMAIN TIME   OK    LAMP1 STATUS   FAILED    LAMP2 STATUS   FAILED    APERTURE CONTRAST SHUTTER    OK  INTAKE AIR TEMP SENSOR   OK  OPTICS MODULE TEMP SENSOR   OK  AROUND LAMP TEMP SENSOR   OK  BATTERY   OK    LENS MOUNTER   OK    COVER OPEN   FAILED    BRIGHTNESS SENSOR   OK    ANGLE SENSOR   OK    FILTER UNIT   OK    AIR FILTER   OK    AC POWER   OK       Error code 00 00 00 60 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 23 00 00 00     Intake air temperature   27 degC   80 degF  Optics module temperature   33 degC   91 degF  Around lamp temperature   32 degC   89 degF       PROJECTOR RUNTIME 200H  POWER ON 1 times  LAMP1 ON 1 times  LAMP1 LOW 200 H  LAMP1 MID OH  LAMP1 HIGH OH  LAMP1 REMAIN 1800 H  LAMP2 ON 1 times  LAMP2 LOW 200 H  LAMP2 MID OH  LAMP2 HIGH OH  LAMP2 REMAIN 1800 H  d Current status             MAIN VERSION 1 00  NETWORK VERSION 1 00   SUB VERSION 1 00  LAMP STATUS LAMP1 ON LAMP2 ON  INPUT RGB1    REMOTE2 STATUS DISABLE          Wired Network configuration        DHCP Client OFF   IP address 192 168 0 8   MAC address 70 85 12 00 00 00    Fri Nov 01 16 50 14 2013             152   ENGLISH    Chapter 4    Settings      NETWORK  menu        Change password  page    Click  Change password      B rp  neang    1  Administrator   Used to change the setting of the  Administrator      2  User   Used to change the setting of the  User       Administrator  account    BB erp  002  148 0 8 
31.    P IN P  cannot be set    When  BACKUP INPUT MODE  is set to  ON    1   or  2    P IN P  cannot be set    3D images cannot be displayed in P IN P   Only for PT DZ13KE  PT DS12KE  PT DW11KE    The P IN P state continues while the P IN P function is used  even if 3D images of the simultaneous system are displayed   Only for  PT DZ13KE  PT DS12KE  PT DW11KE     128   ENGLISH    Chapter 4 Settings      TEST PATTERN  menu        TEST PATTERN  menu          On the menu screen  select  TEST PATTERN  from the main menu       Press 4P to switch     TET  TESTPATTERN FUNC  CD CD CD  C0 CD CO          Refer to    Navigating through the menu    page 65  for the operation of the menu screen                 Display the test pattern built in to the projector     Settings of position  size  and other factors will not be reflected in test patterns  Make sure to display the input signal before performing various    adjustments     1  Press 4P to switch the  TEST PATTERN  item       The items will switch each time you press the button        Menu screen   All white  Menu screen   All black  Menu screen   Window    Menu screen   Window   inversion                  vertical  adjustments        Menu screen   Color bar   horizontal     Menu screen   16 9 4 3  aspect frame    Menu screen   Focus          Menu screen   Color bar Displays test patterns with the menu screen  Select a test pattern so that it is easy to make various       Displays the menu screen and input signal        Pont Servet nEnH
32.    Right   Projection range Edge blending  WIDTH   Right           H MARKER   Red   i        i c1 Edge blending  START   Right   1    IMARKER   Green               I i     OVERLAPPED BLACK LEVEL   Right    NON OVERLAPPED BLACK LEVEL   BLACK BORDER LEVEL     Note       BRIGHTNESS ADJUST  is a function that makes the increased brightness in black level of the overlapping image area difficult to notice  when  EDGE BLENDING  is used to configure multiple screens  The optimal point of correction is set by adjusting  NON OVERLAPPED  BLACK LEVEL  so the black level of the overlapping image area will be the same level as the non overlapping area  If the border area of the  part where the image is overlapping and the non overlapping part gets brighter after adjusting  NON OVERLAPPED BLACK LEVEL   adjust  the width of the top  bottom  left  or right  Adjust  BLACK BORDER LEVEL  when the width adjustment makes only the border area darker      The joining part may look discontinuous depending on the position you are looking from when a screen with high gain or rear screen is used      When configuring multiple screens using both horizontal and vertical edge blending  adjust  OVERLAPPED BLACK LEVEL  first before  making adjustments in Step 12   Adjustment method is same as the procedure of  NON OVERLAPPED BLACK LEVEL        f only horizontal or vertical edge blending is used  set all items in  OVERLAPPED BLACK LEVEL  to 0       AUTO TESTPATTERN  settings change together with the  AUTO TES
33.    When  it is not possible   INACTIVE  is displayed instead    When  BACKUP INPUT STATUS  is  ACTIVE  while the image of the primary input is displayed  the secondary input becomes the backup  input    When  BACKUP INPUT STATUS  is  ACTIVE  while the image of the secondary input is displayed  the primary input becomes the backup  input    If the inputs of DVI D and HDMI are switched while  BACKUP INPUT MODE  is set to  ON  or  1  and switching to the backup input signal is  possible  the input is switched seamlessly    If the inputs of SDI1 and SDI2 are switched while  BACKUP INPUT MODE  is set to  2  and switching to the backup input signal is possible   the input is switched seamlessly    When  AUTOMATIC SWITCHING  is set to  ENABLE   and  BACKUP INPUT STATUS  is  ACTIVE   the signal is switched to the backup  input if the input signal is disrupted    When  AUTOMATIC SWITCHING  is set to  ENABLE  and the signal is automatically switched to the backup input due to disruption of the  input signal   BACKUP INPUT STATUS  changes to  INACTIVE   In this case  switching to the backup input signal is not possible until the  original input signal is restored  If the signal is automatically switched to the backup input  switching to the backup input signal becomes  possible when the original input signal is restored  In this case  the current input is retained        BACKUP INPUT SETTING  cannot be set during P IN P  The backup operation is not performed either      BACKUP INPUT SET
34.   3  Press the   ENTER  button     The  REGISTERED SIGNAL SETUP  screen is displayed     4  Press A V to select  LOCK IN RANGE    5  Press 4b to switch the item       The items will switch each time you press the button         NARROW  Select in most cases    WIDE  Widens the lock in range                 Note    Switch the range that determines that a signal to be input is the same signal that is already registered    To prioritize the determination that it is the same signal that is already registered  set to the  WIDE  setting    Use in cases such as when the synchronizing frequency of a signal to be input has changed slightly  or multiple signal lists are registered    Can only be used when a signal is input from the   RGB 1 IN   terminal    RGB 2 IN   terminal    DVI D IN   terminal  or  lt HDMI IN  terminal    When  WIDE  is set  the image may appear distorted because a signal is determined to be the same signal even if a synchronizing   frequency changes slightly      When a signal to be input corresponds to multiple signals set in  WIDE   a registered signal with a high memory number receives priority   Example  a signal to be input that corresponds to memory numbers A2  A4 and B1 will be determined to be B1      When a registration signal is deleted  the settings are also deleted       n an environment where multiple types of signals are input to the same terminal  signals are sometimes not determined correctly when the   setting is set to  WIDE      ENGLISH   131   
35.   Display language  DISPLAY OPTION     DISPLAY SETTING   Disposal      lt DVI D gt  button  Projector body  Remote control    DVI D IN J                 m    DYNAMIC TRIS  nencia    E   EDGE BEENDING      i   retreat 87    ENTER  button  Projector body  Remote control   Expanding signal lock in range     F  Filter indicator    abra tepore te elc 158                                                                           lt FOCUS gt  button  Remote control      FRAME LOCK           FRAME RESPONSE      FREEZE      FUNC  button  Remote control    Function button   FUNCTION BUTTON      G   GAMMA             GEOMETRY       H    lt HDMI gt  button  Projector body       Remote control       HDMI IN     HIGH ALTITUDE MODE     l   lt ID ALL gt  button  Remote control    sse 24  28    ID SET  button  Remote control      INITIALIZE    Initial setting        INPUT RESOLUTION   Installation mode                  K   KEYSTONE  riais 84    L  Lamp indicator    LAMP POWER     LAMP RELAY       LAMP SELECT    Lamp unit cover      LARGE SCREEN C   LEFT RIGHT SWAP     LENS  button  Projector body                  see   LENS CALIBRATION      LENS MEMORY     LIGHT  button  Remote control     tacere creto  List of compatible signals   LOAD ALL USER DATA         lt LOCK gt  button   Remote CONTON  ossscsviessscsosssssooasssuveacensnsnssnesenssnassneeresens 24                                              M  Main menu  Main power switch   Maintenance    MENU  button  Projector body     Remote contro
36.   Max    Min    Max    Min    Max    Min    Max  A 5  Diagonal  SD   SH  Width  SW   LW     LT     tW     LT     w     LT      w     LT  Fixed Fixed  1 78  70   1 067 1 422 1 95   2 52   2 52   3 66   3 64   7 10   7 02   11 28 1 02 1 03  2 03  80   1 219 1 626 2 24   2 89   2 89   4 20   4 17   8 13   8 05   12 92 1 18 1 19  2 29  90   1 372 1 829 2 53   3 27   3 26   4 74   4 71   9 17   9 07   14 56 1 34 1 35  2 54  100   1 524 2 032 2 82   3 64   3 63   5 28   5 24   10 21   10 10   16 19 1 50 1 50  3 05  120   1 829 2 438 3 40   4 39   4 37   6 36   6 31   12 29   12 15   19 46 1 81 1 82  3 81  150   2 286 3 048 4 27   5 52   5 49   7 98   7 92   15 41   15 23   24 37 2 29 2 29  5 08  200  3 048 4 064 5 72   7 39   7 34   10 67   10 60   20 60   20 35   32 54 3 08 3 08  6 35  250   3 810 5 080 7 17   9 27   9 20   13 37   13 28   25 79   25 48   40 72 3 87 3 87  7 62  300   4 572 6 096 8 62   11 14   11 06   16 07   15 96   30 99   30 61   48 89 4 66 4 65  8 89  350   5 334 7 112 10 07   13 02   12 91   18 77   18 63   36 18   35 74   57 07     5 44  10 16  400   6 096 8 128 11 52   14 90   14 77   21 46   21 31   41 38   40 87   65 25     6 23  12 70  500   7 620 10 160   14 42   18 65   18 48   26 86   26 67   51 77   51 12   81 60     7 80  15 24  600   9 144 12 192   17 33   22 40   22 19   32 25   32 03   62 15   61 38   97 95     9 38  25 40  1000   15 240 20 320   28 93   37 40   37 05   53 83   53 45  103 711102 41 163 36     15 68        1    38   ENGLISH    The
37.   Menu item    N   Navigating through the menu    NETWORK                    Network connections    NETWORK CONTROL     137   NETWORK SETUP         NETWORK STATUS   NOISE REDUCTION    ini   NO SIGNAL SHUT OFF                 seen 121     0    lt ON SCREEN gt  button   Remote control     ON SCREEN DISP  On screen menu           Optional accessories     P   PICTURE                     PICTURE MODE     P IN P   P IN P function   POSITION    Power cord     Power indicator                                      Power on button  Projector body        Remote control      Power standby button  Projector body   Remote control      Precautions for Ceiling Mount Bracket for   Projectors   Precautions for use    Projecting    PROJECTION METHOD  109   Projector body                  PROJECTOR ID        PROJECTOR SETUP       Protecting the registered signal       R   RASTER POSITION                                                   Registering new signals    REMOTE 1 IN  terminal    lt REMOTE 1 OUT gt  terminal    REMOTE 2 IN  terminal    REMOTE2 MODE    Remote control           Remote control operations  Renaming the registered signal    Replacing the air filter unit  Replacing the lamp unit   Replacing the unit              Resetting to the factory default      lt RGB1 gt  button  Projector body  Remote control      lt RGB2 gt  button  Projector body  Remote control  RGB IN        RoomView   RS 232C     S  SAFETY PRECAUTIONS MESSAGE   SAVE ALL USER DATA    SCHEDULE                  SCREEN 
38.   The  SCHEDULE  screen is displayed     3  Select and assign program to each day of week   e Press A V to select the day of week  and press q gt  to select a program number     You can set the program from No 1 to No 7              indicates that the program number has not been set     How to set a program  Set up to 16 commands to each program   1  Press A V to select  SCHEDULE      2  Press 4b to select  ON   and press the   ENTER  button     The  SCHEDULE  screen is displayed     3  Press A V to select  PROGRAM EDIT    4  Press 4b to select a program number  and press the   ENTER  button     5  Press A V to select a command number  and press the   ENTER  button   e You can change the page using q gt      6  Press A  W 4b to select  TIME   and press the   ENTER  button     7  Press 4b to select    hour    or    minute     and press A or the number   lt 0 gt     lt 9 gt   buttons to set a  time  and then press the   ENTER  button     8  Press A V 4b to select  COMMAND    9  Press 4b to switch the item       The items will switch each time you press the button   e For the detailed settings of  COMMAND   the details set in Step 11  are displayed                        COMMAND  DE COMMAND zu Description   POWER ON      Switches on the projector    STANDBY      Enters standby    SHUTTER   OPEN  Opens the shutter    CLOSE  Closes the shutter              ENGLISH   117    Chapter4 Settings      PROJECTOR SETUP  menu                                                                D
39.   USER2    4  Press the   ENTER  button     The  COLOR TEMPERATURE  screen is displayed   5  Press A V to select  COLOR TEMPERATURE NAME CHANGE    6  Press the   ENTER  button     The  COLOR TEMPERATURE NAME CHANGE  screen is displayed   7  Press A V 4b to select the text  and press the   ENTER  button to enter the text   8  Press A W 4  to select  OK   and press the   ENTER  button     The name set to color temperature is changed   Note      When a name is changed  display of  USER1    USER2  is also changed      GAMMA         b      2 2p b b QD n    You can switch gamma mode     1   2     3     Press A V to select  GAMMA      Press 4P or the   ENTER    button     The  GAMMA  individual adjustment screen is displayed     Press 4P to switch the item     The items will switch each time you press the button                     DEFAULT  Factory default setting     USER1  Allows you to change the name     USER2  Refer to  Changing the name of  USER1  or  USER2      9 page 75  for details    DICOM SIM   The picture becomes similar to that of DICOM standard              74   ENGLISH    Chapter 4 Settings      PICTURE  menu           1 0         1 8  Set so that images become as you like   2 0     2 8  can be set in increments of 0 1                  2 0     2 8   increments of 0 1         1 When  PICTURE MODE  is set to  DYNAMIC    USER   or  DICOM SIM     DEFAULT  cannot be selected     Note      DICOM is an abbreviation of    Digital Imaging and COmmunication in Medicine  and is 
40.   When installing the projector  attach the drop prevention kit included with the Ceiling Mount Bracket for Projectors      Ask a qualified technician to do the installation work such as mounting the projector on the ceiling    e Panasonic takes no responsibility for any damage to the projector resulting from use of a ceiling mount bracket not manufactured by  Panasonic or the inappropriate choice of location for installation  even if the warranty period of the projector has not expired      Unused products must be removed promptly by a qualified technician    Use a torque screwdriver or Allen torque wrench to tighten bolts to their specified tightening torques  Do not use electric screwdrivers or   impact screwdrivers    Read the Installation Instructions for the Ceiling Mount Bracket for Projectors for details    The model numbers of accessories and optional accessories are subject to change without prior notice           Bottom view  Model No  of Ceiling Mount Bracket for Projectors  ET PKD310H  for High Ceilings   ET PKD310S  for Low Ceilings   ET PAD310  Projector ceiling mount bracket                                   00000      000                   p                                     O00 DU    000 00  itt  o D  f o  PT 00 a 00     Sooo P7  a000 l    e e    re    ey                              M6    B 16 mm  5 8                                                                                                                  CY    I L 1                                
41.   terminal   This is the terminal to input video signals     lt 3D SYNC 1 IN OUT gt  terminal    lt 3D SYNC 2 OUT gt  terminal  This is a terminal to input or output control signals when using  the projector in 3D systems     Only for PT DZ13KE  PT DS12KE  PT DW11KE     lt LAN gt  terminal   This is a terminal to connect to the network    Used for control and monitoring  Image input through network  connections is not possible       When a LAN cable is directly connected to the projector  the network connection must be made indoors     ENGLISH   27    Chapter1 Preparation     Using the remote control       Using the remote control       Fig  1 Fig  2    1  Open the cover   Fig  1     2  Insert the batteries and close the cover  insert the    side first    Fig  2     When removing the batteries  perform the steps in reverse order        When you use the system with multiple projectors  you can operate all the projectors simultaneously or each projector individually using single  remote control  if a unique ID number is assigned to each projector   After setting the ID number of the projector  set same ID number on the remote control     The factory default ID number of the projector is set to  ALL   When using a single projector  press the   ID ALL  button on the  remote control  Also  you can control a projector by pressing the   ID ALL   button on the remote control even if you do not know the  projector ID     How to set    1  Press the   ID SET   button on the remote contr
42.   to set zoom ratio  Image can be enlarged or reduced vertically and horizontally at the  same magnification         ON                 7  Press A V to select  VERTICAL  or  HORIZONTAL       f  ON  is selected  select  BOTH      8  Press   4b to adjust     Note    When  ASPECT  is not set to  DEFAULT    MODE  is not displayed      CLOCK PHASE  0 00    You can adjust to achieve an optimal image when there is a flickering image or smeared outlines   1  Press A V to select  CLOCK PHASE      2  Press 4b or the   ENTER    button     The  CLOCK PHASE  individual adjustment screen is displayed     3  Press 4b to adjust       Adjustment value will change between  0  and   31   Adjust so that the amount of interference is at a minimum     Note    Certain signals may not be adjustable    Optimal value may not be achieved if the output from the input computer is unstable    Optimal value may not be achieved when there is a shift in the total dot numbers     CLOCK PHASE  can be adjusted only when a signal is input to the   RGB 1 IN   terminal or the   RGB 2 IN   terminal       CLOCK PHASE  cannot be adjusted when a digital signal is input       f you press  gt  while the adjustment value is   31   the value will become  0   If you press     while the adjustment value is  0   the value will  become   31       GEOMETRY              p   J                   J       Only for PT DZ13KE  PT DS12KE  PT DZ10KE   You can correct various types of distortion in a projected image   Unique image proce
43.   when the   MAIN POWER  switch on the  projector is set to   ON   and in projection mode    2 Power on       button  Starts projection when the   MAIN POWER  switch on the  projector is set to   ON   when the power is switched off   standby mode     3   VIDEO    button  Switches the input to VIDEO    4   RGB1   button  Switches the input to RGB1    5   RGB2   button  Switches the input to RGB2    6  lt DVI D gt  button  Switches the input to DVI D    7  lt HDMI gt  button  Switches the input to HDMI    8   SDI 1 2   button  Switches the input to SDI    Only for PT DZ13KE  PT DS12KE  PT DZ10KE     26   ENGLISH       10    11    12    13    14         MENU  button   Displays or hides the main menu    page 65    Returns to the previous menu when a sub menu is displayed    If you press the   MENU  button on the control panel for at least  three seconds while the on screen display is off  the on screen  display is turned on       LENS  button   Adjusts the focus  zoom  and shift  position  of the lens     ENTER  button   Determines and executes an item in the menu screen    lt SHUTTER  gt  button   Used to temporarily turn off the image    page 61    AV  lt  gt  buttons   Use to select items in the menu screen  change settings  and  adjust levels    Also used to enter a password in  SECURITY  or enter  characters      AUTO SETUP  button   Automatically adjusts the image display position while projecting  the image   PROGRESS  is displayed on the screen while  adjusting automatica
44.  0   C  32   F  and 35   C  95   F   However  it cannot be  used at high altitudes    If you use the Replacement lamp unit  for portrait mode   the operating environment temperature should be between 0   C  32   F  and 40   C   104   F  when using the projector at elevations lower than 1 400 m  4 593   above sea level  and between 0   C  32   F  and 35   C  95   F  when  using the projector at high altitudes  If you use the Smoke cut filter together  the operating environment temperature should be between 0   C  32   F   and 30   C  86   F     If the  PROJECTOR SETUP  menu      LAMP POWER  is set to  HIGH    MIDDLE   or  NORMAL   and an ambient temperature reaches 40   C   104   F  or higher  35   C  95   F  or higher when  HIGH ALTITUDE MODE  is set to  ON  or the Smoke cut filter is used   the light output may  decrease by approx  20   to protect the projector     184   ENGLISH    Chapter6 Appendix     Specifications       B Applicable scanning frequency    Refer to    List of compatible signals    page 179  for the types of video signals that can be used with the projector        For video signal   including Y C signal     For RGB signal    Horizontal  15 75 kHz 15 63 kHz  Vertical  50 Hz 60 Hz    Horizontal  15 kHz to 100 kHz  Vertical  24 Hz to 120 Hz    PIAS  Panasonic Intelligent Auto Scanning  system       Dot clock frequency  162 MHz or less       For YC amp Cg4 YPgP  signal    525i  480i    Horizontal  15 75 kHz  Vertical  60 Hz  525p  480p    Horizontal  31 5 kHz  
45.  10 01   9 90   15 87 1 47 1 47  2 54  100   1 245 2 214 3 08   3 98   3 96   5 76   5 72   11 14   11 01   17 65 1 64 1 64  3 05  120   1 494 2 657 3 71   4 79   4 77   6 94   6 89   13 40   13 25   21 21 1 98 1 99  3 81  150   1 968 3 321 4 66   6 02   5 98   8 70   8 64   16 80   16 60   26 56 2 5 2 50  5 08  200   2 491 4 428 6 24   8 06   8 01   11 64   11 56   22 46   22 19   35 46 3 36 3 36  6 35  250  3 113 5 535 7 82   10 11   10 03   14 58   14 47   28 11   27 77   44 37 4 22 4 22  7 62  300   3 736 6 641 9 40   12 15   12 05   17 51   17 39   33 77   33 36   53 27 5 08 5 08  8 89  350   4 358 7 748 10 98   14 19   14 07   20 45   20 31   39 43   38 95   62 18     5 93  10 16  400   4 981 8 855 12 56   16 23   16 10   23 39   23 23   45 09   44 53   71 09     6 79  12 70  500   6 226 11 069 15 72   20 32   20 14   29 27   29 06   56 40   55 70   88 90     8 51  15 24  600   7 472 13 283   18 88   24 41   24 18   35 15   34 90   67 72   66 88  106 71     10 22  25 40  1000   12 453 22 138   31 53   40 75   40 36   58 65   58 24  112 98 111 56 1177 96     17 09                                            1    The throw ratio is based on the value during projection onto a 3 81 m  150   screen size     ENGLISH   39    Chapter 2 Getting Started     Setting up       For PT DW11KE    B When the screen aspect is 16 9                                                                                                                                                                 
46.  125 09   33 52   33 68   50 53   50 54   84 45   84 45  134 38   134 11  251 62  16 91   20 27  25 40  1000   15 240 20 320 41 86   55 93   56 18   84 29   84 30  140 83  140 83  224 03 223 77        28 22   33 84  Lens type Zoom lens Fixed focus lens  Projection lens Model No  ET D75LE10   ET D75LE20   ET D75LE30   ET D75LE40   ET D75LE5   ET D75LE50  Throw ratio     1 9 2 5 1 2 5 3 6 1 3 6 6 9 1 6 8 10 9 1 1 0 1 1 0 1  Projection screen size Projection distance  L     Height   Min    Max    Min    Max    Min    Max    Min    Max  3 A  Diagonal  SD   SH  Width  SW   LW     LT     Lw     LT     w     LT    w     LT  Fixed Fixed  1 78  70   1 067 1 422 2 69   3 48   3 47   5 05   5 01   9 77   9 66   15 49 1 43 1 44  2 03  80   1 219 1 626 3 09   3 99   3 98   5 78   5 75   11 19   11 06   17 72 1 64 1 65  2 29  90   1 372 1 829 3 49   4 51   4 49   6 52   648   12 61   12 46   19 96 1 86 1 87  2 54  100   1 524 2 032 3 88   5 02   4 99   7 26   7 21   14 03   13 86   22 19 2 08 2 08  3 05  120   1 829 2 438 4 68   6 05   6 01   8 74   8 68   16 87   16 67   26 67 2 51 2 51  3 81  150   2 286 3 048 5 87   7 58   7 53   10 95   10 87   21 13   20 88   33 37 3 16 3 16  5 08  200   3 048 4 064 7 85   10 15   10 07   14 64   14 53   28 23   27 89   44 55 4 24 4 24  6 35  250  3 810 5 080 9 83   12 71   12 61   18 32   18 20   35 33   34 90   55 73 5 32 5 31  7 62  300   4 572 6 096 11 82   15 28   15 15   22 01   21 86   42 43   41 91   66 91 6 40 6 39  8 89  350   5 334 7 112 13
47.  148 5 R YID H S   5   a     y y  2K 24p 2 048 x 1 080 27 0 24 0 74 3 s s              2K 24sF 2 048 x 1 080 27 0 24 0 74 3 s s                      640 x 400 31 5 70 1 25 2 R D H                  VESA400  640 x 400 37 9 85 1 31 5 R D H                    640 x 480 31 5 59 9 25 2 R D H       A y  640 x 480 35 0 66 7 30 2 R D H   ES        VGA480 640 x 480 37 9 72 8 31 5 R D H J       a    640 x 480 37 5 75 0 31 5 R D H  A       V A  640 x 480 43 3 85 0 36 0 R D H                                                                ENGLISH   179    Chapter 6 Appendix     Technical information                                                                                                                                                                Scanning freq  Dot clock Plug and play   Resolution       Mode Horizontal   Vertical freq  Format DVI D   Dots  MH RGB2 HDMI   kHz     Hz   MHz  EDID1   EDID2   EDID3  800 x 600 35 2 56 3 36 0 R D H  4     v v v  800 x 600 37 9 60 3 40 0 R D H  4    4  4  4  SVGA 800 x 600 48 1 72 2 50 0 R D H V      4  4  4  800 x 600 46 9 75 0 49 5 R D H  4      4  4  4  800 x 600 53 7 85 1 56 3 R D H                      MAC16 832 x 624 49 7 74 6 57 3 R D H V      4  4  4  1 024 x 768 39 6 50 0 51 9 R D H                      1 024 x 768 48 4 60 0 65 0 R D H  4      4  4  4  1024 x 768 56 5 70 1 75 0 R D H V      4  4  4  XGA 1 024 x 768 60 0 75 0 78 8 R D H  4     V  4  4  1 024 x 768 65 5 81 6 86 0 R D H                      1024 x 768 68 7 85 0 94 5
48.  168  30  2 E3                       E  prosector2 192  168 30  3 RETURN  PROJECTOR3 192  168 30  4     4  5  r7  8       Display the name of the projector    Display the synchronized group    Display the IP address of the projector    Display the names and IP addresses of projectors in same group detected over the network     ak WN      Display the status by color    Green  There is an allowance for brightness correction   Yellow  There is little allowance for brightness correction   Red  There is a brightness control error     Display error detailed messages     7 Display error messages   When the message  Failed to apply BRIGHTNESS CONTROL to some projectors   appears  it means that synchronization with the  projector displayed in red has failed   Press A to select the projector displayed in red  and press the   ENTER  button to display the error details     8 Update to the latest status information     E Error details       Error message Measures to take     Limit the number of projectors in one group to eight      When synchronizing nine or more projectors  use the dedicated software  Multi Projector  Monitoring  amp  Control Software   through a computer     Please check the COMMAND e Set  NETWORK CONTROL      gt   COMMAND CONTROL  to  ON  for the projector in error    CONTROL setting     Set  NETWORK CONTROL   gt   COMMAND PORT  of all projectors to be linked to the same value     Please check the USER NAME    and PASSWORD in the COMMAND  CONTROL setting       Cannot a
49.  2  Press 4b to switch the item        Menu screen   Entry screen       Menu screen   Left  white   Right  black Select a test pattern so that it is easy to check operations and make adjustments        Menu screen   Left  black   Right  white                Note      The 3D test pattern cannot be displayed when the following inputs are selected     VIDEO input    RGB1 input  only when  RGB IN  is set to  Y C       This is disabled when  3D SYSTEM SETTING  is set to other than  SINGLE       SAFETY PRECAUTIONS MESSAGE                            Set to show or hide the safety precautions message related to 3D viewing when the projector is switched on     1  Press A V to select  SAFETY PRECAUTIONS MESSAGE      2  Press 4b to switch the item     The items will switch each time you press the button         ON  Shows the safety precautions message related to 3D viewing when the projector is switched on    OFF  Hides the safety precautions message related to 3D viewing when the projector is switched on                 Note    e Set to  OFF  to hide the safety precautions message related to 3D viewing when the projector is switched on   e A confirmation screen is displayed when switched from  ON  to  OFF   Press        to select  OK   and press the   ENTER   button to change  the setting to  OFF      Attention      When 3D images are viewed by unspecified number of people for commercial use  display the safety precautions message related to 3D  viewing to notify viewers      SDSAFETY 
50.  2 585 3 32   4 30   4 28   6 22   6 18   12 03   11 89   19 05 1 76 1 78  3 81  150   2 019 3 231 4 18   5 40   5 37   7 81   7 75   15 08   14 90   23 85 2 22 2 24  5 08  200   2 692 4 308 5 60   7 24   7 19   10 45   10 38   20 16   19 92   31 86 2 99 3 01  6 35  250  3 365 5 385 7 02   9 07   9 00   13 09   13 0   25 25   24 95   39 86 3 76 3 78  7 62  300   4 039 6 462 8 44   10 91   10 82   15 73   15 62   30 34   29 97   47 87 4 53 4 56  8 89  350   4 712 7 539 9 86   12 74   12 64   18 37   18 24   35 42   34 99   55 87     5 33  10 16  400   5 385 8 616 11 28   14 58   14 46   21 01   20 86   40 51   40 01   63 87     6 10  12 70  500   6 731 10 770   14 12   18 25   18 09   26 29   26 11   50 68   50 05   79 88     7 64  15 24  600   8 077 12 923   16 96   21 92   21 73   31 58   31 35   60 85   60 09   95 89     9 18  25 40  1000   13 462 21 539   28 33   36 61   36 27   52 70   52 33 1101 53 100 25 159 93     15 35        1 The throw ratio is based on the value during projection onto a 3 81 m  150   screen size     ENGLISH   35    Chapter 2 Getting Started     Setting up       B When the screen aspect is 16 9                                                                                                                                                                                Unit  m   Lens type Zoom lens  Projection lens Model No  ET D75LE1 ET D75LE2   ET D75LE3   ET D75LE4   ET D75LE8   ET D75LE6  Throw ratio     1 4 1 8 1 1 8 2 8 1 2 8 4 6 1 4 6 7 4 1 7 3 
51.  7 62  300   3 736 6 641 8 67   11 21   11 13   16 17   16 06   31 18   30 80   49 20 4 66 4 68  8 89  350   4 358 7 748 10 13   13 10   12 99   18 88   18 75   36 41   35 96   57 43     5 48  10 16  400   4 981 8 855 11 59   14 99   14 86   21 60   21 45   41 64   41 12   65 65     6 27  12 70  500   6 226 11 069 14 51   18 76   18 60   27 03   26 84   52 09   51 44   82 11     7 85  15 24  600   7 472 13 283   17 44   22 54   22 33   32 46   32 23   62 54   61 76   98 56     9 44  25 40  1000   12 453 22 138   29 12   37 63   37 28   54 17   53 79  104 36 103 05 164 38     15 78              1    36   ENGLISH    The throw ratio is based on the value during projection onto a 3 81 m  150   screen size     Chapter 2 Getting Started     Setting up       B When the screen aspect is 4 3                                                                                                                                                                                Unit  m   Lens type Zoom lens  Projection lens Model No  ET D75LE1 ET D75LE2   ET D75LE3   ET D75LE4   ET D75LE8   ET D75LE6  Throw ratio     1 6 2 2 1 2 2 3 3 1 3 3 5 5 1 5 6 8 9 1 8 8 16 5 1 1 1 1 3 1  Projection screen size Projection distance  L   B Height  gt  Min    Max    Min    Max    Min    Max    Min    Max    Min    Max    Min    Max   Diagona   SP     sq WP GV wy   qm   ew     m    aw    ery   ew     LT     QW    or     LW     Lr   1 78  70   1 067 1 422 2 29   3 06   3 09   4 65   4 66   7 83   7 83   12 54   12 
52.  80   17 84   17 68   25 70   25 52   49 53   48 92   78 08     7 47  10 16  400   6 096 8 128 15 78   20 40   20 22   29 39   29 18   56 64   55 93   89 26     8 54  12 70  500   7 620 10 160   19 75   25 53   25 30   36 76   36 50   70 84   69 95   111 62     10 70  15 24  600   9 144 12 192   23 72   30 66   30 38   44 14   43 83   85 04   83 98 1133 97     12 85  25 40  1000   15 240 20 320   39 59   51 17   50 68   73 64   73 12  141 85 140 07 223 40     21 46              1    The throw ratio is based on the value during projection onto a 3 81 m  150   screen size     ENGLISH   41    Chapter 2 Getting Started     Setting up       Formula to calculate projection distance per projection lens    To use a screen size not listed in this manual  check the screen size SD  m  and use the respective formula to calculate projection distance   The unit of all the formulae is m   Values obtained by the following calculation formulae contain a slight error      For PT DZ13KE  PT DZ10KE    E Zoom lens                                                                                                                                           Projection lens Model No  Throw ratio Aspect ratio Projection distance  L  formula  Min   LW  L   1 1732 x SD   0 0760  1 4 to 1 8 1 16 10  Max   LT  L   1 5709 x SD   0 1004  Min   LW  L   1 2087 x SD   0 0760  ET D75LE1 1 4 to 1 8 1 16 9  Max   LT  L   1 6142 x SD   0 1004  Min   LW  L   1 3307 x SD   0 0760  1 6 to 2 2 1 4 3  Max   LT  L   1 7756 x
53.  Chapter 4 Settings      SIGNAL LIST  menu       Sub memory             0 DJ     BDr          The projector has a sub memory function that can register the multiple image adjustment data  even if it is recognized as the same signal by  the frequency or format of the synchronization signal source    Use this function when you need to adjust the picture quality such as switching of the aspect ratio or white balance by the same  synchronization signal source  The sub memory includes all the data that can be adjusted for each signal  such as the screen aspect ratio and  data adjusted in the  PICTURE  item   CONTRAST    BRIGHTNESS   etc       Registering to the sub memory    1     2   3     4     Press q gt  on the normal screen  when the menu is not displayed       The sub memory registration screen is displayed if the sub memory is not registered  Proceed to Step 3       Alist of sub memories registered to the signal currently input is displayed      By selecting  SUB MEMORY  in the  PROJECTOR SETUP  menu      FUNCTION BUTTON   the  lt FUNC gt  button can be used instead  of 4 gt      Press A V 4b to select the sub memory number to register in  SUB MEMORY LIST      Press the   ENTER  button     The  SIGNAL NAME CHANGE  screen is displayed     Press A V 4p to select  OK   and press the   ENTER  button     e To rename the registered signal  follow the procedure in Steps 6  and 7  in    Renaming the registered signal      page 130      Switching to the sub memory    1     2   3    
54.  DDC clock  18  T M D S data 0   lE ni   7  DDC data  19  T M D S data 0 5 shield  8   lt      1  e   e     9  T M D S data 1   21        10  T M D S clock1   22  T M D S clock shield   11  T M D S data 1 3 shield  23  T M D S clock    12       24  T M D S clock           For  lt HDMLIN gt   lt DVI D _IN gt   lt VIDEO IN   terminals          o0    j    BO  DVD player with HDMI terminal  HDCP                                                            I  Ey  XZSIUR                                uc   oxen    Blu ray disc player VCR  with built in TBC     Attention      Always use one of the following when connecting a VCR     AVCR with built in time base corrector  TBC     Atime base corrector  TBC  between the projector and the VCR      f nonstandard burst signals are connected  the image may be distorted  In such case  connect the time base corrector  TBC  between the  projector and the external devices     Note    e When entering DVI D  some external devices to be connected may require switching the setting using the  DISPLAY OPTION  menu  gt    DVI D IN       EDID       The   DVI D IN   terminal can be connected to HDMI  or DVI D compliant devices  However  images may not appear or may not be  displayed properly on some devices      For an HDMI cable  use an HDMI High Speed cable that conforms to HDMI standards  If a cable that does not conform to HDMI standards  is used  images may be interrupted or may not be displayed      The   HDMI IN  terminal of the projector can be 
55.  ENTER  button     The  COLOR TEMPERATURE  individual adjustment screen is displayed     3  Press 4b to select an item other than  DEFAULT    USER1   or  USER2      ENGLISH   73    Chapter 4 Settings      PICTURE  menu       4  Press the  lt ENTER gt  button     The  CHANGE TO        screen is displayed   5  Press A V to select  USER1  or  USER2      The status of the color temperature changed is saved to the selected item   6  Press the   ENTER  button     The confirmation screen is displayed   7  Press 4b to select  OK   and press the   ENTER  button     The  USER1  or  USER2  data is overwritten      f you press 4P to select  CANCEL  and then press the   ENTER  button  the data will not be overwritten     The  WHITE BALANCE HIGH  screen is displayed   8  Press A V to select  RED    GREEN   or  BLUE    9  Press 4b to adjust the level   Note      Adjust  COLOR TEMPERATURE  correctly  All colors will not be displayed properly unless adequate adjustment is made  If the adjustment  does not look suitable  you can press the   DEFAULT  button on the remote control to return the setting for the selected item only to the  factory default setting      When color temperature has been changed  the colors before and after the change will differ slightly     Changing the name of  USER1  or  USER2     1  Press A V to select  COLOR TEMPERATURE    2  Press 4b or the   ENTER    button     The  COLOR TEMPERATURE  individual adjustment screen is displayed   3  Press q gt  to select  USER1  or
56.  Is the  DVI D IN  setting  EDID3   EDID2 PC   101  eal Ma UR aaah e The graphics accelerator driver of the computer may need to be updated to the  appear  latest version    e The computer may need to be restarted after performing the  DVI D IN  setting  101  Video from HDMI    s the HDMI cable connected securely  48  compatible device does   Turn the power of the projector and the external device off and on     not appear or it appears  jumbled  e Is a signal which is not compatible with the projector being input  179  Cannot control the   Is  Art Net SETUP  set to an item other than  OFF   138  projector with Art Net    Are the  NET    SUB NET    UNIVERSE   and  START ADDRESS  settings correct  138       166   ENGLISH       Chapter 5 Maintenance     Troubleshooting             Problems Points to be checked Page    Is the  3D INPUT FORMAT  setting of  3D SETTINGS  correct  92  3D function is not working      Check the 3D eyewear settings          s a signal which is supported by the projector being input  181       Left and right images are   Are the devices synchronized  Check the 3D eyewear settings       reversed  not showing       properly     Change the  LEFT RIGHT SWAP  setting of  3D SETTINGS   93  image inthe3D eyewear e Are you within the reception range       flickers          Are batteries of the 3D eyewear drained  If you use the rechargeable 3D eyewear   charge it  If you use the battery powered 3D eyewear  replace the battery        s the  3D SETTINGS  setting 
57.  L   1 6324 x SD   0 0832  1 8 to 2 7 1 16 9  Max   LT  L   2 3720 x SD   0 1162  ET D75LE20    Min   LW  L   1 9986 x SD   0 0832  2 5 to 3 6 1 4 3  Max   LT  L   2 9040 x SD   0 1162  Min   LW  L   2 3550 x SD   0 1131  2 7 to 5 2 1 16 9  Max   LT  L   4 5673 x SD   0 1765  ET D75LE30    Min   LW  L   2 8833 x SD   0 1131  3 6 to 6 9 1 4 3  Max   LT  L   5 5917 x SD   0 1765  Min   LW  L   4 5092 x SD   0 1577  5 1 to 8 2 1 16 9  Max   LT  L 7 7 1891 x SD   0 1615  ET D75LE40    Min   LW  L   5 5206 x SD   0 1577  6 8 to 10 9 1 4 3  Max   LT  L   8 8016 x SD   0 1615                      E Fixed focus lens                      Projection lens Model No  Throw ratio Aspect ratio Projection distance  L  formula  0 8 1 16 9 L 7 0 6929 x SD   0 0835  ET D75LE5  1 0 1 4 3 L   0 8504 x SD   0 0835  0 8 1 16 9 L 7 0 6925 x SD   0 0713  ET D75LE50  1 0 1 4 3 L 7 0 8479 x SD   0 0713                      Install the projector on a flat surface so that the front of the projector is parallel to the screen surface and the projection screen is rectangular     If the screen is tilted downward  the projection screen can be adjusted to be rectangular by adjusting the front adjustable feet  The adjustable  feet can also be used to adjust the projector to be level when it is tilted in the horizontal direction     Extend the adjustable feet by rotating in the direction shown in the figure and retract by rotating in the opposite direction           Adjustable amount  J Front adjustable feet  Ap
58.  MONITOR    Displays the waveform of the input signal     LENS    Adjusts the projection lens     TEST PATTERN    Displays the test pattern     GET OSD    Updates the on screen display of the projector at the right of the  control page     ENGLISH   145    Chapter 4 Settings      NETWORK  menu        Network config  page    Click  Detailed set up       Network config      Click  Network config  to display the  CAUTION   screen       The current settings are displayed by pressing the  Next  button       Click  Change  to display the setting change screen     4d rent 82 168  8j  ben ei ri fpegee I X   a erepto conem          PROJECTOR NAME                                                                                     1  PROJECTOR NAME   Enter the name of the projector  Enter the host name if it is  required when using a DHCP server etc     2  DHCP ON   DHCP OFF    To enable the DHCP client function  set to  DHCP ON    3  IP ADDRESS    Enter the IP address when not using a DHCP server     4  SUBNET MASK   Enter the subnet mask when not using a DHCP server     5  DEFAULT GATEWAY   Enter the default gateway address when not using a DHCP  server     Note        DNS1    Enter the DNS1 server address    Permissible characters for the entry of DNS1 server address   primary     Numbers  0   9   period        Example  192 168 0 253      DNS2    Enter the DNS2 server address    Available characters for the entry of DNS2 server address   secondary     Numbers  0   9   period        E
59.  OPTION  menu      ON SCREEN DISPLAY       OSD DESIGN   The selected  item is displayed with the yellow cursor by the factory default       n the portrait setting  the menu is displayed sideways     Resetting adjustment values to the factory default    If the   DEFAULT  button on the remote control is pressed  the values adjusted in the menu items are restored to the factory default settings     button    1  Press the   DEFAULT  button on the remote control     CONTRAST EE E gt    lt  gt  ADJUST    Note      You cannot reset all the settings to the factory default at a time    e To reset all the settings adjusted in the sub menu item to the factory default one at a time  execute  PROJECTOR SETUP  menu  gt    INITIALIZE    page 125     e Some items cannot be reset by pressing the   DEFAULT  button  Adjust each item manually      The triangular mark under the bar scale in the individual adjustment screen indicates the factory default setting  The position of the triangular  mark varies according to the selected input signals     Current adjustment value  Factory default setting   The following items are in the main menu    When a main menu item is selected  the screen changes to a sub menu selection screen                                      Main menu item Page   3  PICTURE  71  IE  POSITION  79     ADVANCED MENU  85         DISPLAY LANGUAGE  90  e   3D SETTINGS   91   g  DISPLAY OPTION  96             66   ENGLISH    Chapter 4 Settings     Menu navigation                     
60.  Press q gt  on the normal screen  when the menu is not displayed      Alist of sub memories registered to the signal currently input is displayed     Press A V 4b to select the signal to switch in  SUB MEMORY LIST    Press the   ENTER  button       This switches to the signal selected in Step 2      Deleting the sub memory    1     2     3     Press q gt  on the normal screen  when the menu is not displayed      The  SUB MEMORY LIST  screen is displayed     Press A V 4  to select the sub memory to delete  and press the   DEFAULT  button       The  REGISTERED SIGNAL DELETE  screen is displayed   e To cancel the deletion  press the   MENU  button to return to the  SUB MEMORY LIST  screen     Press the   ENTER  button       The selected sub memory will be deleted     132   ENGLISH    Chapter 4 Settings      SECURITY  menu     SECURITY  menu    On the menu screen  select  SECURITY  from the main menu  and select an item from the sub   menu   Refer to    Navigating through the menu    page 65  for the operation of the menu screen     When the projector is used for the first time  Initial password  Press A gt  W 4 AP w 4 in order  and press the   ENTER    button   e After selecting the item  press A V   b to set                          Attention      When you select the  SECURITY  menu and press the   ENTER  button  entering a password is required  Enter the preset password and  then continue operations of the  SECURITY  menu   e When the password has been changed previously  ent
61.  R D H                1 024 x 768 81 4 100 0 113 3 R D H 7                      1 024 x 768 98 8 120 0 139 1 R D H 7 V      4  4  4  1152x 864 53 7 60 0 81 6 R D H                      1152x 864 64 0 70 0 94 2 R D H                MXGA  1 152 x 864 67 5 74 9 108 0 R D H             M  1152x864 76 7 85 0 121 5 R D H                MAC21 1 152 x 870 68 7 75 1 100 0 R D H  4      4 v  4  1 280 x 720 37 1 49 8 60 5 R D H                  1 280 x 720 44 8 59 9 74 5 R D H           LI  1280 x 720  1 280 x 720 76 3 100 0 131 8 R D H 7                1 280 x 720 92 6 120 0 161 6 R D H 7                1 280 x 768 39 6 49 9 65 3 R D H                      1 280 x 768 47 8 59 9 79 5 R D H                      1280 x 768 1 280 x 768 8 47 4 60 0 68 3 R D H                    1 280 x 768 60 3 74 9 102 3 R D H                      1 280 x 768 68 6 84 8 117 5 R D H       a    1 280 x 800 41 3 50 0 68 0 R D H            1 280 x 800 49 7 59 8 83 5 R D H                    1280 x 800 1 280 x 800  8 49 3 59 9 71 0 R D H                      1 280 x 800 62 8 74 9 106 5 R D H                      1 280 x 800 71 6 84 9 122 5 R D H                      MSXGA 1 280 x 960 60 0 60 0 108 0 R D H                      1 280 x 1 024 52 4 50 0 88 0 R D H                  1 280 x 1 024 64 0 60 0 108 0 R D H  4      4  4  4  1 280 x 1 024 72 3 66 3 125 0 R D H                      SXGA  1 280 x 1 024 78 2 72 0 135 1 R D H                      1 280 x 1 024 80 0 75 0 135 0 R D H  4    4 v v  1 280 x 1 024 91 
62.  SD   0 1004  Min   LW  L   1 5748 x SD   0 0795  1 8 to 2 8 1 16 10  Max   LT  L   2 3661 x SD   0 1064  Min   LW  L 7 1 6220 x SD   0 0795  ET D75LE2 1 8 to 2 8 1 16 9  Max   LT  L   2 4291 x SD   0 1064  Min   LW  L   1 7835 x SD   0 0795  2 2 to 3 3 1 4 3  Max   LT  L   2 6772 x SD   0 1064  Min   LW  L   2 3661 x SD   0 0958  2 8 to 4 6 1 16 10  Max   LT  L   3 9488 x SD   0 1216  Min   LW  L   2 4291 x SD   0 0958  ET D75LE3 2 8 to 4 6 1 16 9  Max   LT  L 7 4 0591 x SD   0 1216  Min   LW  L   2 6772 x SD   0 0958  3 3 to 5 5 1 4 3  Max   LT  L   4 4724 x SD   0 1216  Min   LW  L   3 9488 x SD   0 1158  4 6 to 7 4 1 16 10  Max   LT  L 7 6 2795 x SD   0 1013  Min   LW  L   4 0591 x SD   0 1158  ET D75LE4 4 6 to 7 4 1 16 9  Max   LT  L 7 6 4528 x SD   0 1013  Min   LW  L   4 4724 x SD   0 1158  5 6 to 8 9 1 4 3  Max   LT  L  7 1102 x SD   0 1013  Min   LW  L   6 2795 x SD   0 3862  7 3 to 13 8 1 16 10  Max   LT  L   11 7677 x SD   0 3598  Min   LW  L   6 4567 x SD   0 3862  ET D75LE8 7 3 to 13 8 1 16 9  Max   LT  L   12 0945 x SD   0 3598  Min   LW  L  7 1102 x SD   0 3862  8 8 to 16 5 1 4 3  Max   LT  L   13 3189 x SD   0 3598  Min   LW  L   0 7913 x SD   0 0566  0 9 to 1 1 1 16 10  Max   LT  L   0 9488 x SD   0 0736  Min   LW  L   0 8150 x SD   0 0566  ET D75LE6 0 9 to 1 1 1 16 9  Max   LT  L   0 9764 x SD   0 0736  Min   LW  L 7 0 8976 x SD   0 0566  1 1 to 1 3 1 4 3  Max   LT  L   1 0748 x SD   0 0736  Min   LW  L   1 1186 x SD   0 0857  1 3 to 1 7 1 16 10  Max   LT  L
63.  SS                 S  1280 x 768 1 280 x 768 47 8 59 9 79 5 JE pomo mee  em omis      m   me  l  1 280 x 7687  47 4 60 0 68 3 j me   o l l me e cee  ie mm ee  1 280 x 800 41 3 50 0 68 0 4   f  f         SS         SS  HS      1280 x 800 1 280 x 800 49 7 59 8 83 5 V                                           1 280 x 8007 49 3 59 9 71 0 4 l               l e jej jelj jel el el l ese  MSXGA 1 280 x 960 60 0 60 0 108 0 4 l   s     ee ef eee ee   ee   eee  m  1 280 x 1 024 52 4 50 0 88 0 las md    m e  ee  RS  SXGA  1 280 x 1 024 64 0 60 0 108 0 Vom S   f Sf     ES     HS     1 366 x 768 47 7 59 8 85 5 Sf p   S   f ES S   Sf HS   HY SE  1366 x 768  1 366 x 768 39 6 49 9 69 0                               Ext  1 400 x 1 050 54 1 50 0 99 9 Je ee eem eeJ   euw  iw  l   1 400 x 1 050 64 0 60 0 108 0 Jem os   cee  ee RR mee   KY cme  SXGA   1 400 x 1 050 65 2 60 0 122 6 So           fj HS  S   HS Vv   KS  1 400 x 1 050 65 3 60 0 121 8 S  S    SS SS E   HS P  1 440 x 900 55 9 59 9 106 5 vC mS S  me ts m m e  om    mm  WXGA   1 440 x 900 46 3 49 9 86 8 Fy  ee end lll ee De  UXGA60 1 600 x 1 200 75 0 60 0 162 0 EIE ee  ee ee  m  s         1 680 x 1 050 65 3 60 0 146 3  MEME EE Er  WSXGA   1 680 x 1 050 54 1 50 0 119 5 s   ee p eme  1 920 x 1 080 55 6 49 9 141 5 f               f SS Ss S    je  1920 x 1080  1 920 x 1 08072 66 6 59 9 138 5 vom    m m cms   iS m m S   m  1 920 x 1 200 61 8 49 9 158 3 V                        i    iv   wxv       WUXGA  1 920 x 1 2007  74 0 60 0 154 0 Vi      
64.  Select  RGB  or  YPsPl         lt HDMI IN  terminal    480i  576i  480p  or 576p  signal    Select  AUTO    RGB   or  YC amp C4         Other movie based signals    Select  AUTO    RGB   or  YP amp P          lt SDI IN 1   terminal   lt SDI  IN 2   terminal  only for  PT DZ13KE  PT DS12KE     Single link    During SDI1  SDI  input  select  AUTO    480i YCsCp    576i  YCaC4    720 50p YPgP4    720 60p YPsPp    1035 60i YPsPal    1080 24p YPgP4    1080 24sF YPgPpl   1080 25p YPaPpl    1080 30p YP amp P4    1080 50i YP amp P4    1080 60i YP Ppl    1080 50p YPgPal   1080 60p YPgPal   1080 24p RGB     1080 24sF RGB    1080 25p RGB    1080 30p RGB     1080 50i RGB   or  1080 60i RGB     During SDI2 input  select  AUTO    480i YCgCal   576i  YCsCp    720 50p YPgP4    720 60p YP amp P    1035 60i YPaP      1080 24p YP Ppl   1080 24sF YPgPpl   1080 25p YPP     1080 30p YPgPal   1080 50i YPgP    or  1080 60i YPsPp         Dual link       Select  AUTO    1080 24p RGB    2K 24p RGB    2K 24p XYZ     1080 24sF RGB    2K 24sF RGB    2K 24sF XYZ    1080 25p RGB     1080 30p RGB    1080 50i RGB   or  1080 60i RGB          lt SDI IN  terminal  only for  PT DZ10KE           Select  AUTO    480i YCgCl   576i YCaCa    720 50p YPgPg    720 60p YPsPp    1035 60i YPsPal    1080 24p YPgPpl   1080 24sF YP amp P    1080 25p YP amp P    1080 30p YPgPpl   1080 50i YPgP     1080 60i YP amp P    1080 50p YP amp P    1080 60p YP amp P4    1080 24p RGB    1080 24sF RGB     1080 25p RGB    1080 30p RGB    1
65.  The  NETWORK STATUS  screen is displayed     Make settings to use the Art Net function     1  Press A V to select  Art Net SETUP      2  Press 4b to select an item     The items will switch each time you press the button                        OFF  Disables the Art Net function    ON 2 X X X   Enables the Art Net function and sets the IP address to 2 X X X    ON 10 X X X   Enables the Art Net function and sets the IP address to 10 X X X    ON MANUAL   Enables the Art Net function and uses the IP address set in  NETWORK SETUP              When an item other than  OFF  is selected  proceed to Step 3      3  Press the   ENTER  button     The  Art Net SETUP  screen is displayed     4  Press A V to select an item  and press q gt  to switch the setting                        NET  Enter  NET  to be used when the projector processes Art Net    SUB NET  Enter  SUB NET  to be used when the projector processes Art Net    UNIVERSE  Enter  UNIVERSE  to be used when the projector processes Art Net    START ADDRESS  Enter  START ADDRESS  to be used when the projector processes Art Net        5  Press A V to select  STORE   and press the   ENTER  button   6  When the confirmation screen is displayed  press 4P to select  OK   and press the   ENTER  button   Note      When  ON 2 X X X   or  ON 10 X X X   is selected  the IP address is searched and set automatically    Network connections           1 1 0  The projector has a network function  and the following operations are available from the
66.  The clock phase may shift even if it has completed without any incident  In such cases  adjust the  POSITION  menu      CLOCK PHASE    9 page 81     e  f an image with blurred edges or a dark image is input   INCOMPLETE  may appear or adjustment may not be performed properly even   when  COMPLETE  appears  In this case  adjust the settings in the  ADVANCED MENU  menu      INPUT RESOLUTION   9 page 86      POSITION       CLOCK PHASE   9 page 81   and  SHIFT    page 79     Adjust special signals according to the  DISPLAY OPTION  menu      AUTO SETUP   9 page 98     Automatic adjustment may not work depending on the model of the computer    Automatic adjustment may not work for a synchronization signal of C SY or SYNC ON GREEN    Images may be disrupted for a few seconds during automatic adjustment  but it is not a malfunction    Adjustment is required for each input signal    Automatic adjustment can be canceled by pressing the   MENU  button during the automatic adjustment operation    If the automatic setup function is used while moving images are being input  the adjustment may not be performed properly even for an RGB   signal that can use automatic setup   INCOMPLETE  may appear  or adjustment may not be finished properly even if  COMPLETE  appears      P IN P    SSUB MEMORY    SYSTEM SELECTOR    SYSTEM DAYLIGHT VIEW    FREEZE     WAVEFORM MONITOR    LENS MEMORY    LOAD   or  LEFT RIGHT SWAP  operations can be assigned to the  lt FUNC gt  button on the remote control so t
67.  The projector identifies the video ID  VID  embedded in the video signals and displays the image by    VID AUTO   automatically switching the screen sizes between 4 3 and 16 9  This function is effective for NTSC  signals   The projector identifies the video ID  VID  embedded in the video signals and displays the image by    AUTO   automatically switching the screen sizes between 4 3 and 16 9  This function is effective for 480i 480p   signals     THROUGH  Displays images without changing the resolution of the input signals     16 9  Displays images with the aspect ratio converted to 16 9 when standard signals are input    Display    images without changing the aspect ratio when wide screen signals are input        Displays images without changing the aspect ratio when standard signals are input   s  Displays images   4 3  without changing the aspect ratio so that the images will fit in the 4 3 screen when wide screen  signals are input           Displays images using the entire width of the screen  When signals have the aspect ratio vertically   H FIT  longer than the aspect ratio of the screen selected in  SCREEN FORMAT   the images are displayed  with the top and bottom parts cut off     Displays images using the entire height of the screen range selected in  SCREEN FORMAT   When   V FIT  signals have the aspect ratio horizontally longer than the aspect ratio of the screen selected in   SCREEN FORMAT   the images are displayed with the right and left parts cut off     Dis
68.  computer using the web control    e Setting and adjustment of the projector     Display of the projector status   e Sending of E mail messages when there is a problem with the projector   The projector supports    Crestron RoomView    and the following application software of Crestron Electronics  Inc  can be used      RoomView Express    e Fusion RV    RoomView Server Edition    Attention    When a LAN cable is directly connected to the projector  the network connection must be made indoors   Note    e    Crestron RoomView    is a system of Crestron Electronics  Inc  that collectively manages and controls devices on multiple systems  connected to a network using a computer     For details of  Crestron RoomView   refer to the website of Crestron Electronics  Inc   English only   URL http   www crestron com  To download    RoomView Express   go to the following website of Crestron Electronics  Inc   English only   URL http   www crestron com getroomview    ALAN cable is required to use the network function     138   ENGLISH       Chapter 4 Settings      NETWORK  menu       E Example of a normal network connection    Computer    Projector                                                                                                       LAN cable  straight  LAN cable  straight     Hub       A web browser is required to use this function  Confirm that the web browser can be used beforehand    Compatible OS  Windows XP Windows Vista Windows 7 Windows 8  Mac OS X v10 4 v10 5 v1
69.  control wired  B terminal             Connecting terminals    Attention      Use a cable that is 15 m  49 2   or shorter  with 2 core shield  The remote control may not operate when the length of the cable exceeds  15 m  49 2   or when the shielding of the cable is inadequate     ENGLISH   29    Chapter 2 Getting Started       This chapter describes things you need to do before using the projector such as the setup and connections     30   ENGLISH    Chapter 2 Getting Started     Setting up       Setting up       There are six ways to set up the projector  Set the  PROJECTOR SETUP  menu      PROJECTION METHOD   9 page 109  depending  on the installation location  Set  COOLING CONDITION    page 110  to  AUTO   Using the projector with  COOLING CONDITION  set    incorrectly may shorten the life of the lamp     Mounting on the ceiling and projecting forward          Setting on a desk floor and projecting from rear   Using the translucent screen              Menu item             Method Menu item Method   PROJECTION METHOD   FRONT CEILING   PROJECTION METHOD   REAR FLOOR    COOLING CONDITION   CEILING SETTING   COOLING CONDITION   FLOOR SETTING           Mounting on the ceiling and projecting from rear   Using the translucent screen        Setting on a desk floor and projecting forward          Menu item   PROJECTION METHOD     Method   REAR CEILING        Menu item   PROJECTION METHOD     Method   FRONT FLOOR         COOLING CONDITION   CEILING SETTING         COOLING CONDITION
70.  e Some items in  SIGNAL INFORMATION  may be displayed and others not displayed  depending on the signal being input       f you attach a lamp unit used in a projector of a model different from the projector  PT DZ13KE  PT DS12KE  PT DW11KE  PT DZ10KE   to the projector  or when the lamp unit used in the projector to a projector of a different model  the  lighting time  and  runtime  displayed in   STATUS  may differ from the actual time     A function that automatically switches the power source of the projector to standby if there is no input signal for a certain period of time  The  time before switching to standby can be set     1  Press AY to select  NO SIGNAL SHUT OFF    2  Press 4b to switch the item       The items will switch each time you press the button         DISABLE    10MIN      90MIN      Disables the No signal shut off function                 Allows you to set in ten minutes intervals        ENGLISH   121    Chapter4 Settings      PROJECTOR SETUP  menu    TREMOTE2 MODE    J                         You can set the  lt REMOTE 2 IN  terminal        1  Press A V to select  REMOTE2 MODE    2  Press 4b to switch the item       The items will switch each time you press the button                        DEFAULT  The pin assignment of the  lt REMOTE 2 IN   terminal is used by the factory default setting of the  projector    USER  Used to change the setting of the  lt REMOTE 2 IN  terminal    L6500 SERIES  The setting of  lt REMOTE 2 IN   terminal is used for the L65
71.  item            ON    OFF        Returns the response when the ID setting is GROUP   Does not return the response when the ID setting is GROUP        Note      Refer to     lt SERIAL IN gt   lt SERIAL OUT gt  terminal    page 173       STATUS  yyy    Display the status of the projector     1  Press AY to select  STATUS      2     Press the   ENTER  button       The  STATUS  screen is displayed     3  Press 4b to switch the pages       The page will change each time you press the button         INPUT     Displays the input terminal currently selected         BACKUP INPUT STATUS     Displays whether switching to the backup input signal is possible or not when  BACKUP INPUT  MODE  is set to  ON    1   or  2     amp  page 99                     SIGNAL NAME  Displays the input signal name    SIGNAL FREQUENCY  Displays the frequency of the input signal    PROJECTOR RUNTIME  Displays the operation times of the projector    LAMP1   Displays the runtime and status of Lamp 1    LAMP2   Displays the runtime and status of Lamp 2    INTAKE AIR TEMP   Displays the status of the air intake temperature of the projector         OPTICS MODULE TEMP     Displays the status of the internal temperature of the projector         AROUND LAMP TEMP      Displays the status of the temperature around the lamps of the projector         PROJECTOR TYPE     Displays the type of the projector         SERIAL NUMBER     Displays the serial number of the projector         LAMP UNIT MODEL NO      Displays the mo
72.  last    VIDEO  Sets the input to VIDEO    RGB1  Sets the input to RGB1           118   ENGLISH    Chapter 4 Settings      PROJECTOR SETUP  menu                          RGB2  Sets the input to RGB2    DVI D  Sets the input to DVI D    HDMI  Sets the input to HDMI    SDH    SDI   Sets the input to SDI SDI1    SDI2 t Sets the input to SDI2               1 Only for PT DZ13KE  PT DS12KE   2 Onlyfor PT DZ10KE    Note      When  BACKUP INPUT MODE  in the  DISPLAY OPTION  menu      BACKUP INPUT SETTING    page 99  has been set to  ON  or   1   and the projector has been turned off with the input set to HDMI  projection will start with the DVI D input  even when  STARTUP INPUT  SELECT  is set to  LAST USED     e When  BACKUP INPUT MODE  in the  DISPLAY OPTION  menu      BACKUP INPUT SETTING    page 99  has been set to  2   and the  projector has been turned off with the input set to SDI2  projection will start with the SDI1 input  even when  STARTUP INPUT SELECT  is  set to  LAST USED      Set the communication conditions of the   SERIAL IN gt   lt SERIAL OUT gt  terminal     Setting the communication condition of the   SERIAL IN   terminal    1  Press AY to select  RS 232C      2  Press the   ENTER  button     The  RS 232C  screen is displayed     3  Press A V to select   IN  BAUDRATE    4  Press 4b to switch the item       The items will switch each time you press the button         9600    19200  Select the proper speed    38400                    5  Press A V to select   IN  PAR
73.  length 9 bytes 1 byte 1 byte 1 byte    Mode  0   Non protect mode  Command transmission method  Transmit using the following command formats   B Transmitted data  r Termination  Header Data section  symbol  Command    0    0 Control command  CR   example 0x30 0x30  ASCII string  Ox0d  Data length 1 byte 1 byte Undefined length 1 byte  E Received data  1 Termination  Header Data section  symbol  Command    0    0 Control command  CR   example 0x30 0x30  ASCII string  Ox0d  Data length 1 byte 1 byte Undefined length 1 byte                      172   ENGLISH             Chapter 6 Appendix     Technical information       B Error response                                        String Details Termination  symbol     ERR1    Undefined control command     ERR2    Out of parameter range     ERR3    Busy state or no acceptable period  CR   Message       ERR4  Timeout or no acceptable period Ox0d   ERR5  Wrong data length   ERRA  Password mismatch  Data length 4 bytes     1 byte       SSERIALINZ SSERIAL OUT   terminal            The   SERIAL IN gt   lt SERIAL OUT gt  terminal of the projector conforms with RS 232C so that the projector can be connected to and controlled    from a computer     Connection    Q Single projector    Projector connecting terminals          D Sub 9p  female     Qisses o    D Sub 9p  male           D Sub 9p  male       Multiple projectors                Connecting terminals on projector 1    Computer                 Communication cable  straight     Connecting
74.  lens memory of the zoom position does not operate    When  LENS MEMORY LOAD  is assigned to the  lt FUNC gt  button  the lens memory is loaded in order each time you press the  lt FUNC gt   button     Deleting a lens memory    1   2   3   4     5   6     7   8     Press A V to select  LENS MEMORY    Press the   ENTER  button   Press AY to select  LENS MEMORY EDIT      Press the   ENTER  button     The  LENS MEMORY EDIT  screen is displayed     Press A V to select  LENS MEMORY DELETE      Press the   ENTER  button     The  LENS MEMORY DELETE  screen is displayed     Press A WV to select the item to delete  and press the   ENTER  button     When the confirmation screen is displayed  press 4P to select  OK   and press the   ENTER  button     Changing the lens memory name    1   2   3   4     Press A V to select  LENS MEMORY    Press the   ENTER  button   Press A V to select  LENS MEMORY EDIT      Press the   ENTER  button     The  LENS MEMORY EDIT  screen is displayed     124   ENGLISH    Chapter 4 Settings      PROJECTOR SETUP  menu       5   6     7     8   9     Press A V to select  LENS MEMORY NAME CHANGE      Press the   ENTER  button     The  LENS MEMORY NAME CHANGE  screen is displayed     Press A V to select the name to change  and press the   ENTER  button     The  LENS MEMORY NAME INPUT  screen is displayed     Press A VW 4b to select the text  and press the   ENTER  button to enter the text     After the name is changed  press A W   b to select  OK   and press the   
75.  lit or flashing after taking the preceding measures  ask your dealer for repair     158   ENGLISH    Chapter 5 Maintenance     Lamp temperature filter indicators       Temperature indicator  lt TEMP gt             EE Flashing in red Flashing in red  Indicator status Lighting in red  2 times   3 times   Status Warm up status Internal temperature is high   Internal temperature is high   The cooling fan has    warning    standby status   stopped           e Did you turn on the power         Is the air intake exhaust port blocked   when the temperature       Cause was low  around 0   C   Is the room temperature high        32  F      s the filter indicator   FILTER  lit           Remove any objects that are blocking the air intake     Wait at least five minutes exhaust port   in the current Status    Install the projector in a location with an ambient    a  E SOR Vn  Solution   Install the projector in a temperature of 0   C  32   F  to 45   C  113  F    switch to     9 page 55   and  consult your dealer     location with an ambient  temperature of 0   C   32   F  to 45   C  113   F  1       Do not use the projector at high altitudes of 2 700 m   8 858   or higher above sea level     Clean or replace the air filter unit    page 160                     1 When using the projector at high altitudes  1 400 m  4 593   or higher     lower than 2 700 m  8 858   above sea level   the operating environment  temperature should be between 0   C  32   F  and 40   C  104   F    If you use th
76.  optional                             32  Screen size and throw distance    32  Adjusting adjustable feet    45   Attaching removing the projection lens   optional     46  Attaching the projection lens    46  Removing the projection lens    46   Connecting    cioe reto ian Debet 48  Before connecting    sss 48  Connecting example  AV equipment                        49  Connecting example  Computers                  50    12   ENGLISH    Be sure to read  Read this first   from page 2     Chapter 3 Basic Operations   Switching on off the projector    52  Connecting the power cord    52  Power indicator    52  Switching on the projector    53  Making adjustments and selections                            54  Switching off the projector    55  Direct power off function    55   Projecting                  sss 56  Selecting the input signal    56  Adjusting the focus  zoom  and shift                        56  Moving the lens to the home position                        57  Adjustment range by the lens position shift    optical shift     57  Adjusting the lens mounter when the focus is  unbalanced                 sss 58   Operating with the remote control    61  Using the shutter function    61  Using the on screen display function                          61  Switching the input signal    62  Using the Status function    62  Using the Automatic setup function                           62  Using the Function button    63  Displaying the internal test pattern    63  Changing the pict
77.  p  female     RGB signal    YPgP5 signal    0 7 V  p p  75 Q  SYNC ON GREEN  1 0 V  p p  75 Q     SYNC HD TTL high impedance  automatic positive negative  polarity compatible    VD TTL high impedance  automatic positive negative  polarity compatible    Y  1 0 V  p p  including synchronization signal  PgPp  0 7 V  p p  75 Q        lt DVI D IN  terminal    1 set  DVI D 24 p  single link  DVI 1 0 compliant  HDCP compatible        lt HDMI IN  terminal    1 set  HDMI 19 pin  HDCP compatible  Deep Color compatible        lt VIDEO IN gt  terminal    1 set  BNC 1 0 V  p p  75 Q        lt SDI IN 1 gt  terminal  Only for  PT DZ13KE  PT DS12KE     SDI IN   terminal  Only for  PT DZ10KE     1 set  BNC    SD SDI signal  HD SDI signal  3G SDI signal    Dual link HD SDI   LINK A  signal     SMPTE ST 259 compliant  SMPTE ST 292 compliant  SMPTE ST 424 compliant    SMPTE ST 372 compliant        lt SDI IN 2 gt  terminal   Only for PT DZ13KE   PT DS12KE     1 set  BNC   SD SDI signal  HD SDI signal    Dual link HD SDI   LINK B  signal    SMPTE ST 259 compliant  SMPTE ST 292 compliant    SMPTE ST 372 compliant        lt 3D SYNC 1 IN OUT gt  terminal   Only for PT DZ13KE   PT DS12KE  PT DW11KE     1 set  BNC   During input setting  During output setting    TTL high impedance  TTL output  Maximum 10 mA         3D SYNC 2 OUT gt  terminal   Only for PT DZ13KE   PT DS12KE  PT DW11KE     SERIAL IN      SERIAL OUT    terminal    1 set  BNC     TTL output  Maximum 10 mA    D Sub 9 p  1 set each  RS 232
78.  select  OK   and press the   ENTER  button     Note    When a button operation is performed on the device set to  DISABLE   the  CONTROL DEVICE PASSWORD  screen is displayed   Enter the control device password       The  CONTROL DEVICE PASSWORD  screen will disappear when there is no operation for approx  10 seconds   e  f the operations of both  CONTROL PANEL  and  REMOTE CONTROL  are set to  DISABLE   the projector cannot be turned off  cannot  enter standby      When the setting has completed  the menu screen will disappear  To operate continuously  press the   MENU  button to display the main  menu   Even when button operation on the remote control is disabled  the   ID SET   button and the   ID ALL   button are enabled      CONTROL DEVICE PASSWORD CHANGE  eee    The control device password can be changed     1   2     3     Press A V to select  CONTROL DEVICE PASSWORD CHANGE      Press the   ENTER  button     The  CONTROL DEVICE PASSWORD CHANGE  screen is displayed     Press AW 4  to select the text  and press the   ENTER  button to enter the text     ENGLISH   135    Chapter 4 Settings      SECURITY  menu       4  Press A V 4  to select  OK   and press the   ENTER  button     To cancel  select  CANCEL      Attention      The initial password is    AAAA    by the factory default or when  ALL USER DATA  in  INITIALIZE    page 125  is executed     Change the password periodically that is hard to guess     136   ENGLISH    Chapter 4 Settings      NETWORK  menu        NETWO
79.  signal  do not enter sync signals to the  lt SYNC HD gt  terminal or the   VD   terminal       f you operate the projector using the computer with the resume feature  last memory   you may have to reset the resume feature to operate  the projector     50   ENGLISH    Chapter3 Basic Operations    This chapter describes basic operations to start with     ENGLISH   51    Chapter 3 Basic Operations     Switching on off the projector       Switching on off the projector          Make sure that the supplied power cord is securely fixed to the projector body to prevent it from being removed easily   Confirm that the   MAIN POWER  switch is on the   OFF  side before connecting the power cord   For details of power cord handling  refer to  Read this first          page 2      Attaching the power cord    1  Check the shapes of the   AC IN  terminal on the side of the projector body and the power cord  connector and insert the plug completely in the correct direction  until you hear the side tabs click in  place      Removing the power cord       1  Confirm that the   MAIN POWER  switch on the side of the projector body is on the   OFF   side  and  remove the power plug from the outlet     2  Remove the power cord connector from the   AC IN   terminal of the projector body while pressing the  side tabs        Displays the status of the power  Check the   ON  G  STANDBY  R  gt  status of the power indicator before operating the projector   Power indicator   ON  G  STANDBY  R  gt        
80.  terminals on projector 2       Computer       D Sub 9p  female     esos      D Sub 9p  male           D Sub 9p  female   OL     D Sub 9p  male     Ol sor                       D Sub 9p  male     Communication cable    Note    D Sub 9p  female     D Sub 9p  male     Communication cable    e The destination of  RS 232C    page 119  must be set according to the connection method     Pin assignments and signal names                                                    Desub 3 pini  female  Pin No  Signal name Details  Outside view   1      NC   5  lt   1   2  TXD Transmitted data   3  RXD Received data        4      NC   9  C ie    9   5  GND Earth  ANN  6      NC     7  CTS   9       6   8  RTS Connected internally   9      NC    ENGLISH   173          Chapter 6 Appendix     Technical information          D Sub 9 pin  male   Outside view       Pin No     Signal name Details                          1      NC   1       5   2  RXD Received data   3  TXD Transmitted data   4      NC   5  GND Earth   6      NC   7  RTS     6      9   8  CTS Connected internally              9               NC       Communication conditions  Factory default                                   Signal level RS 232C compliant  Sync  method Asynchronous  Baud rate 9 600 bps  Parity None  Character length 8 bits  Stop bit 1 bit   X parameter None  S parameter None             Basic format    Transmission from the computer starts with STX  then the ID  command  parameter  and ETX are sent in this order  Add p
81.  the polarity of the batteries set correctly  28     Are there any obstructions between the remote control and the remote control 24   signal receiver of the projector   Remote control does not    s the remote control being used beyond its effective operation range  25  respond    Are other forms of light  such as fluorescent light  affecting the projection  25     s the  REMOTE CONTROL  setting in  CONTROL DEVICE SETUP  set to 134   DISABLE     e  s the  lt REMOTE 2 IN  terminal used for contact control  177      s the ID number setting operation correct  28  cm doesnot    s the on screen display function turned off  hidden   103     Is the  CONTROL PANEL  setting in  CONTROL DEVICE SETUP  set to  Buttons on the control  DISABLE   134  panel do not operate        Is the  lt REMOTE 2 IN  terminal used for contact control  177        s the  SYSTEM SELECTOR  selection set correctly  77  Mic ori not display    s there a problem with the video tape or other image sources           s a signal which is not compatible with the projector being input  179      s the cable too long   Use D Sub cables that are 10 m  32 10   or shorter        Image from a computer e Is the external video output on the laptop computer set correctly   Ex   The external  does not appear  output settings may be switched by pressing the    Fn       F3  or    Fn         F10        simultaneously  Since the method varies depending on the computer type  refer to  the user manual provided with your computer      
82.  the projector can project   Items that are applicable to 1 to 10 in the table are as follows    1 Frame packing system                                                 2 Side by side system  3 Top and bottom system  4 Line by line system  5 Frame sequential system  6 3G SDI Level B simultaneous system  7 HDMI  amp  DVI D  8 RGB1  amp  RGB2  9 SDI1  amp  SDI2  only for PT DZ13KE  PT DS12KE   10 Simultaneous system  3D compatible Resolution es E ue e  signal  Dots   kHz   Hz   MHz  1 2  3 5 2  3 4 5  750  720  60p 1 280 x 720 45 0 60 0 74 3  4 V  4 a v V v      750  720  50p 1 280 x 720 37 5 50 0 74 3 4  4 V     v A V      1080 60i 1 920 x 1 080i 33 8 60 0 74 3 V 4       V A4        1080 50i 1 920 x 1 080i 28 1 50 0 74 3 v y         V V          1080 24p 1920 x 1 080 27 0 24 0 74 3  4 V V     V A4      1080 24sF 1 920 x 1 080i 27 0 48 0 74 3             V A4      1080 25p 1 920 x 1 080 28 1 25 0 74 3                 V V          1080 30p 1 920 x 1 080 33 8 30 0 74 3         m   V A4      1080 60p 1 920 x 1 080 67 5 60 0 148 5     v y   A4 V          1080 50p 1 920 x 1 080 56 3 50 0 148 5    4 v     V v      VGA480 640 x 480 31 5 59 9 25 2             V              SVGA 800 x 600 37 9 60 3 40 0                 A4                                                       ENGLISH   181    Chapter 6 Appendix     Technical information                                                                                                    Scanning freq   3D compatible Resolution   g d Deos  s
83.  the simultaneous system        Note      When set to  AUTO   3D images are displayed when the same 3D compatible signals are entered to each input  However  the P IN P status  during P IN P is maintained      When  BACKUP INPUT MODE  is set to  ON    1   or  2    3D SIMUL INPUT SETTING  cannot be set      This may not function properly for some connected external devices      Certain signals may not function properly      SD INPUT FORMAT               0 O    Set the 3D format for the image signals being input   Set a 3D format that matches the input signal     1  Press A V to select  3D INPUT FORMAT      2  Press the   ENTER  button     The  3D INPUT FORMAT  screen is displayed     3  Press AY to select a 3D format                                 AUTO   Automatically detects 3D format of input image signals and displays images    NATIVE  Forcibly displays 2D images regardless of input image signals     SIMULTANEOUS   Forcibly displays 3D images in simultaneous system regardless of input video signals    SIDE BY SIDE  Forcibly displays 3D images in side by side format regardless of input image signals    TOP AND BOTTOM  Forcibly displays 3D images in top and bottom format regardless of input image signals     LINE BY LINE   Forcibly displays 3D images in line by line system regardless of input video signals    FRAME SEQUENTIAL  Forcibly displays 3D images in frame sequential format regardless of input image signals         1 During DVI D or HDMI input only    2 During 3G SDI 
84.  the vertical sync signal pulse width of the input signal    SCAN TYPE  Displays the scan type of the input signal    SIGNAL INFORMATION          TOTAL DOTS  Displays the total dot count of the input signal    DISPLAY DOTS  Displays the number of input signal display dots    TOTAL LINES  Displays the total line count of the input signal    DISPLAY LINES  Displays the number of input signal display lines    SAMPLING  Displays the sampling information of the input signal    SIGNAL LEVEL  Displays the signal level of the input signal    BIT DEPTH  Displays the gradation of the input signal            1 The lamp runtime to be displayed is real time  The following conversion is required to calculate the rough estimate for lamp replacement                 Model No  Formula for lamp replacement time  rough estimate     A x 56   B x 40   C x 35    56    A  Runtime when  LAMP POWER  is set to  HIGH    PT DZ13KE i       PT DS12KE e B  Runtime when  LAMP POWER  is set to  MIDDLE    PT DW11KE e C  Runtime when  LAMP POWER  is set to  ECO   The formula when the optional Replacement lamp unit  for portrait mode  is used is    Bx2 C  2   A x 40   B x 35    40  e A  Runtime when  LAMP POWER  is set to  NORMAL    PT DZ10KE    B  Runtime when  LAMP POWER  is set to  ECO   The formula when the optional Replacement lamp unit  for portrait mode  is used is    Ax2  B  2             Note      The content of status can be sent via E mail by pressing the   ENTER  button while displaying the status   
85.  throw ratio is based on the value during projection onto a 3 81 m  150   screen size     Chapter 2 Getting Started     Setting up       B When the screen aspect is 16 9                                                                                                                                                  Unit  m   Lens type Zoom lens  Projection lens Model No  ET D75LE1 ET D75LE2   ET D75LE3   ET D75LE4   ET D75LE8   ET D75LE6  Throw ratio     1 5 2 0 1 2 0 30 1 3 0 5 0 1 5 0 8 0 1 8 0 15 0 1 1 0 1 2 1  Projection screen size Projection distance  L   B Height  gt  Min    Max    Min    Max    Min    Max    Min    Max    Min    Max    Min    Max   Diagona   SP  E E E  m    qw     rT    ew     LT     QW    or   aw    tm   1 78  70   0 872 1 550 2 26   3 02   3 06   4 60   4 61   7 74   7 75   12 40   12 12   23 06   1 52   1 82  2 03  80   0 996 1 771 2 60   3 47   3 51   5 27   528   8 86   8 87   14 18   13 90   26 41   1 75   2 09  2 29  90   1 121 1 992 2 93   3 92   3 95   5 95   5 96   9 99   9 99   15 97   15 69   29 76   1 97   2 36  2 54  100   1 245 2 214 3 27   4 36   440   6 62   6 63   11 11   11 11   17 76   17 47   33 10   2 20   2 63  3 05  120   1 494 2 657 3 93   5 26   5 30   7 96   7 97   13 35   13 36   21 33   21 04   39 79   2 65   3 17  3 81  150   1 868 3 321 4 94   6 60   6 64   9 98   9 99   16 72   16 73   26 68   26 40   49 83   3 33   3 98  5 08  200   2 491 4 428 6 61   8 83   8 89   13 34   13 35   22 34   22 34   35 61   35 33   66 56   
86.  to the projector      There are 12 pages  eight memories of A through L  with eight memories possible on each page  for memory numbers  and the signal is  registered to the lowest number that is available  If there is no available memory number it will be overwritten from the oldest signal      The names to be registered are automatically determined by the input signals and memory numbers    e  f a menu is being displayed  the new signals will be registered at the instant they are input     eer ee II    Registered signals can be renamed   1  Press AW 4b to select the signal of which name is to be changed     2  Press the   ENTER  button       The  REGISTERED SIGNAL STATUS  screen is displayed     The memory number  input terminal  input signal name  frequency  synch polarity  etc   are displayed     Press the   MENU  button to return to the  SIGNAL LIST  screen     3  Press the   ENTER  button     The  REGISTERED SIGNAL SETUP  screen is displayed     4  Press A V to select  SIGNAL NAME CHANGE      5  Press the   ENTER  button     The  SIGNAL NAME CHANGE  screen is displayed     6  Press A  W 4  to select the text  and press the   ENTER  button to enter the text     7  After the name is changed  press A V 4  to select  OK   and press the   ENTER    button       The registration is completed and the  REGISTERED SIGNAL SETUP  screen returns     When pressing A V      to select  CANCEL  and pressing the   ENTER  button  the changed signal name will not be registered and  an auto
87.  vi                      vi ivi         1 Supports half               2 VESA CVT RB  Reduced Blanking  compliant     3 Only supports SDI1                                        ENGLISH   183    Chapter6 Appendix     Specifications                      The specifications of the projector are as follows   Power supply AC 220 V   240 V  50 Hz 60 Hz  PT DZ13KE 970 W  5A   PT DS12KE  PT DW11KE 950 W  4 8 A   Power consumption PT DZ10KE 900 W  4 7 A     0 3 W when  STANDBY MODE  is set to  ECO   9 W when  STANDBY MODE  is set to  NORMAL           PT DZ13KE  PT DZ10KE 24 4 mm  0 96    aspect ratio 16 10   Size PT DS12KE 24 1 mm  0 95    aspect ratio 4 3   PT DW11KE 21 6 mm  0 85    aspect ratio 16 9   DLP chip Display system   3 unit DLP chips  DLP type  PT DZ13KE  PT DZ10KE 2 304 000 pixels  1 920 x 1 200 dots   Number of pixels   PT DS12KE 1 470 000 pixels  1 400 x 1 050 dots   PT DW11KE 1 049 088 pixels  1 366 x 768 dots        Lens Optional                         PT DZ13KE  PT DS12KE  380 W UHM lamp x 2                                                                         Luminous lamp PT DW11KE  PT DZ10KE 355 W UHM lamp x 2  PT DZ13KE  PT DS12KE 12 000 Im   ANSI   Light output  PT DW11KE 11 000 Im   ANSI   PT DZ10KE 10 600 Im  ANSI   Contrast ratio   10 000 1  when  DYNAMIC IRIS  is set to  3    Color system 7 standards  NTSC NTSC4 43 PAL PAL N PAL M SECAM PAL60   Projection screen size 1 78 m  70   to 25 40 m  1 000    PT DZ13KE  PT DZ10KE 16 10  Screen aspect ratio PT DS12
88.  when there are vertical stripes or sections are missing from the screen     Note    Previously mentioned vertical banding will not occur with all white signal input   The image may be disrupted while performing the adjustment  but it is not a malfunction    INPUT RESOLUTION  can be adjusted only when an RGB signal is input to the   RGB 1 IN   terminal or the   RGB 2 IN  terminal     e   e   e     Certain signals may not be adjustable      CLAMP POSITION  1    You can adjust the optimal point when the black part of the image is blunt or it has turned green   1  Press A V to select  CLAMP POSITION    2  Press 4b to adjust        Status Rough guide for optimal value Range of adjustment    The point where bluntness of the black part improves the most is    The black part is blunt  the optimal value        1 255  The point where the green part becomes black  and the bluntness    The Black part is green  has improved is the optimal value                    Note    e  CLAMP POSITION  can be adjusted only when a signal is input to the   RGB 1 IN   terminal or the   RGB 2 IN  terminal     Certain signals may not be adjustable     86   ENGLISH    Chapter 4 Settings      ADVANCED MENU  menu          JEDGE BLENDING     The edge blending function allows multiple projector images to be seamlessly overlapped by using the inclination of the brightness at the  overlapped area        1  Press A V to select  EDGE BLENDING    2  Press 4b to switch the item       The items will switch each time 
89. 0 6 v10 7 v10 8   Compatible browser  Internet Explorer 7 0 8 0 9 0 10 0  Safari 4 0 5 0 6 0  Mac OS      Communication with an E mail server is required to use the E mail function  Confirm that the E mail can be used beforehand   Use a LAN cable that is compatible with category 5 or higher    Use a LAN cable of 100 m  328 1   or shorter     Name and function of network function parts             1 LANLINK ACT lamp  green   Lights on when connected   Flashes when transmitting receiving data     2   LAN    terminal  10Base T 100Base TX   Used to connect the LAN cable here     3 LAN10 100 lamp  yellow   Lights on when connected to the 100Base TX     ENGLISH   139       Chapter 4 Settings      NETWORK  menu       1  Start up the web browser on the computer   2  Enter the IP address set on the projector into the URL entry field of the web browser   3  Enter the user name and the password       The factory default setting of the user name is user1  user rights  admin1  administrator rights  and the password is panasonic  lower  case      Windows Security    itin ani    connection      Remember my credentials    Cancel       4  Click OK       The  Projector status  page is displayed        Projector Control Window    b atus Network status Access error log Access log    PROJECTOR TYPT SIIK SERIAL NUMBER  234587    MAIN VERSION t NETWORK VERSION   Status   POWER on REMOTE  STATUS DISABLE   SHUTTER OFF osp ox    Projector   control LAMP SELECT LAMP POWER MIDDLE  INPUT  Wo ikh  B   Det
90. 00   20 68   20 49   29 78   29 57   57 39   56 68   90 45     8 66  15 24  600   9 144 12 192   19 21   24 83   24 61   35 76   35 51   68 91   68 05 1108 58     10 40  25 40  1000   15 240 20 320   32 08   41 46   41 07   59 68   59 26  114 96 113 52 1181 07     17 39              1    The throw ratio is based on the value during projection onto a 3 81 m  150   screen size     ENGLISH   37    Chapter 2 Getting Started     Setting up       For PT DS12KE    E When the screen aspect is 4 3                                                                                                                                                                                   Unit  m   Lens type Zoom lens  Projection lens Model No  ET D75LE1 ET D75LE2   ET D75LE3   ET D75LE4   ET D75LE8   ET D75LE6  Throw ratio  1 5 2 0 1 2 0 30 1 3 0 5 0 1 5 0 8 0 1 7 9 15 0 1 1 0 1 2 1  Projection screen size Projection distance  L     Height   Min    Max    Min    Max    Min    Max    Min    Max    Min    Max    Min    Max   Diagonal  SD     sey Width  SW  ew     rp     iw     rr     rw     LT    ew     LT     LW     LT     LW     LT   1 78  70   1 067 1 422 2 07   2 77   2 80   421   423   7 09   7 10   11 37   11 09   21 14   1 39   1 66  2 03  80   1 219 1 626 2 38   3 18   3 21   4 83   4 84   8 13   8 13   13 01   12 73   24 21   1 60   1 91  2 29  90   1 372 1 829 2 68   3 59   3 62   5 45   5 46   9 16   9 16   14 65   14 37   27 29   1 81   2 16  2 54  100   1 524 2 032 2 99   4 00   4 04   6 0
91. 00 hours when using the optional Replacement lamp unit  for portrait mode   Model No   ET LAD320P  1 pc   ET LAD320PW  2 pcs       2 3500 hours for PT DZ10KE      Ensure that lamp units not to be turned on are also installed      More lamps than the specified number of lamps light temporarily to prevent decreased illuminance when a lamp is switched      LAMP RELAY  yyy    Switch the lamp to be turned on automatically by specifying the day of the week and time     The degradation of the lamp due to continuous usage can be reduced by automatically switching the lamp to be turned on when using the  projector continuously for a week or more     1  Press A V to select  LAMP RELAY    2  Press 4b to switch the item                     OFF  Disables lamp relay    24H  Switches the lamp daily    1TWEEK  Switches the lamp weekly             When  24H  or  TWEEK  is selected  proceed to Step 3    3  Press AY to select  TIME    4  Press the   ENTER  button       Enters adjustment mode  the display is blinking      5  Press 4b to select    hour    or    minute     and press A or the number   lt 0 gt     lt 9 gt   buttons to set a  time       Selecting  hour  allows setting of only the hour in increments of one hour  and selecting    minute    allows setting of only the minute in  increments of one minute between 00 and 59     6  Press the   ENTER  button     The adjusted time is established     When  1WEEK  is selected in Step 2   proceed to Step 7      7  Press A V to select  DAY OF THE 
92. 00 series compatibility       When  USER  is selected  proceed to Step 3    3  Press the   ENTER  button     4  Press A V to select one from  PIN2  to  PIN8   and press q gt  to switch the setting      FUNCTION BUTTON     b               Set the functions of the  lt FUNC gt  button on the remote control   1  Press AY to select  FUNCTION BUTTON      2  Press the   ENTER  button     The  FUNCTION BUTTON  screen is displayed     3  Press A V to select a function            DISABLE  Disables the  lt FUNC gt  button    P IN P  Switches  OFF   USER1   USER2   USER3  in  P IN P      amp  page 127    SUB MEMORY  Displays the sub memory list    page 132         SYSTEM SELECTOR  Switches the  SYSTEM SELECTOR  setting    page 77    SYSTEM DAYLIGHT VIEW    Switches the  SYSTEM DAYLIGHT VIEW  setting    page 75    FREEZE  Temporarily pauses the image    page 106    WAVEFORM MONITOR  Displays the waveform of the input signal    page 106    LENS MEMORY LOAD  Calls the registered lens memory    page 123    LEFT RIGHT SWAP  Switches the flip horizontal settings    page 93                                 1 Only for PT DZ13KE  PT DS12KE  PT DW11KE    4  Press the  lt ENTER gt  button   Set the time zone  date  and time of the built in clock of the projector     Setting the time zone    1  Press A V to select  DATE AND TIME      2  Press the   ENTER  button     The  DATE AND TIME  screen is displayed     3  Press A V to select  TIME ZONE    4  Press 4b to switch  TIME ZONE      Setting the date 
93. 080 50i RGB   or  1080 60i RGB            Press the   ENTER  button     Note    e Refer to    List of compatible signals    amp  page 179  for the types of video signals that can be used with the projector       This may not function properly for some connected external devices     ENGLISH   77    Chapter 4 Settings      PICTURE  menu       sRGB is an international standard  IEC61966 2 1  for color reproduction defined by IEC  International Electrotechnical Commission    Set according to the following steps to reproduce more faithful  sRGB compliant colors     1  Set  COLOR MATCHING  adjustments to  OFF      Refer to  COLOR MATCHING   9 page 96    2  Display the  PICTURE  menu   e Refer to  IPICTURE  menu       page 71    3  Press AY to select  PICTURE MODE    4  Press 4b to set  NATURAL    5  Press A V to select  COLOR    6  Press the   DEFAULT  button on the remote control to set the factory default setting   7  Follow Steps 5  to 6  to set  TINT    COLOR TEMPERATURE    GAMMA   and  SYSTEM DAYLIGHT  VIEW  to the factory default settings   Note      sRGB is available for RGB signal input only     78   ENGLISH    Chapter4 Settings      POSITION  menu        POSITION  menu          menu           On the menu screen  select  POSITION  from the main menu  and select an item from the sub     Refer to    Navigating through the menu    page 65  for the operation of the menu screen   e After selecting the item  press A V   b to set     I             Move the image position verticall
94. 1 85 0 157 5 R D H                      1366 x 768 47 7 59 8 85 5 R D H  9      9 9  9  1366 x 768 Y S pes oe  1 366 x 768 39 6 49 9 69 0 R D H                      1 400 x 1 050 54 1 50 0 99 9 R D H                      1 400 x 1 050 64 0 60 0 108 0 R D H                      1 400 x 1 050 65 2 60 0 122 6 R D H      SXGA  x  4  4  4 v  1 400 x 1 050 65 3 60 0 121 8 R D H                      1400 x 1 050 78 8 72 0 149 3 R D H                      1400 x 1 050 82 2 75 0 155 9 R D H                      1 440 x 900 55 9 59 9 106 5 R D H           EN    WXGA   1 440 x 900 46 3 49 9 86 8 R D H                      UXGA60 1 600 x 1 200 75 0 60 0 162 0 R D H  4      4  4  4  1 680 x 1 050 65 3 60 0 146 3 R D H                  WSXGA   1 680 x 1 050 54 1 50 0 119 5 R D H                                                      180   ENGLISH       Chapter 6 Appendix     Technical information                                        Scanning freq  Dot clock Plug and play     Resolution 7 E  Mode Horizontal   Vertical freq  Format DVI D   Dots  MH RGB2 HDMI   kHz   Hz   MHz  EDID1   EDID2   EDID3  1 920 x 1 080 55 6 49 9 141 5 R D H                      1920 x 1080 1 920 x 1 080  8 66 6 59 9 138 5 R D H                      1 920 x 1 08010 67 2 60 0 173 0 R                      1 920 x 1 200 61 8 49 9 158 3 R D H                      WUXGA 1 920 x 1 200  8 74 0 60 0 154 0 R D H V   v Yn   ve  1 920 x 1 200 10 74 6 59 9 193 3 R                                                          1 Signa
95. 11 91   15 92   16 00   24 02   24 03   40 17   40 18   63 97   63 70  119 70  8 03   9 62  10 16  400   4 981 8 855 13 63   18 21   18 30   27 47   27 48   45 93   45 93   73 13   72 85  136 85  9 18   11 01  12 70  500   6 226 11 069   17 05   22 78   22 90   34 36   34 37   57 44   57 45   91 43   91 16  171 16  11 49   13 78  15 24  600   7 472 13 283 20 48   27 36   27 49   41 25   41 26   68 95   68 96 1109 74 1109 47  205 46   13 80   16 55  25 40  1000   12 453 22 138   34 18   45 67   45 88   68 83   68 84  115 00 115 011182 97 182 70        23 04   27 63  Lens type Zoom lens Fixed focus lens  Projection lens Model No  ET D75LE10   ET D75LE20   ET D75LE30   ET D75LE40   ET D75LE5   ET D75LE50  Throw ratio   1 4 1 9 1 1 8 2 7 1 2 7 5 2 1 5 1 8 2 1 0 8 1 0 8 1  Projection screen size Projection distance  L  5 Height r Min    Max    Min    Max    Min    Max    Min    Max  A n  Diagonal  SD   SH  Width  SW   LW     LT     W     LT     w     LT      w     LT  Fixed Fixed  1 78  70   0 872 1 550 2 18   2 82   2 82   4 10   4 07   7 94   7 86   12 62 1 15 1 16  2 03  80   0 996 1 771 2 51   3 24   3 23   4 70   4 67   9 10   9 01   14 45 1 33 1 34  2 29  90   1 121 1 992 2 83   3 66   3 65   5 31   5 27   10 26   10 15   16 27 1 50 1 51  2 54  100   1 245 2 214 3 15   4 08   4 06   5 91   5 87   11 42   11 30   18 10 1 68 1 69  3 05  120   1 494 2 657 3 80   4 92   4 89   7 11   7 07   13 74   13 59   21 75 2 03 2 04  3 81  150   1 868 3 321 4 78   6 17   6 14   8 92   8 86
96. 13 8 1 0 9 1 1 1  Projection screen size Projection distance  L   B Height  gt  Min    Max    Min    Max    Min    Max    Min    Max    Min    Max    Min    Max   Pragonal  SP  E SY  wy    i   ow   ery   ow    iT    ew    LT     LW     LT     LW     LT   1 78  70   0 872 1 550 2 07   2 77   2 80   421   423   7 09   7 10   11 37   11 09   21 14   1 39   1 66  2 03  80   0 996 1 771 2 38   3 18   3 21   4 83   4 84   8 13   8 13   13 01   12 73   24 21   1 60   1 91  2 29  90   1 121 1 992 2 68   3 59   3 62   545   546   9 16   9 16   14 65   14 37   27 29   1 81   2 16  2 54  100   1 245 2 214 2 99   4 00   4 04   6 07   6 08   10 19   10 19   16 29   16 01   30 36   2 01   241  3 05  120   1 494 2 657 3 60   4 82   4 86   7 30   7 31   12 25   12 26   19 57   19 29   36 50   243   2 90  3 81  150   1 868 3 321 4 53   6 05   6 09   9 15   9 16   15 34   15 35   2449   24 21   45 72   3 05   3 65  5 08  200   2 491 4 428 6 06   8 10   8 15   12 24   12 25   20 50   20 50   32 69   32 40   61 08   4 08   4 89  6 35  250   3 113 5 535 7 59   10 15   10 21   15 33   15 34   25 65   25 66   40 88   40 60   76 44   5 12   6 13  7 62  300   3 736 6 641 9 13   12 19   12 27   18 41   18 42   30 81   30 81   49 08   48 80   91 79   6 15   7 37  8 89  350   4 358 7 748 10 66   14 24   14 32   21 50   21 51   35 96   35 97   57 28   57 00  107 15  7 19   8 61  10 16  400   4 981 8 855 12 19   16 29   16 38   24 58   24 60   41 12   41 12   65 47   65 19  122 51  8 22   9 85  12 70  500
97. 2 7 ROxX     tractor coors rcov     B    Projector Control Window    Pro  s Network status     Access error log Access log  heck system    Status       Projector  control    Detailed  set up    Change  password                                  B  FAILED  items displayed when a problem occurs                Parameter Description   MAIN CPU BUS  There is a problem with the microcomputer circuitry  Consult your dealer    FAN  There is a problem with the fan or the fan drive circuit  Consult your dealer    INTAKE AIR TEMPERATURE  The air intake temperature is too high  The projector may be used in an operating    environment where the temperature is high  such as near a heating appliance         OPTICS MODULE TEMPERATURE     The temperature around the optics module inside the projector is high  The projector  may be used in an operating environment where the temperature is high  such as near a  heating appliance         AROUND LAMP TEMPERATURE     The temperature around the lamp is high  The air exhaust port may be blocked         LAMP1 REMAIN TIME         LAMP2 REMAIN TIME     The runtime of the lamp has exceeded the specified time  and it is time to replace the  lamp         LAMP1 STATUS    LAMP2 STATUS     The lamp has failed to turn on  Wait a while until the luminous lamp cools off  and then  turn on the power         APERTURE CONTRAST SHUTTER      There is a problem in the contrast shutter circuit for dynamic iris  Consult your dealer         INTAKE AIR TEMP SENSOR     Ther
98. 25   23 32   1 54   1 84  2 03  80   1 219 1 626 2 63   3 51   3 55   5 33   5 34   8 96   8 97   14 34   14 06   26 71   1 77   2 11  2 29  90   1 372 1 829 2 96   3 96   4 00   6 01   6 02   10 10   10 10   16 15   15 87   30 09   2 00   2 38  2 54  100   1 524 2 032 3 30   4 41   445   6 69   6 70   11 23   11 24   17 96   17 67   33 47   2 22   2 66  3 05  120   1 829 2 438 3 98   5 32   5 36   8 05   8 06   13 50   13 51   21 57   21 28   40 24   2 68   3 20  3 81  150   2 286 3 048 4 99   6 67   6 72   10 09   10 10   16 91   16 92   26 98   26 70   50 39   3 36   4 02  5 08  200   3 048 4 064 6 68   8 93   8 99   13 49   13 50   22 59   22 59   36 01   35 73   67 31   4 50   5 39  6 35  250   3 810 5 080 8 37   11 18   11 25   16 89   16 90   28 27   28 27   45 04   44 76   84 23   5 64   6 76  7 62  300   4 572 6 096 10 06   13 44   13 52   20 29   20 30   33 94   33 95   54 07   53 79  101 14  6 78   8 12  8 89  350   5 334 7 112 11 75   15 70   15 79   23 69   23 70   39 62   39 63   63 10   62 82  118 06  7 92   9 49  10 16  400   6 096 8 128 13 44   17 96   18 05   27 09   27 10   45 30   45 31   72 13   71 85  134 98  9 06   10 85  12 70  500   7 620 10 160   16 82   22 47   22 58   33 89   33 90   56 65   56 66   90 18   89 91  168 81  11 34   13 58  15 24  600   9 144 12 192   20 20   26 98   27 12   40 69   40 70   68 01   68 02  108 24 1107 96  202 65  13 62   16 32  25 40  1000   15 240 20 320   33 71   45 04   45 25   67 88   67 90  113 43  113 44  180 46 1
99. 259 compliant   YCgCp 4 2 2 10 bit   480i  576i   SMPTE ST 292 compliant   YPgPg 4 2 2 10 bit   720 50p  720 60p  1035 60i  1080 50i  1080 60i  1080 25p   1080 24p  1080 24sF  1080 30p    SMPTE ST 372 compliant   RGB 4 4 4 12 bit 10 bit   1080 50i  1080 60i  1080 25p  1080 24p  1080 24sF  1080 30p  X Y Z  4 4 4 12 bit   2048 x 1080 24p  2048 x 1080 24sF   SMPTE ST 424 compliant   YPgPg 4 2 2 10 bit   1080 50p  1080 60p   RGB 4 4 4 12 bit 10 bit   1080 50i  1080 60i  1080 25p  1080 24p  1080 24sF  1080 30p  e The 3G SDI signal is only compatible with SDI1        For DVI D signal          For HDMI signal          Single link HD SDI signal          ig  For SDI signal Dual link HD SDI signal     Only for PT DZ13KE   PT DS12KE  PT DZ10KE     3G SDI signal              1 Pixel Repetition signal  dot clock frequency 27 0 MHz  only   2 Only for PT DZ13KE  PT DS12KE    Available At    pirojectisle    Where RrojectonssRoanm Gree  ENGLISH   185    Chapter6 Appendix     Specifications       E Terminal         RGB 1 IN   terminal    1 set  BNC x 5  RGB YPsPA YCsC4 YC x 1      RGB signal    YPgPg signal  Y C signal    0 7 V  p p  75 Q  SYNC ON GREEN  1 0 V  p p  75 Q     SYNC HD TTL high impedance  automatic positive negative  polarity compatible    VD TTL high impedance  automatic positive negative  polarity compatible    Y  1 0 V  p p  including synchronization signal  PgPp  0 7 V  p p  75 Q  Y  1 0 V  p p   C  0 286 V  p p  75 O         RGB 2 IN  terminal    1 set  high density D Sub 15
100. 3 L3  angle a      angle B      angle a      angle f       ET D75LE1  40  40  20  15 0 8 1 8 0 5 1 0  ET D75LE2  40  40  20  15 0 6 1 2 0 4 0 7  ET D75LE3  45  40  20  15 0 4 0 8 0 3 0 5  ET D75LE4  45  40  20  15 0 3 0 5 0 2 0 3  ET D75LE5  22  15  8  8 1 5 3 7 0 9 2 2  ET D75LE6  28  15  10  10 1 2 3 0 0 7 1 7  ET D75LE8  45  40  20  15 0 2 0 3 0 1 0 2  ET D75LE10  40  40  20  15 0 9 2 0 0 5 1 1  ET D75LE20  40  40  20  15 0 7 1 3 0 4 0 7  ET D75LE30  45  40  20  15 0 5 0 9 0 3 0 5  ET D75LE40  45  40  20  15 0 3 0 5 0 2 0 3  ET D75LE50  22  15  8  8 1 5 3 7 0 9 2 2                             1 Cannot correct  VERTICAL KEYSTONE  and  HORIZONTAL KEYSTONE  if the total exceeds 55   when used at the same time     Note      When  GEOMETRY  is used  the focus of the entire screen may be lost as correction increases      Make the curved screen a circular arc shape with one part of a perfect circle removed      Adjustment range of the  GEOMETRY  items may not match the listed projection range depending on the projection lens  Use this projector  within the projection range  otherwise the correction may not work     34   ENGLISH       Chapter 2 Getting Started     Setting up       Projection distance of each projection lens    A x5   error in listed projection distances may occur   In addition  when  GEOMETRY  and  KEYSTONE  are used  distance is corrected to become smaller than the specified screen size     For PT DZ13KE  PT DZ10KE    B When the screen aspect is 16 10            
101. 4 45   5 33  6 35  250   3 113 5 535 8 28   11 06   11 13   16 70   16 71   27 95   27 96   44 54   44 26   83 29   5 58   6 68  7 62  300   3 736 6 641 9 95   13 29   13 37   20 07   20 08   33 57   33 57   53 47   53 19  100 02  6 71   8 03  8 89  350   4 358 7 748 11 62   15 52   15 61   23 43   23 44   39 18   39 19   62 40   62 12  116 75  7 84   9 38  10 16  400   4 981 8 855 13 29   17 76   17 85   26 79   26 80   44 80   44 80   71 33   71 05  133 48  8 96   10 73  12 70  500   6 226 11 069 16 63   22 22   22 33   33 51   33 52   56 03   56 03   89 19   88 91  1166 95  11 22   13 43  15 24  600   7 472 13 283   19 97   26 69   26 82   40 24   40 25   67 26   67 26  107 04 1106 77  200 41  13 47   16 14  25 40  1000   12 453 22 138   33 34   44 54   44 75   67 13   67 15  112 18   112 18  178 47 178 20        22 49   26 94  Lens type Zoom lens Fixed focus lens  Projection lens Model No  ET D75LE10   ET D75LE20   ET D75LE30   ET D75LE40   ET D75LE5   ET D75LE50  Throw ratio     1 4 1 8 1 1 8 2 6 1 2 6 5 1 1 5 0 8 0 1 0 8 1 0 7 1  Projection screen size Projection distance  L     Height i Min    Max    Min    Max    Min    Max    Min    Max     A  Diagonal  SD   SH  Width  SW   LW     LT     Lw     LT     w     LT    aw     LT  Fixed Fixed  1 78  70   0 872 1 550 2 13   2 75   275   4 00   3 97   7 74   7 66   12 31 1 12 1 13  2 03  80   0 996 1 771 2 44   3 16   3 15   4 59   4 55   8 88   8 78   14 09 1 29 1 30  2 29  90   1 121 1 992 2 76   3 57   3 56   5 17   5 14  
102. 53  to start projecting  Select the video for projection  and adjust appearance of the projected image     Selecting thei ia    Select an input signal        1  Press the input selection   lt RGB1 gt    lt RGB2 gt    lt DVI D gt    lt VIDEO gt    lt HDMI gt    lt SDI 1 2 gt   buttons on the  control panel or the remote control     The image of the signal being input in the selected terminal is projected     Attention      Images may not be projected properly depending on the external device  or the blu ray disc or DVD disc  to be played back   Set the  PICTURE  menu      SYSTEM SELECTOR       Confirm the aspect ratio of the projection screen and the image  and switch to an optimum aspect ratio from the  POSITION  menu  gt    ASPECT      adjusting the f Lshif    If the projected image or the position is not correct when the positioning of the projector and the screen is correctly installed  adjust the focus   zoom  and shift     Using the control panel    1  Press the   LENS   button on the control panel     Pressing the button changes the adjustment menu in the order of  FOCUS    ZOOM   and  SHIFT      2  Select each item and press AW      to adjust it     Using the remote control    1  Press the lens   lt FOCUS gt    lt ZOOM gt    lt SHIFT gt   buttons on the remote control   e   FOCUS  button  Adjusts focus   e   ZOOM    button  Adjusts zoom   e  lt SHIFT gt  button  Adjusts shift     2  Select each item and press A W  lt P to adjust it        Caution       During the lens 
103. 7   6 08   10 19   10 19   16 29   16 01   30 36   2 01   241  3 05  120   1 829 2 438 3 60   4 82   4 86   7 30   7 31   12 25   12 26   19 57   19 29   36 50   243   2 90  3 81  150   2 286 3 048 4 53   6 05   6 09   9 15   9 16   15 34   15 35   24 49   24 21   45 72   3 05   3 65  5 08  200   3 048 4 064 6 06   8 10   8 15   12 24   12 25   20 50   20 50   32 69   32 40   61 08   4 08   4 89  6 35  250   3 810 5 080 7 59   10 15   10 21   15 33   15 34   25 65   25 66   40 88   40 60   76 44   5 12   6 13  7 62  300  4 572 6 096 9 13   12 19   12 27   18 41   18 42   30 81   30 81   49 08   48 80   91 79   6 15   7 37  8 89  350   5 334 7 112 10 66   14 24   14 32   21 50   21 51   35 96   35 97   57 28   57 00  107 15  7 19   8 61  10 16  400   6 096 8 128 12 19   16 29   16 38   24 58   24 60   41 12   41 12   65 47   65 19  122 51  8 22   9 85  12 70  500   7 620 10 160   15 26   20 39   20 50   30 76   30 77   51 42   51 43   81 87   81 59  153 23  10 29   12 33  15 24  600   9 144 12 192   18 33   24 49   24 61   36 93   36 94   61 73   61 74   98 26   97 98  183 95  12 36   14 81  25 40  1000   15 240 20 320   30 60   40 88   41 07   61 62   61 63  102 97  102 98  163 83  163 56        20 64   24 73  Lens type Zoom lens Fixed focus lens  Projection lens Model No  ET D75LE10   ET D75LE20   ET D75LE30   ET D75LE40   ET D75LE5   ET D75LE50  Throw ratio   1 4 1 8 1 1 8 2 6 1 2 6 5 1 1 5 0 8 0 1 0 8 1 0 8 1  Projection screen size Projection distance  L  5 Height P Min  
104. 80 20        22 74   27 24  Lens type Zoom lens Fixed focus lens  Projection lens Model No  ET D75LE10   ET D75LE20   ET D75LE30   ET D75LE40   ET D75LE5   ET D75LE50  Throw ratio     1 6 2 0 1 2 0 2 9 1 2 9 5 6 1 5 5 8 9 1 0 8 1 0 8 1  Projection screen size Projection distance  L     Height   Min    Max    Min    Max    Min    Max    Min    Max    A  Diagonal  SD   SH  Width  SW   LW     LT     Lw     LT     w     LT    w     LT  Fixed Fixed  1 78  70   1 067 1 422 2 17   2 80   2 80   4 07   4 04   7 88   7 80   12 52 1 13 1 15  2 03  80   1 219 1 626 2 49   3 22   3 21   4 67   4 64   9 03   8 94   14 34 1 31 1 33  2 29  90   1 372 1 829 2 81   3 68   3 62   5 27   5 23   10 19   10 07   16 15 1 48 1 50  2 54  100   1 524 2 032 3 18   4 05   4 03   5 86   5 82   11 34   11 21   17 96 1 66 1 67  3 05  120   1 829 2 438 3 77   4 88   4 86   7 06   7 01   13 64   13 48   21 59 2 00 2 02  3 81  150   2 286 3 048 4 74   6 18   6 09   8 85   8 79   17 09   16 89   27 02 2 53 2 55  5 08  200   3 048 4 064 6 35   8 21   8 15   11 84   11 76   22 85   22 58   36 09 3 40 3 42  6 35  250  3 810 5 080 7 96   10 28   10 20   14 83   14 73   28 61   28 26   45 15 4 27 4 29  7 62  300   4 572 6 096 9 56   12 36   12 26   17 82   17 70   34 36   33 94   54 21 5 14 5 17  8 89  350   5 334 7 112 11 17   14 44   14 32   20 81   20 67   40 12   39 63   63 27     6 04  10 16  400   6 096 8 128 12 78   16 52   16 38   23 80   23 63   45 88   45 31   72 33     6 91  12 70  500   7 620 10 16 16 
105. 93   DARK TIME SETTING     94   3D FRAME DELAY                   sss 94   SD TEST MODE  sis 5  ioi or tenerse 94   3D TEST PATTERN     95   SAFETY PRECAUTIONS MESSAGE     95   3D SAFETY PRECAUTIONS               ss 95    DISPLAY OPTION  menu    96   COLOR MATCHING     96   LARGE SCREEN CORRECTION     97   SCREEN SETTING   tette 97   AUTO SIGNAL       orto tee 98   AUTO SETUP     e e tio tee dm 98   BACKUP INPUT SETTING     99   RGB IN     ttt terere tette 100   DVI D IN     101   HDMI IN     101  SONN  inerea eren eee inet 101   ON SCREEN DISPLAY     103   BACK COLOR     104   STARTUP EOGDO       oretenus 105  UNIFORMITY  cist ctt tiet het etit 105   SHUTTER SETTING     106   FREEZE     ette pedet eedem 106   WAVEFORM MONITOR     sss 106   CUT OFF icto intct tene dde 108     PROJECTOR SETUP  menu    109   PROJECTOR ID     109   PROJECTION METHOD     sss 109   COOLING CONDITION     110   HIGH ALTITUDE MODE     110   LAMP SELECT  itn ter Ee es 110   LAMP RELAY            n ttr teo tete eina 111   LAMP POWER     112   BRIGHTNESS CONTROL     sss 112   STANDBY MODE     116   SCHEDULE     117   STARTUP INPUT SELECT     118   RS 232C   aees ettet e peti there deri 119   STATUS     tette tret taper 120   NO SIGNAL SHU   OFF  121   REMOTE2 MODPBE        t rrr rete 122   FUNCTION BUTTON     cette 122   DATE AND TIME     122   LENS CALIBRATION     sese 123   LENS MEMORY     123   SAVE ALL USER DATA     125   LOAD ALL USER DATA     125   INITIAEIZE         ees 125   SERVICE PASSWORD     
106. Adjust the setting according to the lens shift range in the vertical  direction                 Adjust the setting according to the lens shift range in the horizontal  direction                  CURVED    LENS THROW RATIO   Set the throw ratio for the lens used    VERTICAL KEYSTONE   HORIZONTAL KEYSTONE                                                                                                                                                               VERTICAL ARC   EE LA O rj  L                                                                                                                                                    82   ENGLISH        HORIZONTAL ARC            T  L A  L                                                T   uu                                  Chapter 4 Settings      POSITION  menu           CURVED         VERTICAL BALANCE   HORIZONTAL BALANCE                                               LI                      EEA EEEHEEH                                                                                                                                                    EE     eH                                            MAINTAIN ASPECT RATIO   Select  ON  to correct while keeping the aspect ratio           Setting  CORNER CORRECTION                                                                                                                                                                                                                            
107. Adjusting the color matching as desired    1  Press A V to select  COLOR MATCHING      2  Press 4b to switch the item       The items will switch each time you press the button                        OFF  Color matching adjustment is not carried out    3COLORS  Adjusts the three colors  RED    GREEN   or  BLUE     7COLORS  Adjusts the seven colors  RED    GREEN    BLUE    CYAN    MAGENTA    YELLOW   or  WHITE     709MODE  NN   i     i   MEASURED  Refer to    Adjusting the color matching using a colorimeter      page 97  for details about this mode           3  Select  3COLORS  or  7COLORS   and press the   ENTER  button       The  3COLORS  or  7COLORS  screen is displayed     4  Press A V to select  RED    GREEN   or  BLUE    RED    GREEN    BLUE    CYAN    MAGENTA       YELLOW   or  WHITE  for  7COLORS       5  Press the   ENTER  button       The  3COLORS RED    3COLORS GREEN   or  3COLORS BLUE  screen is displayed     For  7COLORS   the  7 COLORS RED    7COLORS GREEN    7COLORS  BLUE    7COLORS CYAN    7COLORS MAGENTA     7COLORS YELLOWJ  or  7ZCOLORS WHITE  screen is displayed   e Set  AUTO TESTPATTERN  to  ON  to display a test pattern of selected colors     6  Press A V to select  RED    GREEN   or  BLUE      7  Press 4b to adjust       The adjustment value changes between 0 and 2 048     Note    Operation when correcting the adjustment color   When the correction color same as the adjustment color is changed  The luminance of the adjustment color changes    When correct
108. Bottom    21  RP    AUTO SETUP    button  Automatically adjusts the image display position while projecting  the image     PROGRESS  is displayed on the screen while adjusting  automatically    page 62     lt SHUTTER  gt  button   Used to temporarily turn off the image    page 61    lt ASPECT gt  button   Switches the aspect ratio of the image    page 63   Lens   lt FOCUS gt    lt ZOOM gt    lt SHIFT gt   buttons   Adjusts the projection lens    page 56     lt FUNC gt  button   Assigns a frequently used operation as a shortcut button    9 page 63      DEFAULT  button   Resets the content of the sub menu to the factory default    9 page 66      ID SET   button   Sets the ID number of the remote control to use for a system  using multiple projectors    page 28      ID ALL  button   Used to simultaneously control all the projectors with one  remote control for a system using multiple projectors     9 page 28      LOCK  button    Used to prevent unintended operation by careless pressing of  the buttons and prevent draining the remote control batteries        Remote control signal transmitter    Remote control wired terminal  Connects to the projector with a cable    page 29     Chapter1 Preparation     About your projector       Note      The remote control can be used within a distance of about 30 m  98 5   if pointed directly at the remote control signal receiver  The remote  control can control at angles of up to  15   vertically and  30   horizontally  but the effective contr
109. C compliant  for computer control        lt REMOTE 1 IN gt    lt REMOTE 1  OUT gt  terminal    M3 stereo mini jack cable  1 set each  for remote control  wired  projector connection control        lt REMOTE 2 IN gt  terminal    LAN  terminal          1 set  D Sub 9 p  for contact control  1 set  RJ 45  for network connection  PJLink compatible  10Base T 100Base TX  Art Net compatible        1 Only for PT DZ13KE  PT DS12KE    Note      The model numbers of accessories and optional components are subject to change without prior notice     186   ENGLISH       Chapter6 Appendix     Dimensions       Dimensions                                                                         Unit  mm  Ly           L   3 Am      r  xi  a  o   t  i  o e 2  anas    as ire   gena w    ee x                     EN                      100  3 15 16                                                                                                        462  18 3 16               530  20 7 8         26  1 1 32         468  18 7 16                  le      Actual dimensions may differ depending on the product     ENGLISH   187    Chapter 6 Appendix     Precautions for Ceiling Mount Bracket for Projectors    Precautions for Ceiling Mount Bracket for Projectors      When installing the projector to a ceiling  be sure to use the specified optional Ceiling Mount Bracket for Projectors  Model No    ET PKD310H  for High Ceilings   ET PKD310S  for Low Ceilings   ET PAD310  Projector ceiling mount bracket      
110. DS12KE  PT DZ10KE     68   ENGLISH             Chapter 4 Settings     Menu navigation        PROJECTOR SETUP   amp                                                                                Sub menu item Factory default Page   PROJECTOR ID   ALL  109   PROJECTION METHOD   FRONT FLOOR  109   COOLING CONDITION   AUTO  110   HIGH ALTITUDE MODE   OFF  110   LAMP SELECT   DUAL  110   LAMP RELAY   OFF  111   LAMP POWER   HIGH   112   BRIGHTNESS CONTROL      112   STANDBY MODE   NORMAL  116   SCHEDULE   OFF  117   STARTUP INPUT SELECT   LAST USED  118   RS 232C      119   STATUS      120   NO SIGNAL SHUT OFF   DISABLE  121   REMOTE2 MODE   DEFAULT  122   FUNCTION BUTTON      122   DATE AND TIME      122   LENS CALIBRATION      123   LENS MEMORY      123   SAVE ALL USER DATA      125   LOAD ALL USER DATA      125   INITIALIZE      125   SERVICE PASSWORD      126           1 Itis  NORMAL  for PT DZ10KE  In the portrait setting  it is  MIDDLE  for PT DZ13KE  PT DS12KE  PT DW11KE      P IN P   LH    Details    page 127      TEST PATTERN   E     Details    page 129      SIGNAL LIST  E     Details    amp  page 130                        SECURITY  KX   Sub menu item Factory default Page   SECURITY PASSWORD   OFF  133   SECURITY PASSWORD CHANGE      133   DISPLAY SETTING   OFF  134   TEXT CHANGE      134   CONTROL DEVICE SETUP      134   CONTROL DEVICE PASSWORD CHANGE      135                   ENGLISH   69    Chapter 4 Settings     Menu navigation            NETWORK     33             
111. ECT BUTTON  is selected  press the   ENTER  button  and then press A W to select the button to set                                               Buttons that can be set   CONTROL PANEL   REMOTE CONTROL    POWER BUTTON  Power standby   d   button  power on       button   INPUT SELECT BUTTON  nd button   lt RGB1 gt  button   lt RGB2 gt  button    DVI D   button   lt HDMI gt  button  and   SDI 1 2     MENU BUTTON    MENU  button   LENS BUTTON    LENS   button Nicias button    ZOOM    button   lt SHIFT gt    AUTO SETUP BUTTON    AUTO SETUP  button   SHUTTER BUTTON   lt SHUTTER  button   ASPECT BUTTON        ASPECT  button   ON SCREEN BUTTON        ON SCREEN   button   OTHER BUTTON  AV 4b    ENTER   button Buttons not listed above        1 Only for PT DZ13KE  PT DS12KE  PT DZ10KE    Press 4 gt  to switch the item         ENABLE  Enables button operations         DISABLE  Disables button operations                   The following items are available when  SDI1 2 BUTTON  is selected in  INPUT SELECT BUTTON  in PT DZ13KE and PT DS12KE                        TOGGLE  Switches between SDI1 and SDI2 when the button is operated    SDI1  Fixes to SDI1    SDI2  Fixes to SDI2     DISABLE  Disables button operations          When  INPUT SELECT BUTTON  is selected in Step 7   press the   MENU  button to return to the  CONTROL PANEL  screen or the   REMOTE CONTROL  screen     Press AY to select  APPLY   and press the   ENTER  button       The confirmation screen is displayed     10  Press 4P to
112. ENTER  button     The registration completes and returns to the  LENS MEMORY NAME CHANGE  screen   e  f you press A Wp to select  CANCEL  and then press the   ENTER  button  the changed name will not be registered        f you press A V   b to select  DEFAULT  and press the   ENTER  button  the changed name will not be registered and the default  name will be used     If you select  OK  without entering any characters and press the   ENTER  button  the default name will be used      SAVE ALL USER DATA  1 11    Save the various setting values as a backup in the built in memory of the projector     1   2     3   4     Press A V to select  SAVE ALL USER DATA      Press the   ENTER  button     The  SECURITY PASSWORD  screen is displayed     Enter a security password and press the   ENTER  button     When the confirmation screen is displayed  press 4P to select  OK   and press the   ENTER  button      PROGRESS  is displayed while saving data      LOADALLUSERDATA  1 11 11    Load the various setting values saved as a backup in the built in memory of the projector     1   2     3   4     Press A V to select  LOAD ALL USER DATA      Press the   ENTER  button     The  SECURITY PASSWORD  screen is displayed     Enter a security password and press the   ENTER  button     When the confirmation screen is displayed  press 4P to select  OK   and press the   ENTER  button     Note      The projector will go into the standby status to reflect the setting values when  LOAD ALL USER DATA  is ex
113. ESSAGE      Press 4  to switch the item     The items will switch each time you press the button      ON  Messages are displayed during calibration         OFF  Messages are not displayed during calibration                 Press AY to select  APPLY      Press the   ENTER  button      The set  MODE  and  LINK  are enabled  and LAMP RELAY screen alert is displayed when the  LAMP RELAY  setting is  OFF   When   CALIBRATION MESSAGE  is set to  ON   a calibration running message is displayed which will automatically disappear 30 seconds  after calibration completes    e  f the   ENTER  button is pressed with  MODE  in  BRIGHTNESS CONTROL SETUP  set to other than  OFF   the brightness of the  lamp at the time the button was pressed is recorded as the standard brightness     e  f the   ENTER    button is pressed when  LINK  is set from  GROUP A  to  GROUP D   the group name is displayed on the screens of  projectors that have been set in the same group     LINK GROUP A    ENGLISH   113    Chapter4 Settings      PROJECTOR SETUP  menu       Note      When  MODE  in  BRIGHTNESS CONTROL SETUP  is set to  AUTO  or  PC   keep the shutter open for at least two minutes to perform the  brightness sensor calibration after completed the  BRIGHTNESS CONTROL SETUP  setting    e If the shutter is closed within approx  10 minutes after the lamp has turned on while  MODE  in  BRIGHTNESS CONTROL SETUP  is set to   AUTO  or  PC   brightness cannot be measured  Therefore  brightness may be corrected a
114. ETTING  settings      SD SYNC SETTING         1 11    Set the way in which the   3D SYNC 1 IN OUT  terminal and the   3D SYNC 2 OUT gt  terminal will be used     Attention      Before connecting external devices to the   3D SYNC 1 IN OUT gt  terminal and the   3D SYNC 2 OUT gt  terminal using cables  complete the   3D SYNC MODE  setting and confirm that the external devices to be connected are turned off     Changing  3D SYNC MODE  while the cables are connected may result in malfunctions of the projector or the connected external devices     1  Press AY to select  3D SYNC SETTING      2  Press the   ENTER  button     The precaution message related to  3D SYNC SETTING  is displayed     3  Press the   ENTER  button     The  3D SYNC SETTING  screen is displayed     4  Press A V to select  3D SYNC MODE      5  Press 4b to switch the item         3D SYNC MODE     Items set in  3D SYNC1  Items set in  3D SYNC2                                 OFF  Not used  Not used    1  3D trigger output Stereo synch output   2  3D trigger output 3D trigger output   3  Stereo synch input Through 3D SYNC1   4  Stereo synch input Stereo synch output   5  Stereo synch input 3D trigger output   6  Frame synch input Through 3D SYNC1   7  Frame synch input Stereo synch output   9  Frame synch input 3D trigger output           9           3D trigger output Frame synch output       ENGLISH   91    Chapter 4 Settings      3D SETTINGS  menu                          3D SYNC MODE  Items set in  3D SYNC1  Ite
115. EVEL ADJUST  may not function properly unless a still image containing clear blacks and whites is input   Set the backup function that switches the signal to the backup input signal as seamless as possible when input signal is disrupted     1  Press AY to select  BACKUP INPUT SETTING      2  Press the  lt ENTER gt  button     The  BACKUP INPUT SETTING  screen is displayed     3  Press A V to select  BACKUP INPUT MODE    4  Press 4b to switch the item       The items will switch each time you press the button         OFF  Disables the backup function     Enables the backup function between the DVI D input and the HDMI input    The input is switched as seamless as possible when the same signal is input to the primary and   ON    1   secondary inputs    Primary input is fixed to the   DVI D IN   terminal  and the secondary input is fixed to the   HDMI IN    terminal        Enables the backup function between the SDI1 input and the SDI2 input    The input is switched as seamless as possible when the same signal is input to the primary and   2   secondary inputs    Primary input is fixed to the  lt SDI IN 1   terminal  and the secondary input is fixed to the   SDI IN 2 gt   terminal                  1 Only for PT DW11KE  PT DZ10KE   2 Onlyfor PT DZ13KE  PT DS12KE    5  Press A V to select  AUTOMATIC SWITCHING       When  BACKUP INPUT MODE  is set to  OFF    AUTOMATIC SWITCHING  cannot be selected     6  Press 4b to switch the item       The items will switch each time you press th
116. EVICE SETUP  screen is displayed     3  Press A V to select  CONTROL PANEL  or  REMOTE CONTROL          CONTROL PANEL  You can set the limitation on the control from the control panel    REMOTE CONTROL  You can set the limitation on the control from the remote control                 4  Press the   ENTER  button     The  CONTROL PANEL  screen or the  REMOTE CONTROL  screen is displayed     5  Press A V to select  CONTROL PANEL  or  REMOTE CONTROL    6  Press 4b to switch the item       You can set the operation restriction from the control panel or the remote control         ENABLE  Enables all button operations    DISABLE  Disables all button operations     Operation of all buttons can be enabled disabled separately   Refer to    Enabling disabling any button    page 134  for details         USER                 7  Press A V to select  APPLY   and press the   ENTER  button       The confirmation screen is displayed     8  Press 4b to select  OK   and press the   ENTER  button     Enabling disabling any button    1  Press A V to select  CONTROL DEVICE SETUP      134   ENGLISH    Chapter 4 Settings      SECURITY  menu       2     3   4   5   6   7     8     9     Press the   ENTER  button     The  CONTROL DEVICE SETUP  screen is displayed     Press A V to select  CONTROL PANEL  or  REMOTE CONTROL    Press the   ENTER  button   Press A V to select  CONTROL PANEL  or  REMOTE CONTROL    Press q gt  to switch  USER      Press AY to select the button item to set   e When  INPUT SEL
117. Enter the port number of the POP server   Allowed characters   Normally 110   Alphanumerics  A   Z  a   z  0   9  8  Submit     Minus sign     and period       User name     Enter the user name for the POP server or the SMTP server     150   ENGLISH    Update the settings     Chapter 4 Settings      NETWORK  menu       Contents of E mail sent    Example of E mail sent when E mail is set    The following E mail is sent when the E mail settings have been established                  Panasonic projector report CO NF IG URE       Projector Type   DS12K  Serial No   SW1234567    one E mail setup data         TEMPERATURE WARNING SETUP   MINIMUM TIME at   60  minutes interval   INTAKE AIR TEMPERATURE Over   46degC   114degF      ERROR   OFF     LAMP1 RUNTIME  OFF   at REMAIN   400  H  LAMP1 RUNTIME   OFF   at REMAIN   200  H  LAMP2 RUNTIME  OFF   at REMAIN   400  H  LAMP2 RUNTIME   OFF   at REMAIN   200  H  INTAKE AIR TEMPERATURE  OFF     PERIODIC REPORT  Sunday  OFF  Monday  ON   Tuesday  OFF  Wednesday  OFF   Thursday  ON   Friday  OFF  Saturday   OFF         00 00   ON   01 00  OFF  02 00  OFF  03 00  OFF   04 00  OFF  05 00  OFF  06 00  OFF  07 00   OFF   08 00  OFF  09 00  OFF  10 00  OFF  11 00   OFF   12 00  OFF  13 00  OFF  14 00  OFF  15 00  OFF   16 00  OFF  17 00  OFF  18 00  OFF  19 00  OFF   20 00  OFF  21 00  OFF  22 00  OFF  23 00   OFF        check system         MAIN CPU BUS OK     FAN OK     INTAKE AIR TEMPERATURE   OK     OPTICS MODULE TEMPERATURE   OK     AROUND 
118. HUTTER  13  OPTICS MODULE TEMPERATURE   Displays the status of the shutter  ON  closed  OFF  open   Displays the status of the internal temperature of the projector   5  LAMP SELECT  14  AROUND LAMP TEMPERATURE   Displays the setting status of  LAMP SELECT    page 110   Displays the status of the temperature around the lamp of the  6  SERIAL NUMBER  projector   Displays the serial number of the projector  15  LAMP1  LAMP2  RUNTIME   7  NETWORK VERSION  Displays the status and the runtime  converted value  of the  Displays the version of the firmware of the network  lamp   8  REMOTE2 STATUS  16  SELF TEST      u  Displays the control status of the  lt REMOTE 2 IN   terminal  Displays the self diagnosis information   9  OSD  17  PROJECTOR RUNTIME   Displays the status of the on screen display  Displays the runtime of the projector     142   ENGLISH    Chapter 4 Settings      NETWORK  menu       Error information page    When  Error  Detail   or  Warning  Detail   is displayed in the self diagnosis display of the  Projector status  screen  click it to display the    error warning details       The projector may go into the standby status to protect the projector depending on the contents of the error     dicte WO MIRARI tn n atre SRL    1 Self diagnosis result display  Displays the item check results    OK     Indicates that operation is normal    FAILED     Indicates that there is a problem    WARNING     Indicates that there is a warning     p Box     moe aei men 9   FS ES  i 
119. ITY    6  Press 4b to switch the item       The items will switch each time you press the button         NONE    EVEN  Select the parity condition    ODD                    Setting the communication condition of the   SERIAL OUT   terminal    1  Press AY to select  RS 232C      2  Press the   ENTER  button     The  RS 232C  screen is displayed     3  Press AY to select   OUT  BAUDRATE    4  Press 4b to switch the item         9600    19200  Select the proper speed    38400                       5  Press A V to select   OUT  PARITY    6  Press 4b to switch the item       The items will switch each time you press the button     ENGLISH   119    Chapter4 Settings      PROJECTOR SETUP  menu           NONE         EVEN            ODD        Select the parity condition        Setting the response    1  Press A V to select  RS 232C      2     Press the   ENTER  button       The  RS 232C  screen is displayed     3  Press A V to select  RESPONSE ID ALL       4     Press 4 gt  to switch the item         ON     Returns the response when the ID setting is ALL            OFF        Does not return the response when the ID setting is ALL        5  Press A V to select  GROUP      6  Press 4b to switch the item           IA     2        Controls multiple projectors simultaneously by sending the ID of RS 232C  You can set groups from     A  to  Z   The projector responds when the ID of RS 232C matches the setting        7  Press A V to select  RESPONSE ID GROUP       8  Press 4b to switch the
120. KE  PT DZ10KE   Set this to view 3D display when the vertical scanning frequency of the signal is 25 Hz  50 Hz  and 100 Hz        1  Press AY to select  FRAME LOCK    2  Press 4b to switch the item       The items will switch each time you press the button         OFF  Decreases the flickering of the display    ON  Synchronizes the display to the vertical scanning frequency of the input signal                    Note       FRAME LOCK  is not displayed when the vertical scanning frequency of a signal other than the above is input or 2D images are displayed     The screen may flicker when  FRAME LOCK  is set to  ON      The display may look discontinuous when  FRAME LOCK  is set to  OFF       RASTERPOSITION  1 1    This will allow the position of the image to move within the display area arbitrarily when the input image is not using the whole display area     1  Press A V to select  RASTER POSITION      2  Press the   ENTER  button     The  RASTER POSITION  screen is displayed     3  Press A W 4b to adjust the position     ENGLISH   89    Chapter 4 Settings      DISPLAY LANGUAGE  menu     DISPLAY LANGUAGE  menu             On the menu screen  select  DISPLAY LANGUAGE  from the main menu  and display the sub   menu    Refer to    Navigating through the menu    page 65  for the operation of the menu screen    e Press A    to select a language  and press the   ENTER  button to set                         You can select the language of the on screen display     INITIAL SETTING    E
121. KE 4 3  PT DW11KE 16 9  Projection method  FRONT CEILING    FRONT FLOOR    REAR CEILING    REAR FLOOR   Power cable length 3 0 m  118 1 8    Outer case Molded plastic  Width 530 mm  20 7 8    Dimensions   Height 200 mm  7 7 8    with legs at shortest position   Depth 548 5 mm  21 19 32    excluding the lens   Weight Approx  24 0 kg  52 9 Ibs      PT DZ13KE  PT DS12KE  45 dB  Noise level    PT DW11KE  PT DZ10KE 43 dB  Operating  environment 0   C  32   F  to 45   C  113   F     Operating temperature 4  environment   Operating       environment 10   to 80 96  no condensation   humidity          Remote  control    Power supply DC 3 V  AA R6 battery x 2    Operating range   Within approx  30 m  98 5    when operated directly in front of signal receiver   Weight 134 g  4 7 ozs    including batteries    Dimensions Width  51 mm  2    Height  176 mm  6 15 16    Depth  28 mm  1 3 32                     zi   2     4    Measurement  measuring conditions and method of notation all comply with 15021118 international standards    In the portrait setting  the light output is 10 600 Im for PT DZ13KE and PT DS12KE  and 9 600 Im for PT DW11KE    Average value  Weight varies for each product    When using the projector at high altitudes  1 400 m  4 593   or higher     lower than 2 700 m  8 858   above sea level   the operating environment  temperature should be between 0   C  32   F  and 40   C  104   F     If you use the Smoke cut filter  the operating environment temperature should be between
122. LAMP TEMPERATURE   OK     LAMP1 REMAIN TIME OK     LAMP2 REMAIN TIME OK     LAMP1 STATUS OK     LAMP2 STATUS OK    APERTURE CONTRAST SHUTTER    OK      INTAKE AIR TEMP SENSOR   OK     OPTICS MODULE TEMP SENSOR   OK     AROUND LAMP TEMP SENSOR   OK     BATTERY OK     LENS MOUNTER OK     COVER OPEN OK     BRIGHTNESS SENSOR OK     ANGLE SENSOR OK     FILTER UNIT OK     AIR FILTER OK     AC POWER OK             Error code 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00     Intake air temperature   27 degC   80 degF  Optics module temperature   33 degC   91 degF  Around lamp temperature   32 degC   89 degF    PROJECTOR RUNTIME 200H  POWER ON 1 times  LAMP1 ON 1 times  LAMP1 LOW 200 H  LAMP1 MID OH  LAMP1 HIGH OH  LAMP1 REMAIN 1800 H  LAMP2 ON 1 times  LAMP2 LOW 200 H  LAMP2 MID OH  LAMP2 HIGH OH  LAMP2 REMAIN 1800 H       T Current status              MAIN VERSION 1 00   NETWORK VERSION 1 00   SUB VERSION 1 00   LAMP STATUS LAMP1 ON LAMP2 ON  INPUT RGB1   REMOTE2 STATUS DISABLE   one Wired Network configuration         DHCP Client OFF   IP address 192 168 0 8    MAC address 70 85  12 00 00 00    Fri Nov 01 16 38 50 2013             ENGLISH   151    Chapter 4 Settings      NETWORK  menu          Example of the E mail sent for an error       The following E mail is sent when an error has occurred            Panasonic projector report ERROR               Projector Type   DS12K   Serial No   SW1234567         check system         MAIN CPU BUS   OK    FAN   OK    INTAKE AIR TEMPERATURE
123. LAMP1  QSL Lamp cumulative 2 LAMP2  runtime query  Response is 0000 to 4000  OSH Shutter 0 OPEN  QSH Shutter status query 1 CLOSE  0 DEFAULT VID AUTO  f   1 4 3  VSE Aspect ratio switch  2 16 9  5 THROUGH    f 6 HV FIT  QSE Aspect ratio settings 9 H FIT  query  10 V FIT  0 OFF  1 USER1  OPP P IN P execute  2 USER2  3 USER3  0 OFF  QPP P IN P setti 1 USER  setting que  SAR 2 USER2  3 USER3  OCS Sub memory switch  QSB Sub memory status 01   96 Sub memory number  query              1 Use Lamp 1 or Lamp 2 whichever has a shorter runtime     E Projector control command  with sub command        Command    Sub command    Details    Remark       VXX       RYCI1    176   ENGLISH       RGB1 input setting        00000   RGB YPgP   400001   Y C    Chapter 6 Appendix     Technical information       E Lens control command       Command Sub command Details Remark  VXX LNSI2 Lens H shift          VXX LNSI3 Lens V shift    00000   Fine adjustment 1     00001   Fine adjustment 1     00100    Fine adjustment 2    00101   Fine adjustment 2    00200   Coarse  adjustment    00201   Coarse adjustment        VXX LNSIA Lens focus  VXX LNSI5 Lens zoom                      It is possible to control the projector remotely  by external contact  from a control panel located away from the projector where remote control  signals cannot reach     Use the  lt REMOTE 2 IN    terminal on the connecting terminals of the projector to connect to the control panel     Remote control J Contact control    Remote cont
124. Min    Max    Min    Max    Min    Max   Diagona  SD  E E  w   aT    E    LW    an    LW     LT   1 78  70   1 067 1 422 2 86   3 82   3 86   5 80   5 81   9 74   9 75   15 59   15 30   29 04   1 92   2 30  2 03  80   1 219 1 626 3 28   4 38   4 42   6 65   6 66   11 15   11 16   17 83   17 55   33 24   221   2 64  2 29  90   1 372 1 829 3 70   4 94   4 98   7 49   7 50   12 56   12 57   20 07   19 79   37 44   249   2 98  2 54  100   1 524 2 032 4 12   5 50   5 55   8 33   8 34   13 97   13 98   22 31   22 03   41 64   277   3 32  3 05  120   1 829 2 438 4 96   6 62   6 67   10 02   10 03   16 79   16 80   26 79   26 51   50 04   3 34   4 00  3 81  150   2 286 3 048 6 21   8 30   8 36   12 55   12 56   21 02   21 03   33 52   33 24   62 64   4 19   5 01  5 08  200   3 048 4 064 8 831   11 11   11 17   16 77   16 78   28 07   28 07   44 72   44 44   83 63   5 60   6 71  6 35  250   3 810 5 080 10 41   13 91   13 99   20 99   21 00   35 12   35 12   55 93   55 65  104 63  7 01   8 40  7 62  300   4 572 6 096 12 51   16 71   16 80   25 21   25 22   42 16   42 17   67 14   66 86  125 63  8 43   10 10  8 89  350   5 334 7 112 14 60   19 51   19 61   29 43   29 44   49 21   49 22   78 34   78 07  146 63  9 84   11 80  10 16  400   6 096 8 128 16 70   22 31   22 43   33 65   33 66   56 26   56 26   89 55   89 28  167 63  11 26   13 49  12 70  500   7 620 10 160   20 89   27 92   28 05   42 09   42 10   70 35   70 36  111 96   111 69  209 62  14 08   16 88  15 24  600   9 144 12 192
125. NG   sr am  CEILING SETTING   30   30         VERTICAL DOWN SETTING  AR      tm   Projection direction    1  Press A V to select  COOLING CONDITION      2  Press the   ENTER  button     The  COOLING CONDITION  screen is displayed     3  Press A V to select a cooling condition       When  AUTO  is selected  the cooling conditions of  FLOOR SETTING    CEILING SETTING    VERTICAL UP SETTING   and   VERTICAL DOWN SETTING  are set automatically   You can check the setting from  COOLING CONDITION  on the  STATUS  screen     4  Press the   ENTER  button   5  When the confirmation screen is displayed  press 4P to select  OK   and press the   ENTER  button     Note      This item cannot be set when using the optional Replacement lamp unit  for portrait mode   Model No   ET LAD320P  1 pc   ET LAD320PW   2 pcs     Setting is fixed to  PORTRAIT SETTING        HIGH ALTITUDE MODE                     4     Set to  ON  when using the projector at high altitudes between 1 400 m  4 593   or higher and lower than 2 700 m  8 858   above sea level   1  Press A V to select  HIGH ALTITUDE MODE    2  Press 4b to switch the item                     OFF  When using at a location lower than 1 400 m  4 593   above sea level   ON  When using at high altitudes  1 400 m  4 593   or higher and lower than 2 700 m  8 858   above sea  level        3  When the confirmation screen is displayed  press 4P to select  OK   and press the   ENTER  button   Note      The speed of the fan increases and the operation sou
126. NGLISH         Various menus  settings  adjustment screens  control button names  etc   are displayed in the selected language     The language can be changed to English  German  French  Spanish  Italian  Portuguese  Japanese  Chinese  Russian  or Korean     Note    e The on screen display language of the projector is set to English by default and when  ALL USER DATA   9 page 125  in  INITIALIZE  is  executed     90   ENGLISH    Chapter 4 Settings      3D SETTINGS  menu        3D SETTINGS  menu        Only for PT DZ13KE  PT DS12KE  PT DW11KE        sub menu        On the menu screen  select  3D SETTINGS  from the main menu  and select an item from the    Refer to    Navigating through the menu    page 65  for the operation of the menu screen   e After selecting the item  press A W   b to set     CD CD CD  Gm  Co  Qm                    Set a picture display method for use during 3D signal input as necessary for the 3D system in use     1  Press A V to select  3D SYSTEM SETTING      2  Press 4b to switch the item       The items will switch each time you press the button        During 3D signal input  sequential frames of images for the right eye and images for the left eye are             Note     SINGEE  alternately displayed    DUAL  LEFT   Only images for the left eye are displayed during 3D signal input    DUAL  RIGHT   Only images for the right eye are displayed during 3D signal input             When 2D images are input  2D images are displayed regardless of  3D SYSTEM S
127. O MERE ht bn ow  a rp SAUL Rex a masa crc moon s  1    2    3    4    5  6  1 Page tab 4  Detailed set up   Switches pages by clicking this item  The  Detailed set up  page is displayed by clicking this item   2  Status  5  Change password   The status of the projector is displayed by clicking this item  The  Change password  page is displayed by clicking this item   3  Projector control  6  CRESTRON RoomView   The  Projector control  page is displayed by clicking this item  The control page of RoomView is displayed by clicking this item     ENGLISH   141    Chapter 4 Settings      NETWORK  menu        Projector status  page    Click  Status       Projector status    Display the status of the projector for the following items     SS Ima io een caet B  BSR 9 roro oett meom   5                    6                                                                                                                                                                              2 7  3        8   reowcrnwr                  Duk   4 T     9  5 1 m10  1   T    11    mm   12     13  14      15  16  17  1  PROJECTOR TYPE  10  LAMP POWER   Displays the type of the projector  Displays the setting status of  LAMP POWER    page 112    2  MAIN VERSION  11  INPUT   Displays the firmware version of the projector  Displays the status of the selected input   3  POWER  12  INTAKE AIR TEMPERATURE   Displays the status of the power  Displays the status of the air intake temperature of the projector   4  S
128. OJECTION METHOD      1    Set the projection method in accordance with the installation status of the projector   Change the projection method if the screen display is upside down or inverted     1  Press A V to select  PROJECTION METHOD      2  Press the   ENTER  button     The  PROJECTION METHOD  screen is displayed     3  Press AY to select the projection method               FRONT FLOOR  When installing the projector on the desk  etc   in front of the screen   FRONT CEILING  When installing the projector in front of the screen using the Ceiling Mount Bracket for Projectors   optional    REAR FLOOR  When installing the projector on the desk  etc   behind the screen  with a translucent screen        When installing the projector behind the screen  with a translucent screen  using the Ceiling Mount  Bracket for Projectors  optional            REAR CEILING           4  Press the   ENTER  button   5  When the confirmation screen is displayed  press 4P to select  OK   and press the   ENTER    button     Attention      When the  PROJECTION METHOD  setting is changed  confirm that  COOLING CONDITION   9 page 110  is set correctly     ENGLISH   109    Chapter4 Settings      PROJECTOR SETUP  menu          Change the fan control depending on the direction of projection   Set  COOLING CONDITION  according to the projection direction  but set it to  AUTO  normally  Using the projector with incorrect setting may  shorten the life of the lamp      n  VERTICAL UP SETTING  a   FLOOR SETTI
129. OLOR TEMPERATURE  individual adjustment screen is displayed     3  Press 4b to select  USER1  or  USER2      4  Press the   ENTER  button     The  COLOR TEMPERATURE  screen is displayed     5  Press A V to select  WHITE BALANCE      6  Press the   ENTER  button     The  WHITE BALANCE  screen is displayed     7  Press A V to select  WHITE BALANCE HIGH  or  WHITE BALANCE LOW      8  Press the   ENTER  button     The  WHITE BALANCE HIGH  screen or the  WHITE BALANCE LOW  screen is displayed     9  Press A V to select  RED    GREEN   or  BLUE    10  Press 4P to adjust the level                                      Item Operation Adjustment Range of adjustment  Press the  gt  button  Deepens red    RED   Press the  lt     button        Weakens red   WHITE BALANCE HIGH   0    255  factory default is  GREEN Press the  gt  button  Deepens green   255   i   Press the 4 button  Weakens green   WHITE BALANCE LOW    127    127  factory default is  Press the  gt  button  Deepens blue  0    BLUE   Press the     button  Weakens blue        Note      Adjust  COLOR TEMPERATURE  correctly  All colors will not be displayed properly unless adequate adjustment is made  If the adjustment  does not look suitable  you can press the   DEFAULT  button on the remote control to return the setting for the selected item only to the  factory default setting     Adjusting desired white balance based on existing color temperature settings    1  Press A V to select  COLOR TEMPERATURE      2  Press 4  or the  
130. PRECAUTIONS    1 1 1    Show the safety precautions message related to 3D viewing     1  Press A V to select  3D SAFETY PRECAUTIONS      2  Press the   ENTER  button       The  3D SAFETY PRECAUTIONS  screen is displayed     e Press 4P to switch the page     3D SAFETY PRECAUTIONS    If you view 3D images  please note below   In addition  when 3D images will be viewed  by unspecified number of people   or used for commercial applications   someone in authority should convey   the following precautions     To enjoy 3D images safely and comfortably   please refer to the Operating Instructions  for in depth description     4 gt  CHANGE  EXIT       3D SAFETY PRECAUTIONS    Please refrain from viewing 3D images   if you do not feel well or are experiencing  visual fatigue    Please use the contents which has been  properly made for 3D    View from at least the recommended distance    3 times the effective height of the screen     Refer to the Operating Instructions  if this message is no longer needed     4 gt  CHANGE  EXIT       ENGLISH   95    Chapter 4 Settings      DISPLAY OPTION  menu        DISPLAY OPTION  menu             On the menu screen  select  DISPLAY OPTION  from the main menu  and select an item from  the sub menu    Refer to    Navigating through the menu    page 65  for the operation of the menu screen    e After selecting the item  press A W   p to set                 Correct the color difference between projectors when using multiple projectors simultaneously     
131. Panasonic    Operating Instructions  Functional Manual    DLP    Projector    vaino PT DZ13KE  PT DS12KE  PT DW11KE  PT DZ10KE       W a 8he  B aii   anea       D   e      o  o  o  o    E   Bo   rj  eo  oo  oo  oo  2o    The projection lens is sold separately     Thank you for purchasing this Panasonic product     m The Operating Instructions correspond to the firmware s main version 4 04 and higher     m Before operating this product  please read the instructions carefully and save this manual  for future use     m Before using your projector  be sure to read  Read this first     pages 2 to 9         reaL D  3D  Paojectisle  com  au   Where  Brojectocs Por Knee  ENGLISH             TQBJ0522 3    Read this first        Read this first           WARNING  THIS APPARATUS MUST BE EARTHED           WARNING  To prevent damage which may result in fire or shock hazard  do not expose this appliance to rain  or moisture   This device is not intended for use in the direct field of view at visual display workplaces  To avoid  incommoding reflexions at visual display workplaces this device must not be placed in the direct  field of view   The equipment is not intended for used at a video workstation in compliance BildscharbV     The sound pressure level at the operator position is equal or less than 70 dB  A  according to ISO 7779           WARNING    1  Remove the plug from the mains socket when this unit is not in use for a prolonged period of time    2  To prevent electric shock  do no
132. Projection distance  L  formula  0 7 1 16 10 L 7 0 6063 x SD   0 0835  ET D75LE5 0 7 1 16 9 L 7 0 6220 x SD   0 0835  0 8 1 4 3 L 7 0 6850 x SD   0 0835  0 7 1 16 10 L 7 0 6072 x SD   0 0713  ET D75LE50 0 7 1 16 9 L 7 0 6240 x SD   0 0713  0 8 1 4 3 L   0 6873 x SD   0 0713  For PT DS12KE  E Zoom lens  Projection lens Model No  Throw ratio Aspect ratio Projection distance  L  formula     Min   LW  L   1 2087 x SD   0 0760  f Max   LT  L   1 6142 x SD   0 1004  ET D75LE1 1 5 to 2 0 1  160 Min   LW  L   1 3150 x SD   0 0760  i Max   LT  L   1 7559 x SD   0 1004  45 Min   LW  L   1 6220 x SD   0 0795  i Max   LT  L   2 4291 x SD   0 1064  ET D75LE2 2 0 to 3 0 1    d Min   LW  L   1 7638 x SD   0 0795  i Max   LT  L   2 6457 x SD   0 1064     Min   LW  L   2 4291 x SD   0 0958  i Max   LT  L   4 0591 x SD   0 1216  ET D75LE3 3 0 to 5 0 1    T Min   LW  L   2 6457 x SD   0 0958    Max   LT  L   4 4213 x SD   0 1216  4 Min   LW  L 7 4 0591 x SD   0 1158  i Max   LT  L   6 4528 x SD   0 1013  ET D75LE4 5 0 to 8 0 1    16 8 Min   LW  L   4 4213 x SD   0 1158    Max   LT  L   7 0315 x SD   0 1013  Min   LW  L   6 4567 x SD   0 3862  7 9 to 15 0 1 4 3  Max   LT  L   12 0945 x SD   0 3598  ET D75LE8    Min   LW  L   7 0315 x SD   0 3862  8 0 to 15 0 1 16 9  Max   LT  L   13 1732 x SD   0 3598  45 Min   LW  L   0 8150 x SD   0 0566  i Max   LT  L   0 9764 x SD   0 0736  ET D75LE6 1 0 to 1 2 1    16 8 Min   LW  L   0 8858 x SD   0 0566  i Max   LT  L   1 0630 x SD   0 0736  43 Min   LW  L
133. RATION  was executed  ask your dealer to repair the unit     56   ENGLISH    Chapter 3 Basic Operations     Projecting    Moving the  he  M    To move the lens to the home position  perform the following procedure        1  While the  SHIFT  adjustment screen is displayed  press the   DEFAULT  button     The  HOME POSITION  screen is displayed        2  While the  HOME POSITION  screen is displayed  for approximately five seconds   press the   ENTER    button     e  PROGRESS  is displayed in the  HOME POSITION  screen  and the lens returns to the home position   Note    The home position of the lens is the lens position when the lens is being replaced or when the projector is being stored  and it is not the    optical center of the screen     e You can also display the  HOME POSITION  screen by pressing the   LENS   button on the control panel or the  lt SHIFT gt  button on the  remote control for at least three seconds        Perform the lens position shift within the adjustment range   The focus may change when the lens position is shifted out of the adjustment range  This is because the movement of the lens is restricted    to protect the optical parts  Projection position can be adjusted with the optical axis shift based on the standard projection position in the  respective range        ET D75LE1  ET D75LE2  ET D75LE3  ET D75LE4   Projection lens Model No  ET D75LE8  ET D75LE10  ET D75LE20  ET D75LE6  ET D75LE30  ET D75LE40       Projection screen width H Projection scre
134. RK  menu          menu        On the menu screen  select  NETWORK  from the main menu  and select an item from the sub     Refer to    Navigating through the menu    page 65  for the operation of the menu screen   e After selecting the item  press A W   p to set                 Perform the initial setting of the network before using the network function   1   2     3     4     Press A V to select  NETWORK SETUP      Press the   ENTER  button     The  NETWORK SETUP  screen is displayed                       Press AY to select an item  and change the settings according to the operation instructions of the  menu    PROJECTOR NAME  Change the setting when using a DHCP server   Set to  ON  when obtaining an IP address automatically using a DHCP server  Set to  OFF  when not   BEEF  using a DHCP server    IP ADDRESS  Enter the IP address when not using a DHCP server    SUBNET MASK  Enter the subnet mask when not using a DHCP server    DEFAULT GATEWAY  Enter the default gateway address when not using a DHCP server    STORE  Save the current network settings              Press AY to select  STORE   and press the   ENTER  button     5  When the confirmation screen is displayed  press 4P to select  OK   and press the   ENTER    button     Note      When using a DHCP server  confirm that the DHCP server is running     Consult your network administrator regarding the IP address  subnet mask  and default gateway     When  Art Net SETUP  is set to  ON 2 X X X   or  ON 10 X X X     NETWORK 
135. SETTING       SDI 1 2   button   Projector body         Remote control  SDI IN      Security     SECURITY     SECURITY PASSWORD   SECURITY PASSWORD CHANGE   Selecting the input signal       SERIAL IN  terminal    SERIAL OUT gt  terminal     SERVICE PASSWORD      Setting remote control ID numbers  Setting up              SHARPNESS    SHIFT nise   lt SHIFT gt  button   Remote CODfLlol  se eesnin e petet 24  56   lt SHUTTER  gt  button   Projector body   Remote control      SHUTTER SETTING    SIGNAL LIST   Specifications  sRGB compliant video   STANDBY MODE              STARTUP INPUT SELECT    STARTUP LOGO      STATUS     STATUS   button   Remote control  Sub memory    Switching off the projector  Switching on the projector  Switching the input signal    SYSTEM DAYLIGHT VIEW    SYSTEM SELECTOR     T  Temperature indicator                          sss 158    TEST  button  Remote control      TEST PATTERN        ENGLISH   189                                    Index        TEXT CHANGE       TINT      Troubleshooting   Two window    U   UNIFORMITY     Upgrade Kit    V     VIDEO    button  Projector body  Remote control                  Ww   WAVEFORM MONITOR     106  Z   ZOOM  snnm 80    ZOOM    button   Remote control    sss 24  56    190   ENGLISH       A  A    m  c    Information for Users on Collection and Disposal of Old Equipment and used Batteries    These symbols on the products  packaging  and or accompanying documents mean that used  electrical and electronic products and 
136. SETUP  cannot be selected      NETWORK CONTROL  1 1 2 2    Set up the control method of the network     1   2     3     Press A V to select  NETWORK CONTROL      Press the   ENTER  button     The  NETWORK CONTROL  screen is displayed     Press A VW to select an item  and press q gt  to change the setting               WEB CONTROL  Set to  ON  to control with the web browser    PJLink CONTROL  Set to  ON  to control with the PJLink protocol    COMMAND CONTROL  Set to  ON  to control with the   SERIAL IN gt   lt SERIAL OUT gt  terminal control command format      page 176   Refer to    Control commands via LAN      page 171          COMMAND PORT     Set the port number used for command control         CRESTRON RoomView     Set to  ON  to control with RoomView of Crestron Electronics  Inc        Set to  ON  to control with the controller of AMX Corporation   Setting this function to  ON  enables detection through    AMX Device Discovery     For details  refer to          FAGES Deh the website of AMX Corporation   URL http   www amx com    STORE  Save the current network control settings           ENGLISH   137          Chapter 4 Settings      NETWORK  menu       4  Press A V to select  STORE   and press the   ENTER  button   5  When the confirmation screen is displayed  press 4P to select  OK   and press the   ENTER    button      NETWORK STATUS     1 1    Display the status of the projector network     1  Press A V to select  NETWORK STATUS      2  Press the   ENTER  button    
137. Settings      PICTURE  menu       2  Press q gt  or the   ENTER    button     The  CONTRAST  individual adjustment screen is displayed     3  Press 4b to adjust the level        Operation Adjustment    Range of adjustment       Press the  gt  button  Brightens the screen and makes the color deeper        Press the 4 button  Darkens the screen and makes the color lighter               31    31       Attention    e Adjust  BRIGHTNESS  first when you need to adjust the black level     You can adjust the dark  black  part of the projected image   1  Press A V to select  BRIGHTNESS      2  Press 4b or the   ENTER    button     The  BRIGHTNESS  individual adjustment screen is displayed       Press 4b to adjust the level     ao       Operation Adjustment    Range of adjustment       Press the  gt  button  Increases the brightness of the dark  black  parts of the screen        Press the 4 button           Reduces the brightness of the dark  black  parts of the screen         31    31       You can adjust the color saturation of the projected image   1  Press A V to select  COLOR      2  Press 4b or the   ENTER    button     The  COLOR  individual adjustment screen is displayed       Press 4b to adjust the level     oO       Operation Adjustment    Range of adjustment       Press the  gt  button  Deepens colors              Press the 4 button  Weakens colors         31    31       You can adjust the skin tone in the projected image   1  Press AY to select  TINT      2  Press q gt  or 
138. Standby 0 63  8 Power supply control   No operation 64 191 128      Power on 192 255  OFF 0 15  KEYSTONE 16 31   Only for PT DZ13KE   CURVED 32 47 PT DS12KE   PC 1 48 63 hs    9 GEOMETRY     255 To use  PC 1    PC 2   and   PC 2  64 79  PC 3   the optional Upgrade   PC 3  80 95 Kit  Model No   ET UK20  is  required   CORNER CORRECTION 96 111  No operation 112 255    170   ENGLISH       Chapter 6 Appendix     Technical information                                                 Channel Control details Performance Parameter Initial value Remark   OFF el  Only for PT DZ13KE    Pea  32 63 PT DS12KE    10 CUSTOM MASKING   PC 2  64 95 255 To use this function  the   PC 3  96 127 optional Upgrade Kit  Model  No operation 128 255 No   ET UK20  is required   Operation not available 0 127 When    Operation not   11 Lock 0 available    is set  operations  Operation available 128 255 of all channels become   unacceptable   Note    If the projector is operated with the remote control or on the control panel  or by the control command while controlling the projector using    the Art Net function  the setting of the DMX controller and the computer application may be different from the projector status  To reflect the  controls of all channels to the projector in that case  set    Lock    of channel 11 to    Operation not available    and then set back to    Operation    available        When    Light volume adjustment    in channel 1 is set to 0    image and on screen display disappear     
139. T D75LE1    Min   LW  L   1 6496 x SD   0 0760  2 0 to 2 7 1 4 3  Max   LT  L   2 2047 x SD   0 1004  Min   LW  L   1 8110 x SD   0 0795  2 1 to 3 1 1 16 9  Max   LT  L   2 7126 x SD   0 1064  ET D75LE2    Min   LW  L   2 2165 x SD   0 0795  2 7 to 4 1 1 4 3  Max   LT  L   3 3228 x SD   0 1064  Min   LW  L   2 7126 x SD   0 0958  3 1 to 5 2 1 16 9  Max   LT  L   4 5315 x SD   0 1216  ET D75LE3    Min   LW  L   3 3228 x SD   0 0958  4 1 to 6 9 1 4 3  Max   LT  L   5 5472 x SD   0 1216  Min   LW  L   4 5315 x SD   0 1158  5 2 to 8 2 1 16 9  Max   LT  L   7 2087 x SD   0 1013  ET D75LE4    Min   LW  L   5 5472 x SD   0 1158  6 9 to 11 0 1 4 3  Max   LT  L   8 8228 x SD   0 1013  Min   LW  L   7 2087 x SD   0 3862  8 2 to 15 4 1 16 9  Max   LT  L   13 5039 x SD   0 3598  ET D75LE8    Min   LW  L   8 8228 x SD   0 3862  10 9 to 20 5 1 4 3  Max   LT  L   16 5354 x SD   0 3598  Min   LW  L   0 9094 x SD   0 0566  1 0 to 1 2 1 16 9  Max   LT  L   1 0906 x SD   0 0736  ET D75LE6 A  Min   LW  L   1 1142 x SD   0 0566  1 4 to 1 6 1 4 3  Max   LT  L   1 3346 x SD   0 0736  Min   LW  L   1 2759 x SD   0 0857  1 4 to 1 9 1 16 9  Max   LT  L   1 6491 x SD   0 1085  ET D75LE10    Min   LW  L   1 5620 x SD   0 0857  1 9 to 2 5 1 4 3  Max   LT  L   2 0190 x SD   0 1085                      44   ENGLISH             Chapter 2 Getting Started     Setting up                                                 Projection lens Model No  Throw ratio Aspect ratio Projection distance  L  formula  Min   LW 
140. TANDBY MODE    2  Press 4b to switch the item       The items will switch each time you press the button         NORMAL  Use this setting to use the network function during standby                  ECO  Use this setting to reduce power consumption during standby        Note      When set to  ECO   network functions    SERIAL OUT  terminal  and some RS 232C commands are not available during standby     When set to  ECO   it may take approx  10 seconds longer before the projector starts projecting after the power is turned on  compared with  when  NORMAL  is set     116   ENGLISH    Chapter 4 Settings      PROJECTOR SETUP  menu     SCHEDULE      1 1 1 1    Set the command execution schedule for each day of the week        Enabling disabling the schedule function    1  Press A V to select  SCHEDULE    2  Press 4b to switch the item       The items will switch each time you press the button                     OFF  Disables the schedule function    ON  Enables the schedule function  Refer to    How to assign a program      page 117  or    How to set a  program   9 page 117  for how to set the schedule        Note      When  SCHEDULE  is set to  ON   the  STANDBY MODE  setting is forcibly switched to  NORMAL   and the setting cannot be changed   Even if  SCHEDULE  is then set to  OFF  when in this state  the setting of  STANDBY MODE  remains at  NORMAL      How to assign a program    1  Press A V to select  SCHEDULE      2  Press 4b to select  ON   and press the   ENTER  button   
141. TING  cannot be set when  3D SIMUL INPUT SETTING  is set to  AUTO   The backup operation is not performed    either    BACKUP INPUT SETTING  cannot be set when  SDI LINK  is set to  DUAL LINK   The backup operation is not performed either      RGB IN  1    Set to match the signal to input to the  lt RGB 1 IN gt  terminal     Setting  RGB1 INPUT SETTING     1  Press A V to select  RGB IN      2  Press the   ENTER  button       The  RGB IN  screen is displayed     3  Press AY to select  RGB1 INPUT SETTING      4  Press 4b to switch the item       The items will switch each time you press the button         RGB YP amp P   Select when inputting an RGB signal or YCgCr YPgPp signals to the   RGB 1 IN   terminal    Y C  Select when inputting a luminance signal and color signal to the   RGB 1 IN   terminal                    Switching the slice level of an input sync signal    1  Press A V to select  RGB IN      2  Press the   ENTER  button       The  RGB IN  screen is displayed     3  Press A V to select  RGB1 SYNC SLICE LEVEL  or  RGB2 SYNC SLICE LEVEL      4  Press 4b to switch the item         LOW  Sets the slice level to  LOW J    HIGH  Sets the slice level to  HIGH                     100   ENGLISH    Chapter 4 Settings      DISPLAY OPTION  menu     DVI D IN  00000 0    Switch the setting when the external device is connected to the   DVI D IN   terminal of the projector and the image is not projected correctly        1  Press A V to select  DVI D IN      2  Press the   ENTER  
142. TPATTERN  of  COLOR MATCHING       Adjustment of the tilt of the border between  NON OVERLAPPED BLACK LEVEL  and  BLACK BORDER LEVEL  is a function to perform  the adjustment of  GEOMETRY   9 page 81  together with the edge blending  If  NON OVERLAPPED BLACK LEVEL  is tilted by  correcting the keystone from  KEYSTONE  in  GEOMETRY   perform Steps 17  and 18  to adjust the edge blending according to the shape  of  NON OVERLAPPED BLACK LEVEL       When the keystone is corrected with  KEYSTONE   the edge blending cannot be adjusted together   Only for PT DW11KE      FRAME RESPONSE                         4     Set image frame delay   1  Press A V to select  FRAME RESPONSE    2  Press 4b to switch the item       The items will switch each time you press the button                     NORMAL  Standard setting    FAST  Simplifies the image processing to reduce image frame delay    FIXED   Sets image frame delay to be constant regardless of the image position or magnification         1 When input signals are other than interlaced signals   FAST  cannot be set    2 Only when movie based signals and still image signals with the vertical scanning frequency of 50 Hz or 60 Hz are input    Note      When  FRAME RESPONSE  is set to  FAST   picture quality deteriorates  Also   DIGITAL CINEMA REALITY  cannot be set      FRAME RESPONSE  cannot be set during P IN P     88   ENGLISH    Chapter 4 Settings      ADVANCED MENU  menu     FRAME LOCK                         Only for PT DZ13KE  PT DS12
143. The  CALIBRATION TIME  setting will be reflected at the time when you enter the time      The  CALIBRATION MESSAGE  setting will be reflected at the time when items are switched using q gt      Displaying  BRIGHTNESS CONTROL STATUS     Display the brightness control status     1  Press A V to select  BRIGHTNESS CONTROL      2  Press the   ENTER  button     The  BRIGHTNESS CONTROL  screen is displayed     3  Press A V to select  BRIGHTNESS CONTROL STATUS      4  Press the   ENTER  button     The  BRIGHTNESS CONTROL STATUS  screen is displayed      BRIGHTNESS CONTROL STATUS  screen display example    When  MODE  of  BRIGHTNESS CONTROL SETUP  is set to When  MODE  of  BRIGHTNESS CONTROL SETUP  is set to    OFF   AUTO  and  LINK  is set to  OFF    The screen shows the status that the brightness control is disabled  The screen shows the status of the brightness control in one  ja    EE E    BRIGHTNESS CONTROL STATUS  l                        P      Q       5  H PROJECTOR 1                Quy RETURN    RETURN       114   ENGLISH    Chapter 4 Settings      PROJECTOR SETUP  menu       When  MODE  of  BRIGHTNESS CONTROL SETUP  is set to When  MODE  of  BRIGHTNESS CONTROL SETUP  is set to   AUTO  and  LINK  is set from  GROUP A  to  GROUP D   PC   The screen shows the status of the brightness control of    synchronized projectors  up to eight units   including the projector  being controlled through the on screen menu  5      ood   PROJECTOR 4  ui  ii 1         T      E  PROJECTOR 192 
144. The projector can display 3D video signals that are input through various systems such as  frame packing  and  side by side    You are required to prepare external devices for viewing 3D images  such as 3D eyewear  video signal output devices  which    are suitable for your 3D system  For connections of the projector and external devices  they are different depends on the 3D  system to be used  see the operating instructions of external devices you use     Refer to    List of 3D compatible signals    page 181  for the types of 3D video signals that can be used with the projector     Sof inf l ling thi j          Panasonic Corporation 2013   This product is equipped with the following software     1  Software which is developed independently by or for Panasonic Corporation    2  Software which is licensed under GNU GENERAL PUBLIC LICENSE    3  Software which is licensed under GNU LESSER GENERAL PUBLIC LICENSE   For license conditions related to software in  2  and  3   refer to the provisions of the software licenses  GNU GENERAL  PUBLIC LICENSE and GNU LESSER GENERAL PUBLIC LICENSE  in the supplied CD ROM   Those provisions are written  in English because they have been stipulated by third parties     If you have any questions regarding the software  please contact us via email  sav pj gpl pavc ml jp panasonic com               ENGLISH   19    Chapter1 Preparation     Precautions for use          Make sure that the following accessories are provided with your projector  Numbe
145. Vertical  60 Hz  750  720  60p   Horizontal  45 kHz  Vertical  60 Hz  1125  1035  60i   Horizontal  33 75 kHz  Vertical  60 Hz  1125  1080  50i   Horizontal  28 13 kHz  Vertical  50 Hz  1125  1080y24sF   Horizontal  27 kHz  Vertical  48 Hz  1125  1080  30p   Horizontal  33 75 kHz  Vertical  30 Hz    625i  576i    Horizontal  15 63 kHz  Vertical  50 Hz  625p  576p    Horizontal  31 25 kHz  Vertical  50 Hz  750  720  50p   Horizontal  37 5 kHz  Vertical  50 Hz  1125  1080  60i   Horizontal  33 75 kHz  Vertical  60 Hz  1125  1080  24p   Horizontal  27 kHz  Vertical  24 Hz  1125  1080  25p   Horizontal  28 13 kHz  Vertical  25 Hz  1125  1080  60p   Horizontal  67 5 kHz  Vertical  60 Hz    e 1125  1080  50p  Horizontal  56 25 kHz  Vertical  50 Hz    The SYNC HD and VD terminals do not support 3 value SYNC     525i  480i  t  625i  576i  1  525p  480p   625p  576p   750  720  60p  750  720  50p   1125  1080  60i  1125  1080  50i  1125  1080  24p    1125  1080  24sF  1125  1080  25p  1125  1080  30p    1125  1080  60p  1125  1080  50p     Displayable resolution  VGA to WUXGA  non interlaced      Dot clock frequency  25 MHz to 162 MHz   525i  480i     625i  576i  1  525p  480p   625p  576p   750  720  60p  750  720  50p   1125  1080  60i  1125  1080  50i  1125  1080  24p    1125  1080  24sF  1125  1080  25p  1125  1080  30p    1125  1080  60p  1125  1080  50p      Displayable resolution  VGA to WUXGA  non interlaced     Dot clock frequency  25 MHz to 162 MHz    SD SDI signal SMPTE ST 
146. WEEK    8  Press 4b to switch the item      SUNDAY    MONDAY    TUESDAY    WEDNESDAY  Switches the lamp automatically on the set day of the week    THURSDAY    FRIDAY    SATURDAY                                   Note      The  LAMP RELAY  function is enabled when  SINGLE  or  DUAL  is selected in  LAMP SELECT      When  DUAL  is selected in  LAMP SELECT   only one lamp will light for four hours from the specified time   e The operating time will be the local time     page 122     ENGLISH   111    Chapter4 Settings      PROJECTOR SETUP  menu     LAMP POWER  1 1    Switch the brightness of the lamp according to the operating environment of the projector or the purpose        1  Press A V to select  LAMP POWER    2  Press 4b to switch the item                     HIGH   Select when high luminance is required    MIDDLET  Select when using the projector with slightly reduced luminance compared to  HI GH     NORMAL   Select when high luminance is required    ECO  Select when high luminance is not required            1 Only for PT DZ13KE  PT DS12KE  PT DW11KE   2 Onlyfor PT DZ10KE    Note       HIGH  cannot be selected when the optional Replacement lamp unit  for portrait mode   Model No   ET LAD320P  1 pc   ET LAD320PW   2 pcs   is used  Even when  HIGH  is selected while the normal lamp unit is used  the setting is switched to  MIDDLE  automatically if the  optional Replacement lamp unit  for portrait mode  is used      You can reduce power consumption and operation noise  and ex
147. When web control administrator rights password is set  Protect mode     Connecting    1     Obtain the IP address and port number  Initial set value   1024  of the projector and request for a  connection to the projector     You can obtain both the IP address and the port number from the menu screen of the projector        IP address    Obtain from the main menu     gt   NETWORK   gt   NETWORK STATUS        Port number          Obtain from the main menu  gt   NETWORK   gt   NETWORK CONTROL     COMMAND PORT                                                                          2  Check the response from the projector   Data section Blank Mode Blank Random number section Termination  symbol  Command  NTCONTROL  i Es 2    ZZZZZZZZ     CR   example  ASCII string  0x20 0x31 0x20  ASCII code hex number  Ox0d  Data length 9 bytes 1 byte 1 byte 1 byte 8 bytes 1 byte    Mode  1   Protect mode  3  Generate a 32 byte hash value from the following data using MD5 algorithm         XXXXXX YYYYY ZZZZZZZZ     XXXXXX Administrator rights user name for the web control  default user name is    admin1      yyyyy Password of above administrator rights user  default password is  panasonic    ZZZZZZZz 8 byte random number obtained in Step 2   Command transmission method  Transmit using the following command formats   B Transmitted data  Header Data section Termination  symbol  Command Hash value    0    0 Control command  CR   example  Refer to    Connecting    above  0x30 0x30  ASCII string  Ox0
148. a standard for medical imaging devices  Although the    DICOM name is used  the projector is not a medical device  and should not be used for purposes such as diagnosis of display images     Changing the name of  USER1  or  USER2     1   2     3   4     5     6   7     Press AY to select  GAMMA      Press 4  or the   ENTER  button     The  GAMMA  individual adjustment screen is displayed     Press q gt  to select  USER1  or  USER2      Press the   ENTER  button     The  GAMMA  screen is displayed     Press the   ENTER  button     The  GAMMA NAME CHANGE  screen is displayed     Press A V   4b to select the text  and press the   ENTER  button to enter the text     Press A V 4b to select  OK   and press the   ENTER  button       The selected gamma name is changed     Note      When a name is changed  display of  USER1    USER2  is also changed      SYSTEM DAYLIGHT VIEW     You can correct the image to the optimal vividness even if it is projected under a bright light     1   2     3     Press A V to select  SYSTEM DAYLIGHT VIEW      Press 4  or the   ENTER  button     The  SYSTEM DAYLIGHT VIEW  individual adjustment screen is displayed     Press 4P to switch the item     The items will switch each time you press the button                  OFF  No correction    1  Corrects the image to weaken vividness    2  Corrects the image to medium vividness    3  Corrects the image to high vividness                  SHARPNESS       1 1 1    You can adjust the sharpness of the projected ima
149. ailable when the power of the projector is turned off           5 Menu screen control buttons  Navigates the menu screen     6 Freeze image quality adjustment   Controls items related to freeze image quality   7  Back    Performs return to the previous page                                                                    lima   niiki  Gi I n   o  1  2  3  4  5       1  Control System   Set the information required for communicating with the  controller to be connected with the projector    2  User Password   Set the user rights password for the RoomView control page    3  Admin Password   Set the administrator rights password for the RoomView control  page        4 Network status  Displays the settings of wired LAN    DHCP   Displays the current setting    Ip Address   Displays the current setting    Subnet Mask   Displays the current setting    Default Gateway   Displays the current setting    DNS Server   Displays the current setting   5  Exit   Returns to the control page     ENGLISH   155    Chapter 4 Settings      NETWORK  menu        Info  page    Click  Info  on the control page      o x    a FE  gt  Ar BOX  d osrin Ram Con                                                                           1  Projector Name  5  Source   Displays the projector name  Displays the selected input   2  Mac Address  6  Lamp Mode   Displays the MAC address  Displays  LAMP POWER    page 112    3  Lamp Hours  7  Error Status   Displays the runtime of the lamps  converted value   Displa
150. ailed    EN  atl ENTAKE AIR TEMPERATURE    vr mmm  OPTICS MODULE TEMPERATURE vcowr mmm  vr mmm    Change AROUND LAMP TEMPERATURE  password    TF  LAMPI OFF RUNTIME un   Ud on RUNTIME iH    PROJECTOR RUNTIME  UH SELF TEST    140   ENGLISH    Chapter 4 Settings      NETWORK  menu       Note    e  f you use a web browser to control the projector  set  WEB CONTROL  to  ON  in  NETWORK CONTROL   9 page 137       Do not perform setting or control simultaneously by starting up multiple web browsers  Do not set or control the projector from multiple  computers    e Change the password first    page 153    e The administrator rights allow use of all functions  The user rights allow use of  Projector status      page 142   confirmation of the error  information page   page 143    Network status      page 144    Basic control     amp  page 145   and  Change password    page 153   only      Access will be locked for few minutes when an incorrect password is entered three times consecutively    e Some items on the projector setting page use the Javascript function of the web browser  The projector may not be able to be controlled  properly if it is set with a browser that does not have this function enabled    e  f the screen for the web control is not displayed  consult your network administrator      While updating the screen for the web control  the screen may become white for a moment  but it is not a malfunction     Descriptions of items                                        Bitte W
151. al device which outputs  signals  A phase difference may occur between the LINK A signal and the LINK B signal and images may not be projected properly   Only  for PT DZ13KE  PT DS12KE      When an unsteady signal is connected  an error in signal detection may occur  In such a case  use the  PICTURE  menu  gt   SYSTEM  SELECTOR  to switch to a system that matches the signal format                                Control computer                                                                                     Control computer    Computer Computer    Attention      When connecting the projector to a computer or an external device  use the power cord supplied with each device and commercially  available shielded cables   e Use a commercial cable with a ferrite core for connecting with the  lt DVI D IN  terminal     Note      When entering DVI D  some external devices to be connected may require switching the setting using the  DISPLAY OPTION  menu  gt    DVI D IN       EDID       For an HDMI cable  use an HDMI High Speed cable that conforms to HDMI standards  If a cable that does not conform to HDMI standards  is used  images may be interrupted or may not be displayed      The   HDMI IN  terminal of the projector can be connected to an external device with a DVI D terminal by using an HDMI DVI conversion  cable  but some devices may not project the image properly or function properly      The   DVI D IN   terminal supports single links only      When entering the SYNC ON GREEN
152. and stage system can be controlled  Art Net is made based  on DMX512 communication protocol     To dispose of the product  ask your local authorities or dealer for correct methods of disposal   The lamp contains mercury  When disposing of used lamp units  contact your local authorities or dealer for correct methods of  disposal     E To get a good picture quality    In order to view a beautiful image in higher contrast  prepare an appropriate environment  Draw curtains or blinds over  windows and turn off any lights near the screen to prevent outside light or light from indoor lamps from shining onto the screen     18   ENGLISH    Chapter1 Preparation     Precautions for use       E Do not touch the surface of the projection lens with your bare hands    If the surface of the projection lens becomes dirty from fingerprints or anything else  this will be magnified and projected onto  the screen    Attach the supplied lens cover to the projection lens when you do not use the projector     B DLP chips      The DLP chips are precision made  Note that in rare cases  pixels of high precision could be missing or always lit  Note that  such phenomena does not indicate malfunction       Directing a high power laser beam onto the lens surface can damage the DLP chips     E Do not move the projector or subject it to vibration or impact while it is operating   Doing so may shorten the life of the built in motor     E Lamp    The light source of the projector is a high pressure mercury lam
153. and time manually    1  Press A VW to select  DATE AND TIME      2  Press the   ENTER  button     The  DATE AND TIME  screen is displayed     3  Press A V to select  ADJUST CLOCK      122   ENGLISH    Chapter 4 Settings      PROJECTOR SETUP  menu       4  Press the  lt ENTER gt  button     The  ADJUST CLOCK  screen is displayed     5  Press A V to select an item  and press 4P to set the local date and time     6  Press A V to select  APPLY   and press the   ENTER  button       The setting of the date and time will be completed     Setting the date and time automatically    1  Press A VW to select  DATE AND TIME      2  Press the   ENTER  button     The  DATE AND TIME  screen is displayed     3  Press A V to select  ADJUST CLOCK      4  Press the   ENTER  button     The  ADJUST CLOCK  screen is displayed     5  Press A V to select  NTP SYNCHRONIZATION   and press q gt  to change the setting to  ON    6  Press AY to select  APPLY   and press the   ENTER  button       The setting of the date and time will be completed     Note      To set the date and time automatically  the projector must be connected to the network       f synchronization with the NTP server fails just after  NTP SYNCHRONIZATION  is turned  ON   or if  NTP SYNCHRONIZATION  is turned   ON  while the NTP server is not set   NTP SYNCHRONIZATION  will return to  OFF     e Access the projector via a web browser to set the NTP server  Refer to   Adjust clock  page    page 147  for details     Automatically set the l
154. arameters according  to the details of control     ID designate  ZZ  01 to 06    n pie        2 bytes     Pei   c2   c3      aoga    End  1 byte   us  undefined length        Colon  1 byte   3 command characters  3 S  Semi colon  1 byte     2 ID characters  2 bytes   Start  1 byte     Basic format  has subcommands     Same as the basic format            E PIENE                      P1   P2   Pa   Pa   P5   Pe               Parameter  6 bytes           Sub command  5 bytes     Symbol         or  bytes          1 byte  and setting or adjustment value  5  Operation  1 byte               Set the value specified using parameter      1 When transmitting a command which does not need a parameter  an operation  E  and parameter are not necessary     174   ENGLISH    Chapter 6 Appendix     Technical information       Attention    e  f a command is transmitted after the lamp starts illuminating  there may be a delay in response or the command may not be executed  Try  sending or receiving any command after 60 seconds      When transmitting multiple commands  be sure to wait until 0 5 seconds has elapsed after receiving the response from the projector before  sending the next command  When transmitting a command which does not need a parameter  a colon     is not necessary     Note    If a command cannot be executed  the    ER401    response is sent from the projector to the computer    If an invalid parameter is sent  the    ER402    response is sent from the projector to the computer 
155. arby metallic objects to eliminate static  electricity from your body before performing work      Do not use unnecessarily long cables to connect to a device connected to the projector or to the projector body  The longer the cable  the  more it is susceptible to noise  Since using a cable while it is wound makes it act like an antenna  it is more susceptible to noise      When connecting cables  connect GND first  then insert the connecting terminal of the connecting device in a straight manner      Acquire any connection cable necessary to connect the external device to the system that is neither supplied with the device nor available  as an option      Video signals containing too much jitter may cause the images on the screen to randomly wobble or wafture  In this case  a time base   corrector  TBC  must be connected    The projector accepts video signals  including Y C signals   analog RGB signals  synchronous signals are TTL level   and digital signals    Some computer models are not compatible with the projector    Use a cable compensator when you connect devices to the projector using long cables  Otherwise the image may not display properly    Refer to    List of compatible signals    page 179  for the types of video signals that can be used with the projector          RGB 2 IN   terminal pin assignments and signal names                                              Outside view Pin No  Signal name Pin No  Signal name   1  R PR  9      11       15   2  G Y  10  GND   
156. as been adjusted  the lens mounter has focus adjustment screws in three  locations       Tool used  Hex driver or Allen wrench  diagonal 2 5 mm  3 32       The Allen wrench is included with the projection lens ET D75LE6  ET D75LE8     Lens mounter structure    Focus adjustment screws  a    b   and  c  can be turned to move the lens mount bracket back and forth   Also  tightening the fixed screws locks the lens mount bracket in place so it does not move     When a projection lens with a large weight is installed  or when the projector is installed on an inclination  the lens may tilt and the focus may    become unbalanced  In these cases  perform adjustment by referring to the relationship between the adjustment location and adjustment  Screws     58   ENGLISH    Chapter 3 Basic Operations     Projecting       B Front view diagram of the lens mounter  viewed from the screen side     Lens mount bracket Fixing screws                            All                            Note      Focus adjustment screws  a    b   and  c  are adjusted with the lens attached     Adjustment procedure    B Relationship between the adjustment location and adjustment screws                                                                  Adjustment location        inner side of the screen    Location where the just focus point of the screen is in the        a     When the just focus point of  the screen in V up  top in the  vertical direction  is in the inner  side of the screen    Rotate counterc
157. batteries should not be mixed with general household  waste  For proper treatment  recovery and recycling of old products and used batteries  please  take them to applicable collection points  in accordance with your national legislation and the  Directives 2002 96 EC and 2006 66 EC     By disposing of these products and batteries correctly  you will help to save valuable resources  and prevent any potential negative effects on human health and the environment which could  otherwise arise from inappropriate waste handling     For more information about collection and recycling of old products and batteries  please contact  your local municipality  your waste disposal service or the point of sale where you purchased the  items     Penalties may be applicable for incorrect disposal of this waste  in accordance with national  legislation     For business users in the European Union  If you wish to discard electrical and electronic equipment  please contact your dealer or supplier  for further information     Information on Disposal in other Countries outside the European Union  These symbols are only valid in the European Union  If you wish to discard these items  please  contact your local authorities or dealer and ask for the correct method of disposal     Note for the battery symbol  bottom two symbol examples    This symbol might be used in combination with a chemical symbol  In this case it complies with  the requirement set by the Directive for the chemical involved       
158. ble   Electric shocks can result     Do not do anything that might damage the power cord or the power plug   If the power cord is used while damaged  electric shocks  short circuits or fire will result   e Do not damage the power cord  make any modifications to it  place it near any hot objects  bend it  excessively  twist it  pull it  place heavy objects on top of it or wrap it into a bundle   Ask an Authorized Service Center to carry out any repairs to the power cord that might be necessary     Completely insert the power plug into the wall outlet and the power connector into the projector terminal   If the plug is not inserted correctly  electric shocks or overheating will result   e Do not use plugs which are damaged or wall outlets which are coming loose from the wall     Do not use anything other than the provided power cord   Failure to observe this will result in fire or electric shocks  Please note that if you do not use the provided power  cord to ground the device on the side of the outlet  this may result in electric shocks     Clean the power plug regularly to prevent it from becoming covered in dust    Failure to observe this will cause a fire   e  f dust builds up on the power plug  the resulting humidity can damage the insulation   e  f not using the projector for an extended period of time  pull the power plug out from the wall outlet   Pull the power plug out from the wall outlet and wipe it with a dry cloth regularly     Do not handle the power plug and pow
159. bols that indicate formats are as follows                                                                                     V  VIDEO  Y C    R  RGB    Y  YCgCrR YPePR    D  DVI D    H  HDMI    S  SDI    Scanning freq  Dot clock Plug and play     Mode S Horizontal   Vertical freq  Format DVI D   kHz   Hz   MHz  ROB  EDID1   EDID2   EDID3 MI  gens UTD  720 x 480i 15 7 59 9     V              PAL PAL N SECAM 720 x 576i 15 6 50 0     V                      525i  480i  720 x 480i 15 7 59 9 13 5 R YIS                  625i  576i  720 x 576i 15 6 50 0 13 5 R YIS                      525i  480i  720 1440 x480i3  15 7 59 9 27 0 D H              625i  576i  720  1440  x 576i    15 6 50 0 27 0 D H              525p  480p  720 x 483 31 5 59 9 27 0 R YID H      A     a V  625p  576p  720 x 576 31 3 50 0 27 0 R Y D H   JV       A  750  720  60p 1280 x 720 45 0 60 0 74 3 R YID H S     M     Z y  750  720  50p 1280 x 720 37 5 50 0 74 3 R YID H S             A  1125  1080  60i 4 1 920 x 1 080i 33 8 60 0 74 3 R YID H S     J     V V  1125  1080  50i 1 920 x 1 080i 28 1 50 0 74 3 R Y D H S     J       V  1125  1080  24p 1920 x 1 080 27 0 24 0 74 3 R Y D H S   PA       V  1125  1080  24sF 1 920 x 1 080i 270   480 74 3 R YID H S                  1125  1080  25p 1920 x 1 080 28 1 25 0 74 3 R YID H S      4             1125  1080  30p 1920 x 1 080 33 8 30 0 74 3 R YIDIHIS                1125  1080  60p 1 920 x 1 080 67 5 60 0 148 5 R YIDIH S   5           V  1125  1080  50p 1920 x 1 080 56 3 50 0
160. button     The  DVI D IN  screen is displayed     3  Press A V to select  EDID      4  Press 4b to switch the item       The items will switch each time you press the button         EDID3  Recognizes movie based video signals and still image signals automatically        Select mainly when an external device that outputs movie based video signals  such as a blu ray disc    i  player  is connected to the  lt DVI D IN gt  terminal        Select mainly when an external device that outputs still image signals  such as a computer  is     EDID2 PC  connected to the   DVI D IN  terminal                 5  Press A V to select  SIGNAL LEVEL    6  Press 4b to switch the item       The items will switch each time you press the button         AUTO  Automatically sets the signal level         0 255 PC  Select when an external device  such as a computer  is connected via the DVI D terminal output         16 235  Select when an external device  such as a blu ray disc player  is connected via the HDMI terminal  output using a conversion cable  etc              Note      The optimal setting varies depending on the output setting of the connected external device  Refer to the operating instructions of the  external device regarding the output of the external device    e The data for Plug and play will change when the setting is changed  Refer to    List of compatible signals       page 179  for a resolution that  supports plug and play      HDMI IN  K    Switch the setting when the external dev
161. can change the settings by menu operations   Adjust the focus to display the menu screen clearly     You may also need to adjust the zoom and shift   Refer to    Adjusting the focus  zoom  and shift      page 56  for details     1  Press AW 4b to adjust the focus            ADJUST       2  Press the  lt MENU gt  button to proceed to the initial setting     EATE      Select the language to show on the screen   After completed the initial setting  you can change the display language from the  DISPLAY LANGUAGE  menu     1  Press A V to select the display language     INITIAL SETTING 113    Please select DISPLAY LANGUAGE       SELECT  SET       2  Press the  lt ENTER gt  button to proceed to the initial setting     22   ENGLISH    Chapter1 Preparation     Start up display       Initial setting  installati a    Set  PROJECTION METHOD  and  COOLING CONDITION  depending on the installation mode  Refer to    Installation mode    page 31   for details     Set  HIGH ALTITUDE MODE  to  ON  when using the projector at high altitudes between 1 400 m  4 593   or higher and lower than 2 700 m   8 858   above sea level     After completed the initial setting  you can change the settings of each item from the  PROJECTOR SETUP  menu     1  Press AY to select an item     2  Press 4b to switch the setting     INITIAL SETTING 2 3  PROJECTION METHOD E  FRONT FLOOR Q    When PROJECTION METHOD is changed  confirm that  COOLING CONDITION is set correctly     AUTO    It may shorten the life of the lam
162. cation                                                                                                                                        When connected to a computer When multiple projectors are connected   1  NC NC  1 1  NC NC  1   2 2 2 2   3 3 3 3  Projector 4 INC NC   4 Computer Projector 1 4 INC NC  4 Projector 2     SERIAL IN   terminal     5    DTE specifications     SERIAL OUT      z   SERIAL IN    terminal  terminal    6  NC NC  6 6 INC NC  6   7 7 7 7   8 8 8 8   9  NC NC  9 9 INC NC  9                                        ENGLISH   175    Chapter 6 Appendix     Technical information       Control command    The following table lists the commands that can be used to control the projector using a computer     E Projector control command                                                          Command Details EMS ECE Remark  parameter   string  PON Power on          To check if the power is on  use the  Power query  command   POF Power standby  000 STANDBY  QPW Power query 001 Poweron  VID VIDEO  RG1 RGB1  2   RG2 RGB2  IIS Switching the input DVI DVI D  signal  HD1 HDMI  SD1 SDI1  only for PT DZ13KE  PT DS12KE  PT DZ10KE   SD2 SDI2  only for PT DZ13KE  PT DS12KE   0 DUAL  QSL Q for   lecti 1 nang  uery for lamp selection  ii E 2 LAMP1  3 LAMP2  0 DUAL    1 SINGLE   LPM Lamp selection  2 LAMP1  3 LAMP2    HIGH  only for PT DZ13KE  PT DS12KE  PT DW11KE   NORMAL  only for PT DZ10KE   OLP Lamp power  1 ECO  8 MIDDLE  only for PT DZ13KE  PT DS12KE  PT DW11KE     1 
163. cator   Flashes if any button in the remote control is pressed    Power standby  lt   gt  button   Sets the projector to the state where the projector is switched  off  standby mode  when the   MAIN POWER  switch on the  projector is set to  lt ON gt  and in projection mode    Power on  lt   gt  button   Starts projection when the   MAIN POWER  switch on the  projector is set to   ON   when the power is switched off   standby mode     Input selection   lt RGB1 gt    lt RGB2 gt    lt DVI D gt     VIDEO      lt HDMI gt    lt SDI 1 2    buttons   Switches the input signal to project    page 62      MENU    button   ENTER  button A V 4  buttons   Used to navigate through the menu screen    page 65     ON SCREEN  button   Switches on  display   off  hide  the on screen display function    9 page 61     lt TEST gt  button   Displays the test pattern    page 63    Number   lt 0 gt     lt 9 gt   buttons   Used when the system uses multiple projectors    Used to input ID numbers or passwords      STATUS  button   Displays the projector information     lt LIGHT gt  button   Pressing this button lights up the remote control buttons  The  lights will go off when the remote control operation goes idle for  10 seconds     Attention      Do not drop the remote control     Avoid contact with liquids or moisture     Do not attempt to modify or disassemble the remote control     24   ENGLISH    B Side    20           19            13    14    15    16    17    18    19    20  21    B Top    B 
164. cause short circuits or  overheating  and result in electric shock or fire     Keep accessories  screws  out of the reach of small children   Accidentally swallowing them can cause physical harm   e  f you believe that parts have been swallowed  seek medical advice immediately     Remove the depleted batteries from the remote control promptly   e Leaving them in the unit may result in fluid leakage  overheating  or explosion of the batteries              6   ENGLISH    Read this first              CAUTION     E POWER    When disconnecting the power cord  be sure to hold the power plug and power connector   If the power cord itself is pulled  the lead will become damaged  and fire  short circuits or serious electric shocks  will result     When not using the projector for an extended period of time  disconnect the power plug from the wall  outlet   Failure to do so may result in fire or electric shock     Disconnect the power plug from the wall outlet before carrying out any cleaning and replacing the unit   Failure to do so may result in electric shock     B ONUSE INSTALLATION    Do not place heavy objects on top of the projector   Failure to observe this will cause the projector to become unbalanced and fall  which could result in damage or  injury  The projector will be damaged or deformed     Do not put your weight on this projector   You could fall or the projector could break  and injury will result   e Be especially careful not to let young children stand or sit on the 
165. combination list                       178  Control device password    178  Upgrade Kit soccer 179  List of compatible signals    179  Specifications    184  Dimensions            eee 187  Precautions for Ceiling Mount Bracket for  Projectors    rete denda eed edid 188  Index    cette e rete cmm 189    14   ENGLISH    Chapter1 Preparation       This chapter describes things you need to know or check before using the projector     ENGLISH   15    Chapter1 Preparation     Precautions for use       Precautions for use  sauti        The projection lens  optional  is susceptible to effects due to vibration or impact  Make sure to remove the lens when  transporting       When transporting the projector  hold it securely by its bottom and avoid excessive vibration and impacts  They may damage  the internal components and result in malfunctions       Do not transport the projector with the adjustable feet extended  Doing so may damage the adjustable feet     Cantiaps Ear TS    E After removing the projection lens  optional   attach the dust sponge included with the  projector     Otherwise dust will accumulate inside and may cause malfunctions        E Do not set up the projector outdoors   The projector is designed for indoor use only     E Do not set up the projector in the following locations       Places where vibration and impacts occur such as in a car or vehicle  Doing so may cause damage to internal components  or malfunction    Near the exhaust of an air conditioner  Dependi
166. connected to an external device with a DVI D terminal by using an HDMI DVI conversion  cable  but some devices may not project the image properly or function properly      The projector does not support VIERA Link  HDMI      ENGLISH   49    Chapter 2 Getting Started     Connecting       For  lt SDLIN 12   SDI IN 2 gt  terminals  PT DZ13KE  PT DS12KE     SDI IN   terminal  PT DZ10KE     The connection example is for PT DZ13KE  PT DS12KE     Digital VCR for commercial use          BB  da    a poo  E REA Oe ee a a a on a wo                   BERT Q Te NC NCAE DERE C c CREE  SD SDI signal  HD SDI signal or 3G SDI    signal          Note      Use the  PICTURE  menu      SYSTEM SELECTOR  to switch the input format    e Some external devices to be connected require the  DISPLAY OPTION  menu     gt   SDI IN  to be set      Use a 5CFB or higher  such as 5CFB  or 7CFB  or a Belden 1694A or higher connection cable to properly transmit images  Use a  connection cable of 100 m  328 1   length or less      To enter dual link signals  the  SDI LINK  in  SDI IN  must be set   Only for PT DZ13KE  PT DS12KE      Use the same length and same type of cables to connect  lt SDI IN 1 gt   lt SDI IN 2   terminals when entering dual link signals  If there is a  difference of 4 m  13 1   or greater in cable length  images may not be projected properly   Only for PT DZ13KE  PT DS12KE      To input dual link signals  connect directly without going through a distributor or other such device to the extern
167. correct  91    3D eyewear is not  functioning                    Attention       f problems persist even after checking the preceding points  consult your dealer     ENGLISH   167    Chapter6 Appendix       This chapter describes specifications and after sales service for the projector     168   ENGLISH    Chapter 6 Appendix     Technical information       Technical information       The network function of this projector supports the PJLink class 1  and the PJLink protocol can be used to perform projector setting and  projector status query operations from a computer     Control commands    The following table lists the PJLink protocol commands that can be used to control the projector     x characters in tables are non specific characters                                                                             Command Control details Parameter   return string Remark  0 Standby  POWR Power supply control  1 Power on  0 Standby  1 Power on  POWR  Power supply status uu l  query 2 Preparing for switching off the projector  3 Warm up  11 RGB1  INPT Input selection 12 RGB2  21 VIDEO  31 DVI D    32 HDMI  INPT  Input selection query  33 SDI1  only for PT DZ13KE  PT DS12KE   SDI  only for PT DZ10KE   34 SDI2  only for PT DZ13KE  PT DS12KE   AVMT Shutter control 30 Shutter function off  shutter open   AVMT  Shutter status query 31 Shutter function on  shutter closed   1st byte Indicates fan errors  and returns e 0   No error is  y 0 2  detected  Indicates lamp errors  and return
168. ctor body                            1  Attach the air filter unit to the projector     The air filter unit has no difference between top and bottom  but is two sided  Match the protrusion position of the air filter unit with the  grooves on the projector body     Hook the air filter unit frame at the exhaust port side to the two tabs of the back side of the projector s air filter unit compartment and  perform Step 2  in  Removing the air filter unit  in the reverse order to attach     Confirm that the tabs of the air filter unit compartment of the projector body are hooked to the air filter unit frame   2  Attach the air filter cover to the projector and use a Phillips screwdriver to tighten the air filter cover  screw   e Perform Step 2  in    Removing the air filter unit       page 160  in the reverse order   Attention    After washing the air filter unit  dry it thoroughly before attaching it back to the projector  Attaching a wet unit will cause an electric shock or  malfunction     Do not disassemble the air filter unit   Note      Make sure that the air filter unit is properly attached before using the projector  If it is not properly attached  the projector will suck in dirt and  dust causing a malfunction    e  f you use the projector without attaching the air filter unit  the filter indicator   FILTER  flashes in red and the message appears on the  projection screen for approximately 30 seconds      Replace the air filter unit with the new optional Replacement Filte
169. d     Press A V 4  to select the text  and press the   ENTER  button to enter the text     After the name is input  press A V  lt  gt  to select  OK   and press the   ENTER  button     The registration completes and returns to the  LENS MEMORY SAVE  screen   e  f you press A W      to select  CANCEL  and then press the   ENTER  button  the lens memory will not be saved     e  f you press A W        to select  DEFAULT  and press the   ENTER  button  the entered name will not be registered and the default  name will be used        f you select  OK  without entering any characters and press the   ENTER  button  the default name will be used     Loading the lens position    1   2   3   4     5   6     Press A V to select  LENS MEMORY    Press the   ENTER  button   Press AY to select  LENS MEMORY LOAD      Press the   ENTER  button     The  LENS MEMORY LOAD  screen is displayed     Press AY to select the item to load  and press the   ENTER  button     When the confirmation screen is displayed  press 4P to select  OK   and press the   ENTER  button     The lens moves automatically to the registered shift  zoom  and focus positions     Note    Lens memory is not guaranteed to be 100   reproduced    The zoom and focus positions may have shifted after lens memory was loaded  Readjust as necessary    Beware of shift  as errors in zoom position are particularly significant    When a lens is replaced  readjust and save the lens memory again    If a lens without zoom function is used  the
170. d   PT DS12KE     m   16 9  Adjusts the vertical position between  132 and 131                    4  Press A V to select  SCREEN POSITION        If  SCREEN FORMAT  is set to  16 10  in PT DZ13KE and PT DZ10KE  or  SCREEN FORMAT  is set to  4 3  in PT DS12KE  then  selection and adjustment of  SSCREEN POSITION  are not available     5  Press 4b to adjust  SCREEN POSITION       AUTOSIGNAL  K    Set whether to execute automatic setup of signals automatically     The screen display position or signal level can be adjusted automatically without pressing the  lt AUTO SETUP  button on the remote control  on each occasion if you input unregistered signals frequently at meetings  etc     1  Press AW to select  AUTO SIGNAL    2  Press 4b to switch the item       The items will switch each time you press the button                     OFF  Sets the auto signal function to off    ON  Executes automatic setup automatically when images are changed to unregistered signals during  projection        TAUTO SETUP         2 2 2 22020 0    Set this when adjusting a special signal or horizontally long  such as 16 9  signal     Setting with  MODE     1  Press AY to select  AUTO SETUP      2  Press the   ENTER  button     The  AUTO SETUP  screen is displayed     3  Press A V to select  MODE    4  Press 4b to switch the item       The items will switch each time you press the button                        DEFAULT  Standard setting    WIDE  Select when an image aspect is a wide screen signal  which do
171. d  Data length 32 bytes 1 byte 1 byte Undefined length 1 byte                         ENGLISH   171             Chapter 6 Appendix     Technical information       E Received data                                                    Header Data section Termination  symbol  Command    0    0 Control command  CR   example 0x30 0x30  ASCII string  Ox0d  Data length 1 byte 1 byte Undefined length 1 byte  B Error response  String Details Termination  symbol     ERR1    Undefined control command     ERR2    Out of parameter range     ERR3    Busy state or no acceptable period  CR   Message       ERR4  Timeout or no acceptable period Ox0d   ERR5  Wrong data length     ERRA    Password mismatch  Data length 4 bytes     1 byte                   When web control administrator rights password is not set  Non protect mode     Connecting    1  Obtain the IP address and port number  Initial set value   1024  of the projector and request for a          connection to the projector     You can obtain both the IP address and the port number from the menu screen of the projector        IP address    Obtain from the main menu  gt   NETWORK   gt   NETWORK STATUS           Port number       Obtain from the main menu  gt   NETWORK   gt   NETWORK CONTROL     COMMAND PORT           2  Check the response from the projector                                                              Data section Blank Mode genminaon  symbol  Command  NTCONTROL  BS    0     CR   example  ASCII string  0x20 0x30 OxOd  Data
172. del no  of the lamp unit         LAMP1 SERIAL NUMBER     Displays the serial number of the lamp 1                 120     LAMP2 SERIAL NUMBER    Displays the serial number of the lamp 2    MAIN VERSION  Displays the main version of the firmware of the projector                    Chapter4 Settings      PROJECTOR SETUP  menu           SUB VERSION     Displays the sub version of the firmware of the projector         NETWORK VERSION     Displays the firmware version of the projector                                    UPGRADE ET UK20   Displays the activation status based on the Upgrade Kit    POWER ON TIMES  Displays the number of times the power is turned on    ON COUNT   LAMP1 ON         Displays the number of times the lamp is turned on    LAMP2 ON    LAMP1  Displays runtime in detail    LAMP2  Displays runtime in detail   ingre Aine Ce Displays the number of registered signals    REMOTE2 STATUS  Displays the control status of the REMOTE2    AC VOLTAGE  Displays the status of the AC voltage         COOLING CONDITION     Displays the set cooling conditions  When  AUTO  is set  automatically recognized result is displayed                                                MEMORY NO   Displays the memory number of the input signal    INPUT  Displays the input terminal currently selected    SIGNAL NAME  Displays the input signal name    SIGNAL FREQUENCY  Displays the frequency of the input signal    SYNC STATE  Displays the synch polarity of the input signal    V SYNC WIDTH  Displays
173. during SD SDI or HD SDI input     Set the on screen display    Setting  OSD POSITION    Set the position of the menu screen  OSD     1  Press A V to select  ON SCREEN DISPLAY      2  Press the   ENTER  button     The  ON SCREEN DISPLAY  screen is displayed     3  Press A V to select  OSD POSITION    4  Press 4b to switch the item       The items will switch each time you press the button                                       2  Sets to the center left of the screen     3  Sets to the bottom left of the screen    4  Sets to the top center of the screen     5  Sets to the center of the screen     6  Sets to the bottom center of the screen    7  Sets to the upper right of the screen    8  Sets to the center right of the screen    9  Sets to the bottom right of the screen    1  Sets to the upper left of the screen        Setting  OSD DESIGN   Set the color of the menu screen  OSD    1  Press A V to select  ON SCREEN DISPLAY      2  Press the   ENTER  button     The  ON SCREEN DISPLAY  screen is displayed     3  Press A V to select  OSD DESIGN    4  Press 4b to switch the item       The items will switch each time you press the button                              1  Sets to yellow    2  Sets to blue     3  Sets to white    4  Sets to green    5  Sets to peach    6  Sets to brown        Setting  OSD MEMORY   Set hold for the position of the menu screen  OSD  cursor   1  Press A V to select  ON SCREEN DISPLAY      2  Press the   ENTER  button     The  ON SCREEN DISPLAY  screen is di
174. e Smoke cut filter  the operating environment temperature should be between 0   C  32   F  and 35   C  95   F   However  it cannot be  used at high altitudes   If you use the Replacement lamp unit  for portrait mode   the operating environment temperature should be between 0   C  32   F  and 40   C   104   F  when using the projector at elevations lower than 1 400 m  4 593   above sea level  and between 0   C  32   F  and 35   C  95   F  when  using the projector at high altitudes  If you use the Smoke cut filter together  the operating environment temperature should be between 0   C  32   F   and 30   C  86   F      Note    e  f the temperature indicator  lt TEMP gt  is still lit or flashing after taking the preceding measures  ask your dealer for repair    e  f the  PROJECTOR SETUP  menu      LAMP POWER  is set to  HIGH    MIDDLE   or  NORMAL   and an ambient temperature reaches  40   C  104   F  or higher  35   C  95   F  or higher when  HIGH ALTITUDE MODE  is set to  ON  or the Smoke cut filter is used   the light  output may decrease by approx  20   to protect the projector     Filter indicator  lt FILTER gt              Indicator status Lighting in red Flashing in red  Status The filter is clogged  The air filter unit is not  The temperature inside or outside the projector is abnormally high  attached   e ion    s the air intake exhaust    s  HIGH ALTITUDE   Is the air filter unit     Cause ee airallor unit dins port blocked  MODE  set correctly  attached          When 
175. e Uygundur   EEE Complies with Directive of Turkey              2   ENGLISH    Read this first        IMPORTANT  THE MOULDED PLUG  U K  only        FOR YOUR SAFETY  PLEASE READ THE FOLLOWING TEXT CAREFULLY     This appliance is supplied with a moulded three pin mains plug for your safety and convenience  A 13 amp fuse  is fitted in this plug  Should the fuse need to be replaced  please ensure that the replacement fuse has a rating  of 13 amps and that it is approved by ASTA or BSI to BS1362     Check for the ASTA mark D or the BSI mark g on the body of the fuse     If the plug contains a removable fuse cover  you must ensure that it is refitted when the fuse is replaced  If you  lose the fuse cover  the plug must not be used until a replacement cover is obtained  A replacement fuse cover  can be purchased from an Authorised Service Center     If the fitted moulded plug is unsuitable for the mains socket in your home  then the fuse should be  removed and the plug cut off and disposed of safely  There is a danger of severe electrical shock if the  cut off plug is inserted into any 13 amp socket     If a new plug is to be fitted  please observe the wiring code as shown below   If in any doubt  please consult a qualified electrician     WARNING  THIS APPLIANCE MUST BE EARTHED     IMPORTANT  The wires in this mains lead are coloured in accordance with the following code   Green   and   Yellow  Earth  Blue  Neutral  Brown  Live    As the colours of the wire in the mains lead of thi
176. e button         DISABLE  Disables the automatic input switching function         ENABLE  Switches to the secondary input automatically when the input signal for primary input is disrupted                 ENGLISH   99    Chapter 4 Settings      DISPLAY OPTION  menu       Note    Backup function is enabled when  BACKUP INPUT MODE  is set to  ON  or  1   and the same signal is input to the  lt DVI D IN gt  and  lt HDMI  IN gt  terminals    Backup function is also enabled when  BACKUP INPUT MODE  is set to  2   and the same signal is input to the  lt SDI IN 1 gt  and  lt SDI IN 2 gt   terminals    To switch to the backup input signal using the backup function  make sure that the following three conditions are satisfied to be ready to use  the function      Set  BACKUP INPUT MODE  to  ON    1   or  2       Input the same signal to the primary and secondary inputs      Display the image of the primary input    If the input is switched to other than the primary or secondary input while the backup function is ready for use  the state of readiness to use  the backup function is canceled  To switch to the backup input signal using the backup function again  switch to the primary input    When  BACKUP INPUT MODE  is set to  ON    1   or  2    BACKUP INPUT STATUS  is displayed both in the input guide      page 103  and  on the  STATUS  screen   pages 62  120     When switching to the backup input signal is possible using the backup function   ACTIVE  is displayed in  BACKUP INPUT STATUS
177. e indicator status    e  f the operating environment temperature is low and warm up takes more than five minutes  the projector will judge that a problem has  occurred and the power will automatically be set to standby mode  If this happens  increase the operating environment temperature to 0   C   32  F  or higher  turn off the main power  and then switch on the projector again    e  f the  PROJECTOR SETUP  menu      STANDBY MODE  is set to  ECO   it may take approx  10 seconds longer before the projector starts  projecting after the power is turned on  compared with when  NORMAL  is set    e  f the   MAIN POWER  switch was set to   OFF   during projection to end the projection using the direct power off function last time  and the    MAIN POWER  switch is set to   ON   with the power plug connected to the outlet  the power indicator   ON  G  STANDBY  R  gt  will light in  green and the image will soon be projected on the screen     ENGLISH   53    Chapter 3 Basic Operations     Switching on off the projector          It is recommended that images are projected continuously for at least 30 minutes before the focus is adjusted            POWER ON STANDBY  A D                                                 2 qut  j     voo       i  i        Rest                                                                                                                                          1  Press the   FOCUS    button to roughly adjust the focus of the image    gt  page 56     2  Cha
178. e is a problem with the sensor used to detect intake temperature  Consult your  dealer         OPTICS MODULE TEMP SENSOR     There is a problem with the sensor used to detect temperature inside the projector   Consult your dealer         AROUND LAMP TEMP  SENSOR     There is a problem with the sensor used to detect exhaust air temperature  Consult your  dealer         BATTERY     Battery replacement is required  Consult your dealer         LENS MOUNTER     There is a problem in the lens mounter  Consult your dealer         COVER OPEN     Installation of the lamp unit cover is incomplete  Check the installation of the lamp unit  cover    page 164         BRIGHTNESS SENSOR     There is a problem with the luminance sensor  If problems persist even after switching  on the power  consult your dealer         ANGLE SENSOR     There is a problem with the sensor that detects angle  Consult your dealer        The air filter unit is not attached  Check the connection of the air filter unit            FILTER UNIT   9 page 160     AIR FILTER  There is too much dust accumulated in the air filter unit  Turn the   MAIN POWER   switch   OFF     page 55   and clean the air filter    amp  page 160     AC POWER  AC input voltage is weak  Use electric wiring that can sufficiently withstand the power             consumption of the projector        ENGLISH   143    Chapter 4 Settings      NETWORK  menu        Network status  page    Click  Status       Network status    The current network setting 
179. ect  Enable  to use the E mail function    2  SMTP SERVER NAME   Enter the IP address or the server name of the E mail server   SMTP   To enter the server name  the DNS server needs to be  set up    3  MAIL FROM   Enter the E mail address of the projector   Up to 63 characters  in single byte    4  MEMO   Enter information such as the location of the projector that  notifies the sender of the E mail   Up to 63 characters in single  byte     148   ENGLISH     MINIMUM TIME    Change the minimum interval for the temperature warning  E mail  The default value is 60 minutes  In this case  another  E mail will not be sent for 60 minutes after sending the  temperature warning E mail even if it reaches the warning  temperature     INTAKE AIR TEMPERATURE    Change the temperature setting for the temperature warning  mail  A temperature warning E mail is sent when the  temperature exceeds this value     Chapter 4 Settings      NETWORK  menu       A LIBR pm rene co one ATLETI B BORG o mumcu m mum      SB tet    1A Bap oe a pepe ET BENQ  EER Ot                                              9    7  E MAIL ADDRESS 1    E MAIL ADDRESS 2  8 Settings of the conditions to send E mail  Enter the E mail address to be sent  Leave  E MAIL ADDRESS Select the conditions to send E mail   2  blank when two E mail addresses are not to be used   MAIL CONTENTS    Select either  NORMAL  or  SIMPLE     ERROR      Send an E mail when an error occurred in the self diagnosis    LAMP1 RUNTIME    An E mail messa
180. ected screen when there is no signal input                 1  Press A V to select  BACK COLOR    2  Press 4b to switch the item       The items will switch each time you press the button                           BLUE  Displays the entire projection area in blue    BLACK  Displays the entire projection area in black    DEFAULT LOGO  Displays the Panasonic logo    USER LOGO  Displays the image registered by the user        Note    To create register the  USER LOGO  image  use    Logo Transfer Software  included in the supplied CD ROM     104   ENGLISH    Chapter 4 Settings      DISPLAY OPTION  menu        STARTUP LOGO              1    Set the logo display when the power is turned on     1  Press A V to select  STARTUP LOGO      2  Press 4b to switch the item       The items will switch each time you press the button                     DEFAULT LOGO  Displays the Panasonic logo    USER LOGO  Displays the image registered by the user    NONE  Disables the startup logo display           Note      The startup logo will disappear in approximately 15 seconds       To create register the  USER LOGO  image  use    Logo Transfer Software  included in the supplied CD ROM      UNIFORMITY      000000 00000000    Correct the brightness and color unevenness of the entire screen     Setting each color    1  Press A V to select  UNIFORMITY      2  Press the   ENTER  button     The  UNIFORMITY  screen is displayed     3  Press A V to select  WHITE    RED    GREEN   or  BLUE      4  Press 4b t
181. ecuted     Data registered from a computer is not included in  ALL USER DATA      TINITIALIZE  LLLLLLLLLLLLLLLLLLLLLLLLLLL    Return various setting values to their factory default settings     1   2     3     4     Press A V to select  INITIALIZE      Press the   ENTER  button     The  SECURITY PASSWORD  screen is displayed     Enter a security password and press the   ENTER  button     The  INITIALIZE  screen is displayed     Press A VW to select an item to initialize        Returns all setting items including  REGISTERED SIGNAL    NETWORK SETUP    E mail set up     ALL USER DATA  and  USER LOGO  to factory default settings   The projector will go into the standby status to reflect the setting values        Deletes all the setting values saved for each input signal    REGISTERED SIGNAL  To delete only a part of a registered signal  perform the procedure described in  Deleting the  registered signal    page 130     NETWORK E MAIL  Returns  NETWORK SETUP  and  E mail set up  to factory default settings    LOGO IMAGE  Deletes the image registered in  USER LOGO                        ENGLISH   125    Chapter 4 Settings      PROJECTOR SETUP  menu       5  Press the   ENTER  button   6  When the confirmation screen is displayed  press 4P to select  OK   and press the   ENTER  button      SERVICE PASSWORD  11 11 11    This function is used by a service person     126   ENGLISH    Chapter 4 Settings      P IN P  menu        P IN P  menu          On the menu screen  select  P IN P  
182. el     2  Press the  lt SHUTTER gt  button again     The image is displayed   Note      The power indicator   ON  G  STANDBY  R  gt  will flash slowly in green while the shutter is closed      You can set the speed of shutter opening closing via the  DISPLAY OPTION  menu      SHUTTER SETTING         Turn off the on screen display function  no display  when you do not wish the viewers to see the on screen display  such as the menu or the  input terminal name     Ba button    1  Press the   ON SCREEN  button     The on screen display disappears     2  Press the   ON SCREEN  button again       The on screen display appears     Note       f you press the   MENU  button on the control panel for at least three seconds while the on screen display is off  hidden   the on screen  display is turned on     ENGLISH   61    Chapter 3 Basic Operations     Operating with the remote control        Pm m    The input for projection can be switched     INPUT SELECT  SIT button    1  Press the input selection   lt RGB1 gt    lt RGB2 gt    lt DVI D gt     VIDEO     lt HDMI gt     SDI 1 2    buttons       This operation can be also performed using the buttons on the control panel                     lt RGB1 gt  Switches the input to RGB1    lt RGB2 gt  Switches the input to RGB2    lt DVI D gt  Switches the input to DVI D    lt VIDEO gt  Switch the input to VIDEO    lt HDMI gt  Switch the input to HDMI         PT DZ13KE  PT DS12KE    Switches the input to SDI1 or SDI2  Switches to another input wh
183. en one input has already been  chosen  You can also fix the input selection to either SDI1 or SDI2 from the  SECURITY  menu  gt    CONTROL DEVICE SETUP      PT DZ10KE    Switches the input to SDI       SDI 1 2 gt  1                 1 Only for PT DZ13KE  PT DS12KE  PT DZ10KE    Tet eee    You can display the status of the projector     button    1  Press the  lt STATUS gt  button     The  STATUS  screen is displayed     27  C  80  F  33  C  92  F    33  C  92  F    SEND STATUS VIA E MAIL  4 gt  CHANGE cD EXIT       Note a  e This can be displayed from the  PROJECTOR SETUP  menu      STATUS   9 page 120      TN   e    The automatic setup function can be used to automatically adjust the resolution  clock phase  and image position when analog RGB signals  consisting of bitmap images such as computer signals are being input  or to automatically adjust the image position when DVI D HDMI signals  are input  Supplying images with bright white borders at the edges and high contrast black and white characters is recommended when the  system is in automatic adjustment mode     Avoid supplying images that include halftones or gradation  such as photographs and computer graphics   xr  button    1  Press the   AUTO SETUP  button      COMPLETE  is displayed when it has completed without any problem     62   ENGLISH    Chapter 3 Basic Operations     Operating with the remote control         This operation can be also performed using the   AUTO SETUP  button on the control panel     Note     
184. en width H  H A 0 0 15H           si    EID                  0 44 V    Projection screen height V       PT DZ13KE  PT DZ10KE             Projection screen height V                     screen ss a l   screen a t          i    Projection screen height V          e ZA   WY           Projection screen height V                         ENGLISH   57    Chapter 3 Basic Operations     Projecting          ET D75LE1  ET D75LE2  ET D75LE3  ET D75LE4   Projection lens Model No  ET D75LE8  ET D75LE10  ET D75LE20  ET D75LE6  ET D75LE30  ET D75LE40                                         PU d Screen dp um oe width H  e Z 7 7 Zz 7 7    gt   PT DW11KE LY p g r 7                   Standard projection position Standard projection position                   Note    e When the optional fixed focus lens  Model No   ET D75LE5  ET D75LE50  is attached  the shift cannot be adjusted        Focus balance    Relationship between the tilt of the lens and the screen focus surface  When the projection lens is tilted in contrast with the image forming surface  tilting the front side  screen side  of the projection lens downwards   in the direction of the dotted arrow line   the upper side of the screen focus surface will tilt inwards and the lower side will tilt outwards as  shown in the example     Projection lens       Image forming surface    Screen focus surface    How to adjust the focus balance  adjustment by tilting the lens mounter     When the entire screen surface is not uniform even if the focus h
185. en younger than 5 or 6 years old should not use 3D Eyewear   As it is difficult to gauge the reactions of children to fatigue and discomfort their condition may worsen suddenly   If a child uses the 3D Eyewear  guardians should beware of the child s eyes becoming tired              8   ENGLISH    Read this first              EU    To remove the battery    Remote Control Battery  1  Press the guide and lift the cover  2  Remove the batteries           ENGLISH   9          E Trademarks   e Windows    Windows Vista    and Internet Explorer   are registered trademarks or trademarks of Microsoft Corporation in the  United States and other countries      Mac  Mac OS  OS X  and Safari are trademarks of Apple Inc   registered in the United States and other countries      PJLink    is a registered trademark or pending trademark in Japan  the United States  and other countries and regions       HDMI  the HDMI Logo  and High Definition Multimedia Interface are trademarks or registered trademarks of HDMI Licensing  LLC in the United States and other countries       VGA and XGA are trademarks of International Business Machines Corporation in the United States    e SVGA is a trademark or registered trademark of Video Electronics Standards Association      RoomView and Crestron RoomView are registered trademarks of Crestron Electronics  Inc   Crestron Connected and Fusion RV are trademarks of Crestron Electronics  Inc      Art Net    Designed by and Copyright Artistic Licence Holdings Ltd  
186. ens shift limit values and home position for the projector   1  Press A V to select  LENS CALIBRATION    2  Press the   ENTER  button       The confirmation screen is displayed     3  Press 4b to select  OK   and press the   ENTER  button       To cancel  select  CANCEL      The lens moves up  down  left  and right to automatically set the lens shift limit values and home position     The lens stops to complete the calibration     Note    e  PROGRESS  is displayed on the menu during lens calibration  Cannot cancel mid operation      When lens calibration executes correctly   COMPLETE  is displayed and  INCOMPLETE  is displayed when it does not execute correctly      Pressing the   FOCUS  button on the remote control for at least three seconds will also display the confirmation screen for lens calibration  execution      LENS MEMORY                        2 2 2       Save and load the focus position  shift position  and zoom position of an adjusted lens     Saving lens position    1  Press A V to select  LENS MEMORY    2  Press the   ENTER  button   3  Press A V to select  LENS MEMORY SAVE      4  Press the   ENTER  button     The  LENS MEMORY SAVE  screen is displayed     5  Press A V to select the item to save  and press the   ENTER  button     ENGLISH   123    Chapter 4 Settings      PROJECTOR SETUP  menu       6     7   8     When the confirmation screen is displayed  press 4P to select  OK   and press the   ENTER  button     The  LENS MEMORY NAME INPUT  screen is displaye
187. er 4 Settings      ADVANCED MENU  menu                                  Blanking correction Item Operation Adjustment Range of adjustment  Press the   4 The blanking zone 7  button  moves upward  Y  Top of the screen  UPPER     Press the  gt  The blanking zone PT DZ13KE  PT DZ10KE   button  moves downward  Top to bottom 0   599  PT DS12KE  Top to bottom  Press the  gt  The blanking zone 0 524  button  moves upward  PT DW11KE  Top to bottom  0   383  Bottom of the  LOWER  l  screen Press the 4 The blanking zone  button  moves downward   Press the  gt  The blanking zone  button  moves to the right   Left pana the  LEFT  l  Press the 4 The d e PT DZ13KE  PT DZ10KE   button  moves to the left  Left to right 0   959  PT DS12KE  Left to right  Press the 4 The blanking zone 0   699  button  moves to the right  PT DW11KE  Left to right  Rightside ofthe   RIGHT  aes  screen Press the  gt  The blanking zone  button  moves to the left                             You can adjust to achieve an optimal image when there is a flickering image or smeared outlines   1  Press A V to select  INPUT RESOLUTION      2  Press the   ENTER  button     The  INPUT RESOLUTION  screen is displayed     3  Press A V to select  TOTAL DOTS    DISPLAY DOTS    TOTAL LINES   or  DISPLAY LINES   and press   lt  gt  to adjust it       Values corresponding to the signal being input are displayed automatically for each item  Increase or decrease the displayed values  and adjust to the optimal point viewing the screen
188. er connector with wet hands   Failure to observe this will result in electric shocks     Do not overload the wall outlet   If the power supply is overloaded  ex   by using too many adapters   overheating may occur and fire will result     B ON USE INSTALLATION    Do not place the projector on soft materials such as carpets or sponge mats   Doing so will cause the projector to overheat  which can cause burns  fire or damage to the projector     Do not set up the projector in humid or dusty places or in places where the projector may come into  contact with oily smoke or steam  ex  a bathroom    Using the projector under such conditions will result in fire  electric shocks or deterioration of components   Deterioration of components  such as ceiling mount brackets  may cause the projector which is mounted on the  ceiling to fall down     Do not install this projector in a place which is not strong enough to take the full weight of the projector  or on top of a surface which is sloped or unstable    Failure to observe this will cause projector to fall down or tip over the projector  and severe injury or damage  could result              4   ENGLISH    Read this first              WARNING     Do not cover the air intake exhaust ports or place anything within 500 mm  20   of them   Doing so will cause the projector to overheat  which can cause fire or damage to the projector   e Do not place the projector in narrow  badly ventilated places   e Do not place the projector on cloth o
189. er the changed password  and press the   ENTER  button     Note      The entered password is displayed with marks on the screen     An error message is displayed on the screen when the entered password is incorrect  Re enter the correct password        Display the  SECURITY PASSWORD  screen when the power is turned on with the   MAIN POWER  switch set to the   OFF   side  When  the entered password is incorrect  the operation will be restricted to the power standby   d   button  the  lt SHUTTER gt  button  and the   LENS      lt FOCUS gt    lt ZOOM gt    lt SHIFT gt   buttons     1  Press A V to select  SECURITY PASSWORD      2  Press 4b to switch the item     The items will switch each time you press the button         OFF  Disables the security password entry    ON  Enables the security password entry                    Note    e The  SECURITY PASSWORD  setting is set to  OFF  by the factory default or when  ALL USER DATA  in  INITIALIZE    page 125  is  executed      Change the password periodically that is hard to guess    e The security password is enabled after setting  SECURITY PASSWORD  to  ON  and turning the   MAIN POWER  switch to   OFF       Change the security password   1  Press A V to select  SECURITY PASSWORD CHANGE      2  Press the   ENTER  button     The  SECURITY PASSWORD CHANGE  screen is displayed     3  Press A WV 49 and the number    0      lt 9 gt   buttons to set the password     Up to eight button operations can be set     4  Press the   ENTER  butt
190. er the current password  Enter the desired new password again   2  New Password  4  OK   Enter the desired new password   Up to 16 characters in single Determines the change of password   byte   Note      To change the account of the administrator  you must enter the  User name  and  Password  in  Current     CRESTRON RoomView  page    The projector can be monitored controlled with RoomView     To start the RoomView control page from the web control screen  you need to access with the administrator rights   For user rights  the   CRESTRON RoomView  button is not displayed on the web control screen      The control page of RoomView is displayed by clicking  CRESTRON RoomView      It is not displayed if Adobe Flash Player is not installed on the computer used  or the browser used does not support Flash  In that case  click   Back  on the control page to go back to the previous page     154   ENGLISH    Chapter 4 Settings      NETWORK  menu       Control page    d hai BSE ISEB Bey DR      Ar BOX  3 cese men Cm                                                                1  Tools  Info  Help   Tabs for selecting the setting  information  or help page of the  projector     2  POWER   Turns on off the power     3  SHUTTER   Switches the setting whether to use the shutter function   closing opening of the shutter       Tools  page    Click  Tools  on the control page       gt       LE omia p m                            e    7    4  Input Select   Controls input selection   Not av
191. es not meet the  DEFAULT  settings    USER  Select when receiving a signal with a special horizontal resolution  number of display dots           When  DEFAULT  or  WIDE  is selected  proceed to Step 7      When  USER  is selected  proceed to Step 5      5  Press A V to select  DISPLAY DOTS   and press 4P to adjust  DISPLAY DOTS  to the horizontal  resolution of the signal source     6  Press A V to select  MODE    7  Press the   ENTER  button     Automatic adjustment is executed   PROGRESS  is displayed while automatically adjusting  When complete  the system returns to the     AUTO SETUP  screen     Adjusting position automatically    1  Press AY to select  AUTO SETUP      98   ENGLISH    Chapter 4 Settings      DISPLAY OPTION  menu       2  Press the   ENTER  button     The  AUTO SETUP  screen is displayed     3  Press AY to select  POSITION ADJUST    4  Press 4b to switch the item         OFF  Does not perform automatic adjustment    ON  Adjust the screen position and size when automatic setup is executed                 Adjusting signal level automatically    1  Press AY to select  AUTO SETUP      2  Press the   ENTER  button     The  AUTO SETUP  screen is displayed     3  Press AY to select  SIGNAL LEVEL ADJUST    4  Press 4b to switch the item         OFF  Does not perform automatic adjustment     Adjusts black level  on screen menu  BRIGHTNESS   and white level  on screen menu   CONTRAST   when automatic setup is executed         ON                 Note       SIGNAL L
192. es of target data and measurement values obtained from an instrument may occur for certain instruments  and measurement environments used     AUTO TESTPATTERN  settings change together with the  AUTO TESTPATTERN  of  EDGE BLENDING       LARGE SCREEN CORRECTION     Corrects the phenomenon in which colors that appear lighter when viewed on a large screen viewed from a close distance compared to when  viewed on an average screen size so that colors appear the same     1  Press A V to select  LARGE SCREEN CORRECTION    2  Press 4b to switch the item                        OFF  Performs no correction    1  Performs weak correction    2  Performs strong correction         SCREEN SETTING   gt  1 11     Only for PT DZ13KE  PT DS12KE  PT DZ10KE   Set the screen size     When changing the aspect of a projected image  correct to the optimum image position for the set screen  Set as necessary for the screen in  use     1  Press A V to select  SCREEN SETTING      2  Press the   ENTER  button     The  SCREEN SETTING  screen is displayed     ENGLISH   97    Chapter 4 Settings      DISPLAY OPTION  menu       3  Press 4b to switch the  SCREEN FORMAT  item       The items will switch each time you press the button                       Model No   SCREEN FORMAT  Range when  SCREEN POSITION  is selected   16 10  Cannot be adjusted   PT DZ13KE  PT DZ10KE  4 3  Adjusts the horizontal position between    160 and 160    16 9  Adjusts the vertical position between  60 and 60    4 3  Cannot be adjuste
193. es to install the projector  Image size and image position can be adjusted in accordance with the    Screen size and screen position     Projection screen       So    SH             OC  L1                                           Sw       SW                                                      Unit  m   L  LW LT  1 Projection distance  Ei Lens protrusion dimension  SH Image height  SW Image width  SD Image diagonal size   1 LW  Minimum projection distance when the Zoom Lens is used  LT  Maximum projection distance when the Zoom Lens is used   Unit  m                                               Projection lens Model No  L1 dimension  approximate value   ET D75LE1 0 1144  ET D75LE2 0 0989  ET D75LE3 0 1024  ET D75LE4 0 1263  ET D75LE5 0 2024  ET D75LE6 0 2119  ET D75LE8 0 2544  ET D75LE10 0 125  ET D75LE20 0 121  ET D75LE30 0 121  ET D75LE40 0 124  ET D75LE50 0 203   Attention    e Before setting up  read    Precautions for use      page 16           Do not use the projector and the high powered laser equipment in the same room  The DLP chips can be damaged if a laser beam hits the    lens surface     32   ENGLISH       Chapter 2 Getting Started     Setting up        GEOMETRY  projection range     Only for PT DZ13KE  PT DS12KE  PT DZ10KE         VERTICAL KEYSTONE   viewed from the side      HORIZONTAL KEYSTONE   viewed from above                          Horizontal arc correction  viewed from above         L2   Projection distance  R2  Arc radius                      center 
194. et between 0 and  31            CLOCK PHASE                 7  If  SIZE  is selected in Step 6   press the   ENTER  button       The sub menu is displayed   8  Press A Vto select an item   9  Press q gt  to make adjustment  and press the   MENU  button   10  If  POSITION  is selected in Step 6   press the   ENTER  button   11  Press A V 4b to adjust the position  and press the   MENU  button     ENGLISH   127    Chapter 4 Settings      P IN P  menu       12  If  CLOCK PHASE  is selected in Step 6   press 4  to make adjustment   13  Press A V to select  FRAME LOCK      14  Press 4P to switch the item         MAIN WINDOW  Set frame lock to the input signal set in the main window               SUB WINDOW  Set frame lock to the input signal set in the sub window           15  Press AY to select  TYPE      16  Press 4P to switch the item         MAIN WINDOW  The main window has display priority               SUB WINDOW  The sub window has display priority           Note    The P IN P function may not be available for some signals being input or terminals being selected  Refer to    Two window display  combination list    page 178  for details    The main window setting values are applied to image adjustment values such as  PICTURE MODE    GAMMA   and  COLOR  TEMPERATURE     On the main screen  when no menu is displayed   press        to switch the sizes and positions of the main window and sub window while P  IN P is operating    When  FRAME RESPONSE  is set to other than  NORMAL 
195. etailed settings of ee   COMMAND   COMMAND  Description   VIDEO  Switches the input to VIDEO    RGB1  Switches the input to RGB1    RGB2  Switches the input to RGB2    DVI D  Switches the input to DVI D    INPUT   HDMI  Switches the input to HDMI    PT DZ13KE  PT DS12KE   Switches the input to SDI1    i  DIT  PT DZ10KE   Switches the input to SDI    SDI2   Switches the input to SDI2    DUAL  Turns on two lamps    LAMP SELECT   SINGLE  Turns on one lamp   The lamp with shorter runtime will  automatically light     HIGH   Sets the lamp brightness to high luminance    MIDDLE   Sets the lamp brightness to slightly lower luminance compared to   LAMP POWER   HIGH     NORMAL  5 Sets the lamp brightness to high luminance    ECO  Sets the lamp brightness to low luminance    OFF  P IN P function is not used    P IN P   USER1  Lays out the sub screen with the settings of  USER1     USER2  Lays out the sub screen with the settings of  USER2     USER3  Lays out the sub screen with the settings of  USER3          1 Only for PT DZ13KE  PT DS12KE  PT DZ10KE    2 Only for PT DZ13KE  PT DS12KE    3 Only for PT DZ13KE  PT DS12KE  PT DW11KE  Even when the command for  HIGH  is set  it is not reflected at the execution  if the optional  Replacement lamp unit  for portrait mode   Model No   ET LAD320P  1 pc   ET LAD320PW  2 pcs   is used     4 Only for PT DZ13KE  PT DS12KE  PT DW11KE    5 Only for PT DZ10KE    10  Press the   ENTER  button     The  COMMAND  detailed screen is displayed     11  Pre
196. from the main menu  and select an item from the sub   menu    Refer to    Navigating through the menu    page 65  for the operation of the menu screen   e After selecting the item  press A V 4P to set                 Locate a separate  small sub screen in the main screen to project two images simultaneously   1  Press A V to select  P IN P MODE      2  Press the  lt ENTER gt  button     The  P IN P MODE  screen is displayed     3  Press AY to select a function               OFF  P IN P function is not used    USER1    USER2  The items set in  Setting P IN P function    page 127  are used in P IN P function    USER3                 4  Press the   ENTER  button    Setting P IN P function   P IN P function settings can be saved to  USER1    USER2   and  USERS    1  Press A V to select  P IN P MODE      2  Press the   ENTER  button     The  P IN P MODE  screen is displayed     3  Press AY to select the desired mode from  USER1    USER2   and  USER3   and press the   ENTER   button     4  Press A V to select  MAIN WINDOW  or  SUB WINDOW   and press the   ENTER  button   5  Press A V to select the input terminal to be displayed in the window  and press the   ENTER  button     6  Press A Vto select an item         SIZE  Set the window display size between 10   and 100      POSITION  Set the display position of the window within the screen     When the sub window is input from the   RGB 1 IN   terminal or the   RGB 2 IN   terminal and a  flickering image or smeared outline appears  s
197. ge     1   2     3     Press AY to select  SHARPNESS      Press 4 gt  or the   ENTER  button     The  SHARPNESS  individual adjustment screen is displayed     Press q gt  to adjust the level                          Operation Adjustment Range of adjustment  Press the  gt  button  Contours become sharper  0 445  Press the 4 button  Contours become softer        ENGLISH   75    Chapter 4 Settings      PICTURE  menu       Note       f you press  gt  while the adjustment value is   15   the value will become  0   If you press     while the adjustment value is  0   the value will  become   15       NOISE REDUCTION  00    You can reduce noises when the input image is degraded and noise is occurring in the image signal   1  Press AY to select  NOISE REDUCTION      2  Press q gt  or the   ENTER    button     The  NOISE REDUCTION  individual adjustment screen is displayed     3  Press 4b to switch the item       The items will switch each time you press the button                           OFF  No correction    1  Slightly corrects the noise    2  Moderately corrects the noise    3  Strongly corrects the noise        Attention      When this is set for an input signal with less noise  the image may look different from what it originally was  In such a case  set it to  OFF       DYNAMIC IRIS     Aperture correction and signal compensation are performed automatically based on the image to result in an image of optimum contrast   1  Press A V to select  DYNAMIC IRIS      2  Press 4b or t
198. ge is sent when the remaining lamp on time for  the lamp 1 has reached the value set at the right field    LAMP2 RUNTIME    An E mail message is sent when the remaining lamp on time for  the lamp 2 has reached the value set at the right field    INTAKE AIR TEMPERATURE    Send an E mail when the air intake temperature has reached  the value set at the above field    PERIODIC REPORT    Place a check mark on this to send an E mail periodically   It will be sent on the days and time with the check mark   9  Submit   Update the settings     Note    e Set each item of  LAMP1 RUNTIME  to  EAMP2 RUNTIME  to 500 hours or less when using the optional Replacement lamp unit  for portrait  mode   Model No   ET LAD320P  1 pc   ET LAD320PW  2 pcs       ENGLISH   149    Chapter 4 Settings      NETWORK  menu        Authentication set up  page    Set the authentication items when POP authentication or SMTP authentication is necessary to send an E mail   Click  Detailed set up       Authentication set up      B rio  c    D   RO x   Barano control endow  x                                                                               4  8    Auth  5  Password   Select the authentication method specified by your Internet Enter the password for the POP server or the SMTP server   service provider  6  SMTP server port    SMTP Auth  Enter the port number of the SMTP server   Set when the SMTP authentication is selected   Normally 25    POP server name  7  POP server port   Enter the POP server name  
199. gnal Dots z   3   1  3  g per  kHz   Hz   MHz  21  3   4  5   27  3   4   63   10   10   10  750  720  60p 1 280 x 720 45 0 60 0 74 3 Vi vViv i    vi vi iviivi viv v  750  720  50p 1 280 x 720 37 5 50 0 74 3 ae A A ee A ee ee ee ee ee 4  1080 60i 1 920 x 1 080i 33 8 60 0 74 3 Vivi        vivi i    vi ivi1 wvi   v  1080 50i 1 920 x 1 080i 28 1 50 0 74 3 Vi v7i       ivci ivi   vi iviwv v  1080 24p 1 920 x 1 080 27 0 24 0 74 3 Vivi        vivi    vivi vi wv  1080 24sF 1 920 x 1 080i 27 0 48 0 74 3 Vivi        vivi i    vi iv1 wv7i  wv  1080 25p 1 920 x 1 080 28 1 25 0 74 3 Vi iv7i        ivi iv i    vi iviviwv  1080 30p 1 920 x 1 080 33 8 30 0 74 3 Vi v7i        ivi ivi    vi iviviwv  1080 60p 1 920 x 1 080 67 5 60 0 148 5 Vi i        vV3V3         v v      1080 50p 1 920 x 1 080 56 3 50 0 148 5 4i          ivcs 3         v7 7       VGA480 640 x 480 31 5 59 9 25 2 2 l    fe SS HS       SS    SVGA 800 x 600 37 9 60 3 40 0 Pe a mS Dp e       e   J    JeIe e  1 024 x 768 39 6 50 0 51 9 oso o  t o t c    om ee  1 024 x 768 48 4 60 0 65 0 l  p meee E mee   eee   ee l  XGA  1 024 x 768 81 4 100 0 113 3 ee ee ae e B    i e  1 024 x 768 98 8 120 0 139 1 9 ami ue  MXGA 1 152 x 864 53 7 60 0 81 6 So   f   fs Sf Sf SS     HS LS  1 280 x 720 37 1 49 8 60 5 Je mm mes RS  m  RIS  m  mns  1 280 x 720 44 8 59 9 74 5 JM EI ee Se   ee a I  1280 x 720  1 280 x 720 76 3 100 0 131 8     pepper rx Ml  1 280 x 720 92 6 120 0 161 6   emn Lot   em mE   m eR  m  mns  1 280 x 768 39 6 49 9 65 3 LS SS    
200. hange by moving the lens mount bracket of the lens mounter forward   screen side   and in the projected image on the screen  the focus point in the opposite direction of the adjustment screws will move  from the inner side of the screen to the outside     ENGLISH   59    Chapter 3 Basic Operations     Projecting       6  Press the  lt SHIFT gt  button on the remote control or the  lt LENS gt  button on the control panel to display  the  SHIFT  adjustment menu  and reset the screen position of the projected image on the screen  surface back to an optimal state     7  Perform focus adjustment again near the center of the screen and if it is still not enough  fine tune the  amount of rotation of the adjustment screws     8  When adjustments have been made  securely tighten the loosened fixing screws     9  Adjust the focus again using the remote control     60   ENGLISH    Chapter 3 Basic Operations     Operating with the remote control       Operating with the remote control    c      POWER      SL ISO 5    ON STANDBY    RGB 1I RGB 2E DVI D   INPUT SELECT    HOMI     Z 4    E    oa    Csr   i    aJ   7d   sus    uor    9000030 A    Panasonic  PROJECTOR       If the projector is not used for a certain period of time during the meeting intermission  for example  it is possible to turn off the image  temporarily        button    1  Press the  lt SHUTTER  gt  button     The image disappears   e This operation can be also performed using the  lt SHUTTER gt  button on the control pan
201. hat it can be used as an easy  shortcut button     FUNC button    1  Press the  lt FUNC gt  button     Note    e  LEFT RIGHT SWAP  can only be assigned in PT DZ13KE  PT DS12KE  PT DW11KE   e Assignment of the function is performed from the  PROJECTOR SETUP  menu      FUNCTION BUTTON    page 122         The projector has eight types of internal test patterns to check the condition of the set  To display test patterns  perform the following steps     TESTPATTERN button    1  Press the   TEST  button   2  Press 4b to select the test pattern     Note    e Setting is also available from the  TEST PATTERN    gt  page 129  menu   e Settings of position  size  and other factors will not be reflected in test patterns  Make sure to display the input signal before performing  various adjustments        You can toggle through aspect ratios to select the one that is appropriate for the input signal     c button    1  Press the   ASPECT  button     The setting will change each time you press the button   e Refer to  ASPECT    page 79  for details     ENGLISH   63    Chapter4 Settings       This chapter describes the settings and adjustments you can make using the on screen menu     64   ENGLISH    Chapter 4 Settings     Menu navigation       Menu navigation    The on screen menu  Menu  is used to perform various settings and adjustments of the projector           Operating procedure       button    1  Press the  lt MENU gt  button on the remote control or control panel     The  MAIN MENU  
202. he   ENTER    button     The  DYNAMIC IRIS  individual adjustment screen is displayed     3  Press 4b to switch the item       The items will switch each time you press the button                           OFF  No correction    1  Slightly corrects aperture and compensate signals    2  Moderately corrects aperture and signal    3  Strongly corrects aperture and signal    USER  Set any desired correction     Refer to    Adjusting desired correction amount    page 76  for details        Adjusting desired correction amount    1  Press A V to select  DYNAMIC IRIS      2  Press 4b or the   ENTER  button     The  DYNAMIC IRIS  individual adjustment screen is displayed     3  Press 4b to select  USER      4  Press the  lt ENTER gt  button     The  DYNAMIC IRIS  screen is displayed     5  Press A V to select  AUTO IRIS    MANUAL IRIS   or  DYNAMIC GAMMA      6  Press 4b to adjust the correction amount                       Item Adjustment   AUTO IRIS   OFF  No correction    Automatic adjustment of  1     255  Allows you to set in increments of 1  The larger the value  the  aperture  stronger the correction    OFF  No correction    MANUAL IRIS        Fixed adjustment of aperture   1     255  Allows you to set in increments of 1  The larger the value  the  stronger the correction           76   ENGLISH       Chapter 4 Settings      PICTURE  menu          Item        DYNAMIC GAMMA    Adjustment of signal  compensation                    Adjustment   OFF  No correction    1  Slightly com
203. he edges of the images may not  be visible or they may become distorted  Such images should be viewed as with an aspect ratio of 4 3 in the original format intended by the  creator of the images      ZOOM            mhxsbsv    You can adjust the image size     When  ASPECT  is set to other than  DEFAULT  and  THROUGH     1  Press A V to select  ZOOM      2  Press the   ENTER  button     The  ZOOM  screen is displayed     3  Press A V to select  INTERLOCKED    4  Press 4b to switch the item         OFF  Sets the  VERTICAL  and  HORIZONTAL  zoom ratio     Uses  BOTH  to set zoom ratio  Image can be enlarged or reduced vertically and horizontally at the  same magnification         ON                 5  Press A V to select  VERTICAL  or  HORIZONTAL       f  ON  is selected  select  BOTH      6  Press 4b to adjust     Note    When  ASPECT  is set to  THROUGH    ZOOM  cannot be adjusted     80   ENGLISH    Chapter 4 Settings      POSITION  menu       When  ASPECT  is set to  DEFAULT     1  Press A V to select  ZOOM      2  Press the   ENTER  button     The  ZOOM  screen is displayed     3  Press A V to select  MODE    4  Press 4b to switch the item         INTERNAL  Enlarges the size within the aspect range set with  SCREEN FORMAT     FULL  Enlarges or reduces the size using the entire display area set with  SCREEN FORMAT                  5  Press A V to select  INTERLOCKED    6  Press 4b to switch the item         OFF  Sets the  VERTICAL  and  HORIZONTAL  zoom ratio     Uses  BOTH
204. hen using chemically treated dust cloths  follow the instructions written on its packaging     Lens front surface    Wipe off dirt and dust from the front surface of the lens with a soft clean cloth     Do not use a cloth that is fluffy  dusty  or soaked with oil water     Since the lens is fragile  do not use excessive force when wiping the lens     Attention    The lens is made of glass  Impacts or excessive force when wiping may scratch its surface  Handle with care     Air filter unit    Perform maintenance of the air filter unit in the following cases       The air filter is clogged with dust  causing the filter replacement message to appear on the screen and the filter indicator   FILTER  to light  in red     Removing the air filter unit    Air filter unit compartment and the  Air filter cover fixing screw projector s air intake port        By    Tabs on the  projector body       Air filter cover Air filter unit    Fig  1 Fig  2 Fig  3    1  Remove the air filter cover   Fig  1     Use a Phillips screwdriver to turn the air filter cover screw counterclockwise until it turns freely  and then remove the air filter cover     Loosen the air filter cover fixing screw while putting your hand on     2  Pull out the air filter unit       Pull out the air filter unit frame from the tabs of the projector body while slightly pressing around the center of the frame at the front  side  with the lens  inward as described with the arrow  and pull out the frame at the opposite side fro
205. high voltage power lines or near motors  Doing so may interfere with the operation of the projector    Places where there is high power laser equipment  Directing a laser beam onto the lens surface causes damage to the DLP  chips     E Be sure to ask a specialized technician or your dealer when installing the projector on  a ceiling    The optional Ceiling Mount Bracket for Projectors is required    Model No   ET PKD310H  for High Ceilings   ET PKD310S  for Low Ceilings     E Lens focus    The high clarity projection lens is thermally affected by the light from the light source  making the focus unstable in the period  just after switching on the power  Wait at least 30 minutes with the image projected before adjusting the lens focus     E Make sure to set  HIGH ALTITUDE MODE  to  ON  when using the projector at  elevations between 1 400 m  4 593   or higher and lower than 2 700 m  8 858   above  sea level    Failure to do so may shorten the life of the components and result in malfunctions     E Make sure to set  HIGH ALTITUDE MODE  to  OFF  when using the projector at  elevations lower than 1 400 m  4 593   above sea level   Failure to do so may shorten the life of the components and result in malfunctions     E Do not install the projector at elevations of 2 700 m  8 858   or higher above sea level   Doing so may shorten the life of the components and result in malfunctions     16   ENGLISH    Chapter1 Preparation     Precautions for use       E Do not use the projector ti
206. ice is connected to the  lt HDMI IN gt  terminal of the projector and the image is not projected correctly   1  Press A V to select  HDMI IN      2  Press the  lt ENTER gt  button   e The  HDMI IN  screen is displayed     3  Press 4  to switch the  SIGNAL LEVEL  item       The items will switch each time you press the button         AUTO  Automatically sets the signal level        Select when the HDMI terminal of an external device  such as a blu ray disc player  is connected to  the   HDMI IN  terminal     Select when the DVI D terminal output of an external device  such as a computer  is connected to the    HDMI IN  terminal via a conversion cable or similar cable    Select also when the HDMI terminal output of a computer or other device is connected to the   HDMI  IN   terminal      64 940         0 1023                 Note      The optimal setting varies depending on the output setting of the connected external device  Refer to the operating instructions of the  external device regarding the output of the external device     The HDMI signal level is displayed for every 30 bits of input      SDIIN J 0     Only for PT DZ13KE  PT DS12KE  PT DZ10KE   Set to match the signal to input to the  lt SDI IN 1 gt   lt SDI IN 2   terminals  PT DZ13KE  PT DS12KE  or   SDI IN   terminal  PT DZ10KE      ENGLISH   101    Chapter 4 Settings      DISPLAY OPTION  menu       Setting  SDI LINK      Only for PT DZ13KE  PT DS12KE     1   2     3   4     Press AY to select  SDI IN      Press the
207. ignal  Dots  Horizontal   Vertical freq    kHz   Hz   MHz   1 024 x 768 39 6 50 0 51 9  1 024 x 768 48 4  XGA  1 024 x 768 81 4  1 024 x 768 98 8      MXGA 1 152 x 864 53 7  4  1 280 x 720 37 1     y      1 280 x 720 44 8 V  1280 x 720  1 280 x 720 76 3      1 280 x 720 92 6      1 280 x 768 39 6  4  1280 x 768 1 280 x 768 47 8  4  1 280 x 768  47 4 4  1 280 x 800 41 3 4  1280 x 800 1 280 x 800 49 7 4  1 280 x 800  49 3 v  MSXGA 1 280 x 960 60 0 v  1 280 x 1 024 524 50 0 88 0 A  SXGA  1 280 x 1 024 64 0 60 0 108 0 4  1 366 x 768 47 7 59 8 85 5 V  1366 x 768  1 366 x 768 39 6 49 9 69 0  4  1 400 x 1 050 54 1 50 0 99 9 V  1 400 x 1 050 64 0 60 0 108 0 V  SXGA   1 400 x 1 050 65 2 60 0 122 6 4  1 400 x 1 050 65 3 60 0 121 8 V  1 440 x 900 55 9 59 9 106 5  4  WXGA   1 440 x 900 46 3 49 9 86 8  4  UXGA60 1 600 x 1 200 75 0 60 0 162 0 V  1 680 x 1 050 65 3 60 0 146 3  4  WSXGA   1 680 x 1 050 54 1 50 0 119 5 4  1 920 x 1 080 55 6 49 9 141 5  4  1920 x 1080  1 920 x 1 080  66 6 59 9 138 5 A  1 920 x 1 200 61 8 49 9 158 3 v  WUXGA  1 920 x 1 2002 74 0 60 0 154 0 4                       1 Supports half      2 VESA CVT RB  Reduced Blanking  compliant    182   ENGLISH                               Chapter 6 Appendix     Technical information                                                                                                                                           r J Scanning freq  Dot clock RGB1 RGB2 SDI1 SDI2 7 8 9  3D compatible Resolution Horizontal   Vertical freq  si
208. ion color red is changed  Red is added to or subtracted from the adjustment color    When correction color green is changed  Green is added to or subtracted from the adjustment color    When correction color blue is changed  Blue is added to or subtracted from the adjustment color    This adjustment should be carried out by a person who is familiar with the projector or by a service person because a high level of skill is  required to make a successful adjustment    Pressing the   DEFAULT  button will restore the factory default settings for all items       When  COLOR MATCHING  is set to other than  DFF    COLOR TEMPERATURE  is fixed to  USER1    e Set  3D COLOR MATCHING    page 93  to set whether 2D and 3D signals are set separately or whether common data is used   Only    for PT DZ13KE  PT DS12KE  PT DW11KE   When 2D and 3D settings are set separately   NATIVE  or  3D  is displayed in the upper right of the menu   Only for PT DZ13KE   PT DS12KE  PT DW11KE     96   ENGLISH    Chapter 4 Settings      DISPLAY OPTION  menu       Adjusting the color matching using a colorimeter    Use a colorimeter that can measure chromaticity coordinates and luminance to change the colors  RED    GREEN    BLUE    CYAN     MAGENTA    YELLOW   or  WHITE  to desired colors     1  Press A V to select  COLOR MATCHING    2  Press 4b to select  709MODE  or  MEASURED      3  Press the   ENTER  button     The  709MODE  or  MEASURED MODE  screen is displayed     4  Press A V to select  MEASURED DATA   
209. items will switch each time you press the button                     AUTO  Performs automatic detection and cinema processing   Factory default    OFF  Does not perform cinema processing    25p FIXED  Only during 576i or 1080 50i  P signal input            Performs forced cinema processing  2 2 pulldown     30p FIXED  Only during 480i or 1080 60i  signal input                Note      In  DIGITAL CINEMA REALITY   the picture quality will degrade when a signal other than the 2 2 pulldown is set as  25p FIXED  or  30p  FIXED    Vertical resolution will degrade      When  FRAME RESPONSE  is set to  FAST    DIGITAL CINEMA REALITY  cannot be set      BLANKING  Kyy    You can adjust the blanking width if there are noises at the edge of the screen or the image is slightly running out from the screen while an  image from the VCR or other devices are projected     1  Press AY to select  BLANKING      2  Press the  lt ENTER gt  button     The  BLANKING  adjustment screen is displayed     3  Press A V to select  UPPER    LOWER    LEFT   or  RIGHT        When  CUSTOM MASKING  is set to an item   PC 1    PC 2   or  PC 3   other than  OFF   the blanking width can be adjusted to any  shape using the computer  Up to three blanking settings adjusted using the computer can be saved   To use the  CUSTOM MASKING  function  the optional Upgrade Kit  Model No   ET UK20  is required  To purchase the product   consult your dealer     4  Press 4b to adjust the blanking width     ENGLISH   85    Chapt
210. ity while viewing with 3D Eyewear  discontinue  viewing    Continuing use may cause health problems  Take a break as necessary    When viewing 3D movies  aim to view one movie at a time and take a break as necessary     When viewing 3D images  for example when playing 3D games or using a PC where two way interaction  is possible  take an appropriate break every 30 to 60 minutes   Watching for long periods of time may cause eye fatigue     When preparing contents  use contents properly created to be used for 3D   This may cause eye fatigue or health problems     When viewing 3D images  pay attention to people and objects in the vicinity   3D video may be mistaken for actual objects  and the related bodily movements can cause damage to objects  and lead to injury     Use 3D Eyewear when viewing 3D videos   Do not tilt your head when viewing with 3D Eyewear     Those who are near or far sighted  those with weaker eyesight in one eye  or those with astigmatism  should use corrective glasses etc  when using 3D Eyewear     If the image appears distinctly double when viewing 3D video  discontinue viewing   Watching for long periods of time may cause eye fatigue     View at a distance of at least three times the effective height of the screen    Viewing at distance closer than the recommended distance may cause eye fatigue  As with movies  if there are  black bands at the top and bottom of the video  view at a distance of 3 times or more of the height of the video  section     Childr
211. jector control       Basic control                                                                  1  POWER   Turns on off the power     2  SHUTTER   Switches the setting whether to use the shutter function   closing opening of the shutter       Detail control  page    Click  Projector control       Detail control        1  D 8c   modo creme mon  a  2  D   3  EA i 4  5  3  OSD   Switches on  display  off  hide  the on screen display function   4  SYSTEM   Switches the system method   5  INPUT SELECT     Switches the input signal     2c    arapa onma mr  cm                                                                                              1 Control of the projector  The projector is controlled by clicking the buttons in the same  way as the buttons on the remote control  After control  the on   Screen display of the projector at the right of the control page is  updated    2  SUB MEMORY   Switches the sub memory    3  SYSTEM DAYLIGHT VIEW   Switches to system daylight view settings    4  FREEZE   Temporarily pauses the image    5  PIN P   Switches the P IN P setting    6  LEFT RIGHT SWAP   only for PT DZ13KE  PT DS12KE   PT DW11KE   Switches the flip horizontal settings        T    10    11                10  11    On screen display of the projector   Displays the same items as shown on the on screen display  of the projector  You can check or change the settings of the  menus  It is displayed even if the on screen display function is  set to off  hide      WAVEFORM
212. k level       Use  BRIGHTNESS  in the on screen menu  PICTURE  to adjust the black level 0 96 of the video signal to the 0   position of the  waveform monitor     3  Adjust white level       Use  CONTRAST  in the on screen menu  PICTURE  to adjust the white level 100   of the video signal to the 100   position of the  waveform monitor     Adjusting red  green  and blue    1  Set  COLOR TEMPERATURE  to  USER1  or  USER2    page 72    2  Select  Select line  red   on the waveform monitor     3  Adjust dark red areas     Use  RED  in  WHITE BALANCE LOW  to adjust the black level 0 96 of the video signal to the 0   position of the waveform monitor     4  Adjust bright red areas       Use  RED  in  WHITE BALANCE HIGH  to adjust the white level 100   of the video signal to the 100   position of the waveform  monitor     5  Use the procedure for  RED  to adjust  GREEN  and  BLUE    Note      Before adjusting the black level for DVI D signals  HDMI signals  and SDI signals  confirm that the  SIGNAL LEVEL  setting is correct     ENGLISH   107    Chapter 4 Settings      DISPLAY OPTION  menu     CUTOFF     p   J      s s 0    Each red  green  and blue color component can be removed        1  Press AY to select  CUT OFF      2  Press the   ENTER  button     The  CUT OFF  screen is displayed     3  Press A V to select  RED    GREEN   or  BLUE    4  Press 4b to switch the item                  OFF    Disables cutoff    ON  Enables cutoff     Note      When input is switched or a signal is 
213. level B input only    8 Only while signals other than interlaced signals are input    4 Only while progressive signals with the vertical scanning frequency of 100 Hz or 120 Hz are input to the  lt RGB1 gt   lt RGB2 gt   lt DVI D gt  terminals    92   ENGLISH    Chapter 4 Settings      3D SETTINGS  menu       4  Press the   ENTER  button     Note      When set to  AUTO    SIMULTANEOUS    SIDE BY SIDE    TOP AND BOTTOM    LINE BY LINE   or  FRAME SEQUENTIAL   3D images  are not displayed in  3D SIMUL INPUT SETTING   In  AUTO   however  this only occurs when 3D format can be recognized     This may not function properly for some connected external devices      LEFT RIGHT SWAP     Display images by inverting the timing of horizontal image switching  Change the settings when there is something wrong with the 3D image  being viewed     1  Press A V to select  LEFT RIGHT SWAP    2  Press 4b to switch the item       The items will switch each time you press the button         NORMAL  Do not change the  NORMAL  setting if the 3D images are displayed correctly    SWAPPED  Select this when left and right 3D images are swapped to be displayed                    Note    This is disabled when  3D SYSTEM SETTING  is set to other than  SINGLE       8D COLOR MATCHING   gt    2 v    Switches the color matching correction data applied to the displayed image   1  Press AY to select  3D COLOR MATCHING    2  Press 4b to switch the item       The items will switch each time you press the button    
214. lly    page 62     Chapter 1    Preparation     About your projector       E Connecting terminals    1 2 3       REMOTE 2 IN                            6 6     lt REMOTE 1 IN   terminal  lt REMOTE 1 OUT gt  terminal  These are the terminals to connect the remote control for serial  control when the system uses multiple projectors     lt REMOTE 2 IN  terminal   This is a terminal to remotely control the projector using the  external control circuit      SERIAL IN   terminal   This is the RS 232C compatible terminal to externally control  the projector by connecting a computer      SERIAL OUT gt  terminal   This is a terminal to output the signal connected to the   SERIAL  IN   terminal      SDI IN  terminal   This is the terminal to input SDI signals   Only for PT DZ10KE    lt SDI IN 1 gt  terminal    lt SDI IN 2   terminal   This is the terminal to input SDI signals     Only for PT DZ13KE  PT DS12KE     lt HDMI IN  terminal   This is the terminal to input HDMI signals     Attention    Oe EOS eC        RGB 1 IN  G Y       10    11    12    13    DVED IN VIDEO IN   3D SYNC    B Ps C 1 IN OUT                   9 10 11 12 13      RGB 1 IN     lt R PR gt    lt G Y gt     B Pg C     lt SYNC HD gt    lt VD gt    terminal   This is a terminal to input RGB signals or the YCgCp YP gPp and  Y C signals     lt RGB 2 IN gt  terminal   This is a terminal to input RGB signals or YCgCr YPpgPp signals    lt DVI D IN gt  terminal   This is the terminal to input DVI D signals     lt VIDEO IN gt
215. lockwise    When the just focus point of the  screen in V bottom  bottom in  the vertical direction  is in the  inner side of the screen    When the just focus point of  the screen in H left  left in the  horizontal direction  is in the  inner side of the screen    When the just focus point of the  screen in H right  right in the  horizontal direction  is in the  inner side of the screen        b     Rotate counterclockwise    Rotate counterclockwise           c           Rotate counterclockwise          Rotate counterclockwise          1     2   3     4     5     Press the   FOCUS    button on the remote control or the   LENS    button on the control panel to  display the  FOCUS  adjustment menu     Press VW to shift the focus of the entire screen once     Press A to stop on any part of the screen to be the first just focus point   e For the location where focus is shifted in this state  the just focus point is on the inner side of the screen     Loosen the fixed screws in the position relative to the location where the focus is shifted the most   the location where the just focus point is shifted the most towards the inner side in Step 2   up to two  rotations      Turn screws clockwise in two locations  or at least in one location to be adjusted     Little by little  turn the focus adjustment screws corresponding to the locations counterclockwise and  stop where the image is in focus       page 58     e  f the screws are turned counterclockwise  the tilt of the lens will c
216. ls with v  in the Plug and play columns are signals described in EDID  extended display identification data  of the projector  A signal  which  has no v in the Plug and play columns but has an entry in the Format column  can be input  For signals without v  in the Plug and play columns   resolution may not be selected in the computer even though the projector supports them     2 For single link connections only    8 Pixel Repetition signal  dot clock frequency 27 0 MHz  only    4 When a 1125  1035  60i signal was input  it is displayed as a 1125  1080  60i signal     5 Only for SDI1    6 For dual link connections only    7 When  3D INPUT FORMAT  is set to  AUTO   3D images in frame sequential format are displayed  To display images in 2D  set  3D INPUT  FORMAT  to  NATIVE      8 VESA CVT RB  Reduced Blanking  compliant    9 Only for PT DW11KE    10 Samples the pixels in the image processing circuit and projects the image     11 Only for PT DZ13KE  PT DZ10KE    Note      There are 1 920 x 1 080 display dots for PT DZ13KE and PT DZ10KE  1 400 x 1 050 for PT DS12KE  and 1 366 x 768 for PT DW11KE  A  signal with a different resolution is converted to the number of display dots      The  i  at the end of the resolution indicates an interlaced signal      When interlaced signals are connected  flickering may occur on the projected image     List of 3D compatible signals     Only for PT DZ13KE  PT DS12KE  PT DW11KE   The following table specifies the 3D compatible video signals that
217. lted to the right or left     Using the projector at a vertical angle that exceeds 15   may reduce product life or result in malfunction     B When installing and using the projector at an angle that exceeds 30   vertically  set   COOLING CONDITION    gt  page 110      Failure to observe this may shorten the life of the components or result in malfunctions     E When using the Replacement lamp unit  for portrait mode   install the projector with  the terminals surface facing down     Do not use the projector tilted to the right and left  front and back  Using the projector at an angle that exceeds 15   in either  direction may reduce the life of the components or result in malfunctions     E Cautions when setting up the projector     When installing and using the projector with a method other than the floor standing installation using the adjustable feet  fix  the projector using the five screw holes for ceiling mount  as shown in the figure     Screw diameter  M6  tapping depth inside the set  16 mm  5 8    torque  4   0 5 N m      Make a clearance of at least 5 mm  3 16   between the projector bottom and the setting surface by inserting spacers   metallic  between them     Adjustable feet                                    Mount                          Spacer                         Screw holes for ceiling mount   M6                                                                                                                                                           Adju
218. m the tabs to remove the air filter  unit   Fig  2      After pulling out the air filter unit  remove large foreign objects and dust from the air filter unit compartment and the air intake port of  the projector body if there are any   Fig  3     160   ENGLISH    Chapter 5 Maintenance     Maintenance replacement       Cleaning the air filter unit    Remove the air filter unit beforehand with the previously described procedure of    Removing the air filter unit      1     2        Fig  1 Fig  2    Wash the air filter unit   Fig  1     Soak the air filter unit in cold or warm water and then lightly rinse it       Do not use cleaning tools such as brushes     When rinsing  hold the frame of the air filter unit without putting strong pressure on the filter unit     Rinse the air filter unit two to three times using fresh water each time     Insufficient rinsing may result in odors     Dry the air filter unit   Fig  2      Let the air filter unit naturally dry off in a well ventilated place where there is little dust and is not exposed to direct sunlight     Do not dry using drying devices such as dryers      After the air filter is dried  proceed to    Attaching the air filter unit    page 161      Attaching the air filter unit    Tabs on the projector body                        Groove on the projector body          LONE    Tabs on the projector body         Protrusion of the air filter unit    a I  Protrusion of the air filter unit                            Groove on the proje
219. matically registered signal name will be used     Registered signals can be deleted   1  Press A V 4b to select the signal to delete     2  Press the  lt DEFAULT gt  button     The  REGISTERED SIGNAL DELETE  screen is displayed     130   ENGLISH    Chapter 4 Settings      SIGNAL LIST  menu         To cancel the deletion  press the   MENU  button to return to the  REGISTERED SIGNAL LIST  screen     3  Press the   ENTER  button       The selected signal will be deleted     Note    Aregistered signal can also be deleted from  REGISTERED SIGNAL DELETE  on the  REGISTERED SIGNAL SETUP  screen     APRECIA li  al    1  Press A V 4b to select the signal to protect     2  Press the   ENTER  button     The  REGISTERED SIGNAL STATUS  screen is displayed     3  Press the   ENTER  button     The  REGISTERED SIGNAL SETUP  screen is displayed     4  Press A V to select  LOCK    5  Press 4b to switch the item       The items will switch each time you press the button         OFF  The signal is not protected    ON  The signal is protected                 Note      When  LOCK  is set to  ON   signal deletion  image adjustment  and automatic setup are not available  To perform these operations  set   LOCK  to  OFF       Asignal can be registered to the sub memory even if it is protected      Even a protected signal will be deleted if  INITIALIZE  is executed     1  Press A V 4b to select the signal to set     2  Press the   ENTER  button     The  REGISTERED SIGNAL STATUS  screen is displayed   
220. move   e Fan and other components are attached to the lamp unit cover  handle the removed lamp unit cover with care     Remove the lamp unit   Fig  2       Use a Phillips screwdriver to turn the lamp unit fixing screws  x2  counterclockwise until they turn freely  and then remove the lamp  unit      Hold the handles of the lamp unit and remove it in the horizontal direction      Do not remove the screws other than the lamp unit fixing screws     Push in the new lamp unit while paying attention to the insertion position   Fig  3     Push the guides to attach the lamp unit slowly into the projector body along the grooves for guide to attach the lamp unit   e  f the lamp unit is not installed properly  remove it and then push it in slowly  Pushing it in quickly or forcibly may break the connector     164   ENGLISH    Chapter 5 Maintenance     Maintenance replacement       5  Use a Phillips screwdriver to firmly tighten the lamp unit fixing screws  x2 each      Make sure to attach the lamp unit securely     6  Attach the lamp unit cover     i  Close the lamp unit cover in Step 2  in the reverse order     Attach the lamp unit cover so that the connector of the lamp unit cover is inserted to the fan power connector securely     ii  Use a Phillips screwdriver to firmly tighten the lamp unit fixing screw  x1      Make sure to attach the lamp unit cover securely     Note      When you replace the lamp unit with new one  the projector resets the runtime of the lamp unit automatically  
221. mp unit for both lamps    When replacing the lamp unit  loosen the lamp unit cover fixing screw while putting your hand on                    Lamp unit cover    Grooves for the guide to attach the lamp unit    S  Bae  IS  E  E  E  E  E  B                                        Lamp unit cover fixing screw                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Fig  1    Guide to attach the  Lamp unit 2 lamp unit  Handles  Lamp unit 1  a  A ae  Fan power connector  Lamp unit fixing screws Grooves for the guide to attach the lamp unit    Fig  2 Fig  3    Set the   MAIN POWER  switch to   OFF   and disconnect the power plug from the power outlet       Wait at least one hour and check if the lamp unit has cooled down   Remove the lamp unit cover   Fig  1     Use a Phillips screwdriver to turn the lamp unit cover fixing screw  x1  counterclockwise until it turns freely  and open the lamp unit cover  slowly in the direction of the arrow       Opening the lamp unit cover quickly may result in damage to the cover        f you loosen the lamp unit cover fixing screw with the projector installed upward in the vertical direction  the lamp unit cover may open  on its weight and the lamp unit may be dropped off     Hold the lamp unit cover securely and slide it in the direction of the arrow  and then pull it out backward to re
222. ms set in  3D SYNC2    10  Stereo synch output Frame synch output   11  3D IR TRANSMITTER     output 3D IR TRANSMITTER     output       6  When  1    4    7   or  10  is selected  press A W to select  STEREO SYNC OUTPUT DELAY   and press   lt  gt  to set the amount of delay output                  0us     25 000 us  Allows you to set in increments of 10 us          To synchronize multiple projectors to display 3D images  use a frame synch input and output   Select  9  or  10  for the first projector   Select  6    7   or  8  for the second and subsequent projectors     Stereo synchronization is a signal having a 50   duty cycle where High is for the left eye and Low is for the right eye   e    H    is output to the 3D image display and    L    is output to the 2D image display from the terminal for which 3D trigger output is selected     Note    e  11  or  3D SYNC MODE  is the setting when the 3D IR TRANSMITTER TY 3DTRW of Panasonic is used with the projector  Consult your  dealer regarding the connection method     Set this item to input and use 3D video signals of the simultaneous system   1  Press A V to select  3D SIMUL INPUT SETTING      2  Press the   ENTER  button     The  3D SIMUL INPUT SETTING  screen is displayed     3  Press A V to select  LEFT RGB1 RIGHT RGB2    LEFT HDMI RIGHT DVI D   or  LEFT SDI1 RIGHT SDI2    only for PT DZ13KE  PT DS12KE      4  Press 4b to switch the setting         OFF  Cannot use 3D simultaneous                  AUTO  Displays 3D images of
223. n bright areas    GRAPHIC  The image becomes suitable for input from the personal computer    USER  Set any desired picture mode        Note      The factory default picture mode is  GRAPHIC  for still image input signals and  STANDARD  for movie based input signals      DICOM is an abbreviation of  Digital Imaging and COmmunication in Medicine  and is a standard for medical imaging devices  Although the  DICOM name is used  the projector is not a medical device  and should not be used for purposes such as diagnosis of display images      Press the   ENTER  button when each  PICTURE MODE  is selected to save as a specified value when a new signal is input  The data of  all items except  SYSTEM SELECTOR  in the  PICTURE  menu is saved       n the factory default settings   USER  is set to images that comply with the ITU R BT 709 standard     Changing the  USER  name    1  Press A to select  PICTURE MODE    2  Press 4b to select  USER      3  Press the   ENTER  button     The  PICTURE MODE  detailed screen is displayed     4  Press A V to select  PICTURE MODE NAME CHANGE   and press the   ENTER  button     The  PICTURE MODE NAME CHANGE  screen is displayed     5  Press A V 4b to select the text  and press the   ENTER    button to enter the text     6  Press A V 4  to select  OK   and press the   ENTER  button       The picture mode name is changed      CONTRAST    1    You can adjust the contrast of the colors     1  Press A V to select  CONTRAST      ENGLISH   71    Chapter 4 
224. n the  PROJECTOR SETUP  menu      STANDBY MODE  is set to  ECO   use of some functions is restricted  but the power  consumption during standby can be conserved     Even if the main power   MAIN POWER  switch is turned   OFF    during projection or immediately after turning off the luminous lamp  the  fan runs using internally stored power to cool the luminous lamp  When the projector is mounted on the ceiling or installed in an environment    where the main power   MAIN POWER  switch of the projector cannot be easily turned   OFF    the power can be turned off directly using the  circuit breaker  It is also safe in case a power outage occurs or the power cord is pulled out immediately after the projector is switched off     Note       f the projector was turned off by turning off the circuit breaker directly during projection last time  then the power indicator   ON  G    STANDBY  R  gt  will light in green a while after the circuit breaker is turned on  and then projection of the image will start       f cooled with the direct power off function  projection may take a longer time than usual to start when the projector is switched on the next  time      Make sure that the fan is not running when packing the projector for transportation or storage     ENGLISH   55    Chapter 3 Basic Operations     Projecting       Projecting    Check the projection lens attachment   page 46   external device connection   page 48   power cord connection   page 52    switch on the power   page 
225. nd becomes louder when set to  ON      This item cannot be set when using the optional Smoke cut filter  Model No   ET SFD320    Setting is fixed to  OFF    Use it at elevations  lower than 1 400 m  4 593   above sea level      LAMP SELECT         11    Select the lamp to be turned on from the two built in luminous lamps according to the use conditions or purposes     1  Press A V to select  LAMP SELECT    2  Press 4b to switch the item                     DUAL  Two lamps will light    SINGLE  One lamp will light   The lamp with shorter runtime will automatically light     LAMP 1  Lamp 1 will light     LAMP2  Lamp 2 will light              110   ENGLISH    Chapter4 Settings      PROJECTOR SETUP  menu       3  Press the   ENTER  button     Note      For a certain time after  LAMP SELECT  is switched   LAMP SELECT  cannot be switched again  because the speed of the lamp  replacement cycle will increase  Repeatedly switching  LAMP SELECT  in a short time will also increase the speed of the lamp replacement  cycle      The colors of the items indicate the status                          Green Current setting   Yellow Current setting  when there is a lamp that cannot turn on or failed to turn on   Red Lamp that has failed to turn on   White Any other status       e When a lamp cannot turn on or the runtime exceeds 2 500 hours  2  the lamp is turned off and the other lamp is turned on  The projector  enters standby mode when the runtime of both lamps exceeds 2 500 hours 1 2     1 5
226. ng on the conditions of use  the screen may fluctuate in rare cases due   to the heated air from the air exhaust port or the hot or cooled air  Make sure that the exhaust from the projector or other  equipment  or the air from the air conditioner does not blow toward the front of the projector    Places with sharp temperature fluctuations such as near lights  studio lamps   Doing so may shorten the life of the lamp  or  result in deformation of the outer case due to heat  which may cause malfunctions    The operating environment temperature of the projector should be between 0   C  32   F  and 45   C  113   F  when using it at  elevations lower than 1 400 m  4 593   above sea level  and between 0   C  32   F  and 40   C  104   F  when using it at high  altitudes  1 400 m  4 593     or higher     lower than 2 700 m  8 858   above sea level     If you use the Smoke cut filter  the operating environment temperature should be between 0   C  32   F  and 35   C  95   F    However  it cannot be used at high altitudes    If you use the Replacement lamp unit  for portrait mode   the operating environment temperature should be between 0   C   32   F  and 40   C  104   F  when using the projector at elevations lower than 1 400 m  4 593   above sea level  and between  0   C  32   F  and 35   C  95   F  when using the projector at high altitudes  If you use the Smoke cut filter together  the  operating environment temperature should be between 0   C  32   F  and 30   C  86   F       Near 
227. nge the settings of the  PROJECTOR SETUP  menu      PROJECTION METHOD  and  COOLING  CONDITION  depending on the installation mode       page 31     e Refer to    Navigating through the menu       page 65  for the operation of the menu screen     3  Press the input selection   lt RGB1 gt    lt RGB2 gt    lt DVI D gt     VIDEO     lt HDMI gt    lt SDI 1 2    buttons to select    the input signal    SDI input is only for PT DZ13KE  PT DS12KE  PT DZ10KE     4  Adjust the front  back and sideway tilt of the projector with the adjustable feet       page 45    5  Press the  lt SHIFT gt  button to adjust the position of the image    6  Ifthe input signal is an RGB signal  press the   AUTO SETUP  button    7  Press the   ZOOM    button to adjust the size of the image to match the screen    8  Press the  lt FOCUS gt  button again to adjust the focus    9  Press the   ZOOM    button again to adjust the zoom and the size of the image to match the screen     Note      When the projector is switched on for the first time after purchase  as well as when  ALL USER DATA  is executed from the  PROJECTOR  SETUP  menu  gt   INITIALIZE   the focus adjustment screen is displayed after projection starts  then the  INITIAL SETTING  screen is  displayed  Refer to    Start up display    page 22  for details     54   ENGLISH    Chapter 3 Basic Operations     Switching on off the projector                  POWER ON STANDBY    4            M   N POWER  or ON     om                                       
228. not use a new battery together with an old battery or mix different types of batteries   Do not use batteries with the outer cover peeling away or removed     If the battery fluid leaks  do not touch it with bare hands  and take the following measures if necessary   e Battery fluid on your skin or clothing could result in skin inflammation or injury   Rinse with clean water and seek medical advice immediately   e Battery fluid coming in contact with your eyes could result in loss of sight   In this case  do not rub your eyes  Rinse with clean water and seek medical advice immediately     Do not remove unspecified screws during the lamp unit replacement   Doing so can cause electric shocks  burns  or injury     Do not disassemble the lamp unit   If the lamp breaks  it could cause injury     Lamp replacement  The lamp has high internal pressure  If improperly handled  an explosion and severe injury or accidents will  result   e The lamp can easily explode if struck against hard objects or dropped   e Before replacing the lamp unit  be sure to turn the power off and to disconnect the power plug from the wall  outlet   Electric shocks or explosions can result if this is not done   e When replacing the lamp unit  turn the power off and allow the lamp to cool for at least one hour before  handling it otherwise it can cause burns     Do not use the supplied power cord with devices other than this projector   e Using the supplied power cord with devices other than this projector may 
229. o select  3D FRAME DELAY    2  Press 4b to switch the item                  0us     25 000 us  Allows you to set in increments of 10 us          The adjustment range depends on the input signal      SD TEST MODE     J                        i   c         Set the image display system for use with 3D system adjustments   1  Press A V to select  3D TEST MODE    2  Press 4b to switch the item                              NORMAL  Standard setting    SIDE BY SIDE  The left eye image is displayed on the left  next to the right eye image displayed on the right    LEFT LEFT  Both the left eye image and right eye image display the left eye input signal     RIGHT RIGHT  Both the left eye image and right eye image display the right eye input signal     LEFT BLACK  The left eye input signal is displayed in the left eye image and a completely black image is displayed  in the right eye image     BLACK RIGHT  A completely black image is displayed in the left eye image and the right input signal is displayed in  the right eye image           Note      The  3D TEST MODE  settings return to  NORMAL  when the projector is switched off     This is disabled when  3D SYSTEM SETTING  is set to other than  SINGLE      This is disabled when  3D TEST PATTERN  is displayed     94   ENGLISH    Chapter 4 Settings      3D SETTINGS  menu     SD TEST PATTERN  000    The 3D test pattern can be used to check operation and make adjustments even without a 3D signal        1  Press A to select  3D TEST PATTERN   
230. o switch                          Setting  PC CORRECTION     To use the  PC CORRECTION  function  the optional Upgrade Kit  Model No   ET UK20  is required  To purchase the product  consult your    dealer     1  Press A V to select  UNIFORMITY      2  Press the   ENTER  button     The  UNIFORMITY  screen is displayed     3  Press A V to select  PC CORRECTION      4  Press 4b to switch the item        Parameter Operation Adjustment Range of adjustment  Press the  gt  button  Deepens upper colors    VERTICAL   Press the 4 button  Deepens lower colors  427   127  Press the  gt  button  Deepens colors on the left    HORIZONTAL     Press the 4 button  Deepens colors on the right               OFF     Does not use a computer to correct         ON           Use a computer to correct the brightness and color unevenness of the entire screen            1 Advanced skills are necessary to use computer controls to correct  Consult your dealer     Note    e  UNIFORMITY  can be set for each  LAMP SELECT  setting     The  UNIFORMITY  settings are not reset to the factory default when  INITIALIZE  is executed     ENGLISH   105    Chapter 4 Settings      DISPLAY OPTION  menu     SHUTTER SETTING      1    Set image fade in and fade out at opening and closing of the shutter  Set automatic opening and closing of the shutter when power is turned  on        Setting  FADE IN  or  FADE OUT     1  Press A V to select  SHUTTER SETTING      2  Press the   ENTER  button     The  SHUTTER SETTING  screen i
231. ol     2  Within five seconds  press the two digit ID number set on the projector using the number   lt 0 gt     lt 9 gt    buttons      f you press the   ID ALL   button  you can control the projectors regardless of the ID number setting of the projector     Attention    e Since the ID number of the remote control can be set without the projector  do not press the   ID SET  button carelessly  If the   ID SET    button is pressed and no number   lt 0 gt     lt 9 gt   buttons are pressed within five seconds  the ID number returns to its original value before the    ID SET  button was pressed      The ID number set on the remote control will be stored unless it is set again  However  it will be erased if the remote control is left with dead  batteries  Set the same ID number again when the batteries are replaced     Note  e Set the ID number of the projector from the  PROJECTOR SETUP  menu      PROJECTOR ID      28   ENGLISH    Chapter 1 Preparation     Using the remote control    C   l l T    When you use the system with multiple projectors  use commercial M3 stereo mini jack cables and connect the other devices to the  lt REMOTE  1 IN gt   lt REMOTE 1 OUT gt  terminals of the projector body     The remote control is effective even in places where an obstacle stands in the light path or where devices are susceptible to outside light        M3 stereo mini jack cable  commercially  available                             Connecting to a second projector    Connecting to the remote
232. ol range may be reduced    e  f there are any obstacles between the remote control and the remote control signal receiver  the remote control may not operate properly    The signal will be reflected off the screen  However  the operating range may be limited from light reflection loss due to the screen material    If the remote control signal receiver directly receives strong light  such as fluorescent light  the remote control may not operate properly  Use   itin a place distant from the light source      The power indicator   ON  G  STANDBY  R  gt  will flash if the projector receives a remote control signal                                                                                                                                                                                      14                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    E Bottom  a WARNING      Keep your hands and other objects away from the air  Q       exhaust port   C0000 E Ns   Keep your hands and face away   p   M y        UN    Do not insert your fingers       DD  DU i    M    il m 00 my Keep heat sensitive objects away   COOL  gg DOO DD   Heated air from the air exhaust port can cause burns  injury  or  RED thea ER   deformations    BOBO nn i    Bo  00  Ifoga pn 
233. on    5  Re enter the password for the confirmation   6  Press the   ENTER  button    Note      The entered password is displayed with marks on the screen     ENGLISH   133    Chapter 4 Settings      SECURITY  menu         When numerical values are used for the security password  the security password is required to be initialized if the remote control is lost   Consult your dealer for the method of initialization      DISPLAY SETTING  1    Overlap the security message  text or image  over the projecting image     1  Press A V to select  DISPLAY SETTING    2  Press 4b to switch the item       The items will switch each time you press the button                     OFF  The text display is disabled    TEXT  The text display is enabled    USER LOGO  Displays the image registered by the user        Note    To create register the  USER LOGO  image  use    Logo Transfer Software  included in the supplied CD ROM     Change the text displayed when the text display is enabled by selecting  TEXT  in  DISPLAY SETTING    1  Press A V to select  TEXT CHANGE      2  Press the   ENTER  button     The  TEXT CHANGE  screen is displayed     3  Press A W 4  to select the text  and press the   ENTER  button to enter the text     4  Press A V 4  to select  OK   and press the   ENTER  button       The text is changed   Enable disable the button operations on the control panel and the remote control   1  Press A V to select  CONTROL DEVICE SETUP      2  Press the   ENTER  button     The  CONTROL D
234. p   A high pressure mercury lamp has the following characteristics     The luminance of the lamp will decrease by duration of usage       The lamp may burst with a loud sound or have its service life shortened because of shock  chipping  or degradation due to  cumulative runtime       The lamp life varies greatly depending on individual differences and usage conditions  In particular  frequent on off switching  of the power greatly deteriorate the lamp and affects the lamp life       Continuous use for over one week will deteriorate the lamp  The degradation of the lamp due to continuous use can be  reduced by using the  PROJECTOR SETUP  menu      LAMP RELAY         n rare cases  the lamps burst shortly after projection starts       The risk of bursting increases when the lamp is used beyond its replacement cycle  Make sure to replace the lamp unit  regularly         When to replace the lamp unit      page 163      How to replace the lamp unit    amp  page 164    e  f the lamp bursts  gas contained inside of the lamp is released in the form of smoke      t is recommended that you store the Replacement lamp unit as a contingency     E Computer and external device connections     When connecting a computer or an external device  read this manual carefully regarding the use of power cords and  shielded cables as well      Use a commercial cable with a ferrite core for connecting with the   DVI D IN  terminal     E Viewing 3D images    Only for PT DZ13KE  PT DS12KE  PT DW11KE    
235. p  1080 25p  1080 30p  1080 50p  1080 60p    4 SDI  only for PT DZ13KE  PT DS12KE     5 SDI2  only for PT DZ13KE  PT DS12KE     6 SDI  only for PT DZ10KE     7 Dual link HD SDI  only for PT DZ13KE  PT DS12KE     Control device password        To initialize your password  consult your distributor     178   ENGLISH    Chapter 6 Appendix     Technical information        Only for PT DZ13KE  PT DS12KE   If the optional Upgrade Kit  Model No   ET UK20  is applied  the following functions are extended              Function Standard status When the Upgrade Kit is applied  Adjustment range of Maximum of  40   1 Maximum of  45   1   VERTICAL KEYSTONE   Adjustment range of Maximum of  15   1 Maximum of  40   1   HORIZONTAL KEYSTONE         CURVED     Adjustment range of    Vertical arc  Maximum  50   1  Horizontal arc  Maximum  50   1    Vertical arc  Maximum   100    Horizontal arc  Maximum  100  1        CUSTOM MASKING     Cannot be used     The image can be masked in optional form            PC CORRECTION  of   UNIFORMITY     Cannot be used           The brightness and unevenness of color of the entire  screen can be corrected            1 The adjustment range of the menu  Refer to      GEOMETRY  projection range    page 33  for the possible projection range   For details  refer to the Operating Instructions included in the CD ROM of the optional Upgrade Kit  Model No   ET UK20      List of blaai    The following table specifies the video signals compatible with the projector   e Sym
236. p and projector if used    in incorrect setting     Switch to HIGH ALTITUDE MODE  ON  if over 1400m   4593Ft         MENUSELECT 4b CHANGE  G9 SET       3  Press the   ENTER  button to proceed to the initial setting     Initial setting  Tm     Only for PT DZ13KE  PT DS12KE  PT DZ10KE     Set the screen format  aspect ratio  and display position of the image  After completed the initial setting  you can change the settings of each  item from the  DISPLAY OPTION  menu      SCREEN SETTING      1  Press AY to select an item     2  Press 4b to switch the setting     INITIAL SETTING  SCREEN FORMAT    Set as necessary for the screen in use        MENUSELECT 4b CHANGE  E SET       e  SCREEN FORMAT   9 page 97      SCREEN POSITION   9 page 97     3  Press the   ENTER  button     Confirm the setting value and complete the initial setting     Note       f you press the   MENU  button while the  INITIAL SETTING  screen is displayed  you can go back to the previous screen     To continue operations after completed the initial settings  refer to  Selecting the input signal    amp  page 56        By default  the time zone of the projector is set to  09 00  Japan and Korean Standard Time   Change the setting in the  PROJECTOR  SETUP  menu      DATE AND TIME   gt   TIME ZONE  to the time zone of the region where you use the projector     ENGLISH   23    Chapter1 Preparation     About your projector       About your projector       10    B Front    Panasonic  PROJECTOR       Remote control indi
237. pensates the signal    2  Moderately compensates the signal    3  Strongly compensates the signal              Note    e When  DYNAMIC GAMMA  is set to  3   the contrast will be maximized       Brightness control and iris operate simultaneously  but the iris is fully open and does not operate while a brightness measurement is    performed      SYSTEM SELECTOR  1 11    The projector will automatically detect the input signal  but you can set the system method manually when an unstable signal is input  Set the  system method matching the input signal     1   2   3     4     Press A V to select  SYSTEM SELECTOR      Press the   ENTER  button     Press AY to select a system format     Available system formats vary depending on the input signal        Terminal    System format         VIDEO IN  terminal    G   Y gt   lt B P  C gt  terminals    Select  AUTO    NTSC    NTSC4 43    PAL    PAL M    PAL N    SECAM   or  PAL60     Set it to  AUTO  normally   Setting  AUTO  will automatically select  NTSC    NTSC4 43    PAL     PAL M    PAL N    SECAM   or  PAL60      Switch the setting to the signal method for the TV used          RGB 1 IN  terminal    RGB 2  IN   terminal    480i  576i  or 576p signal    Select  RGB  or  YCgC          VGA60 or 480p signal    Select  VGA60    480p YC Cal  or  480p RGB         Other movie based signals    Select  RGB  or  Y PPR           DVI D IN  terminal    480i  576i  480p  or 576p  signal    Select  RGB  or  YCgCp         Other movie based signals   
238. plays images in the entire screen range selected in  SCREEN FORMAT   When the aspect ratio of   HV FIT  the input signals differs from that of the screen range  the images are displayed with the aspect ratio  converted to that of the screen selected in  SCREEN FORMAT                         1 For video signals and Y C signals  NTSC  only    2 For RGB  480i or 480p  signal input only    3 Standard signals are input signals with an aspect ratio of 4 3 or 5 4     4 Wide screen signals are input signals with an aspect ratio of 16 10  16 9  15 9 or 15 10     Note    e Some size modes are not available for certain types of input signals   DEFAULT  cannot be selected for video signal  Y C signal  NTSC   or  RGB  480i  480p  signal    e  f an aspect ratio which is different from the aspect ratio for the input signals is selected  the images will appear differently from the originals   Be careful of this when selecting the aspect ratio       f using the projector in places such as cafes or hotels to display programs for a commercial purpose or for public presentation  note that  adjusting the aspect ratio or using the zoom function to change the screen images may be an infringement of the rights of the original  copyright owner for that program under copyright protection laws  Take care when using a function of the projector such as the aspect ratio  adjustment and zoom function       f conventional  normal  4 3 images which are not wide screen images are displayed on a wide screen  t
239. pply BRIGHTNESS  CONTROL  Please check projector    The projector is in standby  Switch on the power   status          Exceed maximum number of  projectors              Assign the same  User name  and  Password  strings that have web control administrator rights to  all projectors to be linked          There is a problem with the brightness sensor  If problems persist even after switching on the     Brightness Sensor Error   power  consult your dealer                  1  Multi Projector Monitoring  amp  Control Software  is included in the supplied CD ROM   Note    e  f the synchronized projectors are not displayed in the list  check the following     Are there devices with the same IP address on the network     Are the LAN cables connected correctly    page 138     Are the subnets of the projectors the same     Are the same  LINK  settings applied to a group     Refer to  NETWORK SETUP   9 page 137  or     Network config  page    gt  page 146  on how to change the projector name     ENGLISH   115    Chapter4 Settings      PROJECTOR SETUP  menu       Brightness control adjustment procedure example   The steps exemplify an adjustment to link the brightness of eight projectors connected in a network   1  Connect all projectors to the hub using LAN cables       page 138    2  Switch on all projectors and start projection    3  Set  LAMP SELECT  to either  DUAL  or  SINGLE  for all projectors     4  Set  MODE  of  BRIGHTNESS CONTROL SETUP  to  OFF   and select  APPLY   and then p
240. pprox  two minutes after the shutter opens      When  MODE  in  BRIGHTNESS CONTROL SETUP  is set to  AUTO  or  PC   the lamp brightness is automatically measured eight minutes  after the lamp is turned on  and correction is performed so that the screen brightness will be the same as the standard brightness when the  brightness control is adjusted  Lamp brightness cannot be measured during the eight minutes after it is turned on because it is not steady    e  f a lamp turns off or lamp relay is performed while  MODE  in  BRIGHTNESS CONTROL SETUP  is set to  AUTO  and  LAMP SELECT  is  set to  DUAL   brightness is corrected to the extent possible one minute later      When  MODE  in  BRIGHTNESS CONTROL SETUP  is set to  AUTO  and  LINK  is set to  OFF   brightness will be corrected until it reaches  the maximum amount of correction      The variation in brightness may increase due to dust accumulating on the lens  screen  or inside the projector  depending on the installation  environment of the projector      Adjust brightness control again when lamp degradation causes increased variation in brightness or a lamp is replaced      For continued use longer than 24 hours  set the  BRIGHTNESS CONTROL SETUP  to  CALIBRATION TIME   or set  LAMP RELAY     9 page 111   If it is not set  correction will not be performed automatically      Brightness control and iris operate simultaneously  but the iris is fully open and does not operate while a brightness measurement is  performed      
241. projector     Do not place the projector in extremely hot locations   Doing so will cause the outer casing or internal components to deteriorate  or result in fire   e Take particular care in locations exposed to direct sunlight or near stoves     Do not place your hands in the openings beside the optical lens  while shifting the lens   Failure to observe this could cause injury     Do not stand in front of the lens while the projector is being used   Doing so can cause damage and burns to clothing   e Extremely strong light is emitted from the projector s lens     Do not place objects in front of the lens while the projector is being used   Doing so can cause damage to the object and can cause the set to malfunction   e Extremely strong light is emitted from the projector s lens     Always disconnect all cables before moving the projector   Moving the projector with cables still attached can damage the cables  which will cause fire or electric shocks to  occur     When mounting the projector on the ceiling  keep mounting screws and power cord from contact with  metal parts inside the ceiling   Contact with metal parts inside the ceiling can cause electric shocks     B ACCESSORIES    Do not use the old lamp unit   If used it could cause lamp explosion     If the lamp has broken  ventilate the room immediately  Do not touch or bring your face close to the  broken pieces   Failure to observe this will cause the user to absorb the gas which was released when the lamp broke and  
242. prox  50 mm  1 31 32      ay iil Rear adjustable feet  Approx  10 mm  13 32         V    Attention    e Heated air is expelled from the air exhaust port while the lamp is lit  Do not touch the air exhaust port directly when adjusting the adjustable  feet    page 25     ENGLISH   45    Chapter 2 Getting Started     Attaching removing the projection lens  optional        Attaching removing the projection lens  optional     Move the projection lens to the home position before replacing or removing the projection lens       page 57     Attention      Replace the projection lens after turning off the power of the projector      Do not touch the lens signal receiver  Dust or dirt may cause defective contact      Do not touch the surface of the projection lens with your bare hands      Before attaching the projection lens  remove the lens cover attached to the projection lens        Attach the projection lens using the following procedure     Screw hole A    Lens fixing screw                                                                         Fig  1 Fig  2    1  Insert by aligning the projection lens mark  orange  with the mark on the projector body  O to the left  of LOCK  and turn clockwise until it clicks   Fig  1     2  Secure the projection lens with the lens fixing screw supplied   Fig  2     Use a Phillips screwdriver to secure it in the screw hole A to the right of the projection lens mark  orange      Note  e Some lenses may not have a screw hole for securing the projec
243. r Unit  Model No   ET EMF320  if it is damaged or if the dirt does not come  off even after washing      Air filter replacement is recommended after cleaning the unit two times      The dust proof properties may be reduced after each cleaning     ENGLISH   161    Chapter 5 Maintenance     Maintenance replacement    Air filter unit       If dirt does not come off even after the unit is maintained  it is time for the unit to be replaced   The Replacement Filter Unit  Model No   ET EMF320  is an optional accessory  To purchase the product  consult your dealer     Replacing the air filter unit    Attention      Make sure to turn off the power before replacing the air filter unit     When attaching the unit  make sure that the projector is stable  and perform the replacement in a safe place where the unit will not be  damaged even if you drop the air filter unit     1  Remove the air filter unit   e Refer to    Removing the air filter unit    page 160      2  Attach the optional Replacement Filter Unit  Model No   ET EMF320  to the projector       The air filter unit has no difference between top and bottom  but is two sided  Match the protrusion position of the air filter unit with the  grooves on the projector body     e Refer to    Attaching the air filter unit       page 161      Attention      When switching on the projector  make sure that the air filter unit is attached  If it is not properly attached  the projector will suck in dirt and  dust causing a malfunction       f 
244. r papers  as these materials could be drawn into the air intake port     Do not place your hands or other objects close to the air exhaust port   Doing so will cause burns or damage your hands or other objects   e Heated air comes out of the air exhaust port  Do not place your hands or face  or objects which cannot  withstand heat close to this port     Do not look at the light emitted from the lens while the projector is being used   Doing so can cause loss of sight   e Strong light is emitted from the projector s lens  Do not directly look at this light   e Be especially careful not to let young children look into the lens  In addition  turn off the power and switch  off the main power when you are away from the projector     Never attempt to remodel or disassemble the projector   High voltages can cause fire or electric shocks   e For any inspection  adjustment and repair work  please contact an Authorized Service Center     Do not project an image with the lens cover of the projection lens  optional  attached   Doing so can cause fire     Do not allow metal objects  flammable objects  or liquids to enter inside of the projector  Do not allow  the projector to get wet   Doing so may cause short circuits or overheating  and result in fire  electric shock  or malfunction of the  projector    e Do not place containers of liquid or metal objects near the projector    e If liquid enters inside of the projector  consult your dealer    e Particular attention must be paid to child
245. r pin  2  to pin  8  settings  you can make changes if you set  REMOTE2 MODE  to  USER     page 122     ENGLISH   177    Chapter 6 Appendix     Technical information    m         m bination list                                                                                                            Sub window  RGB1 RGB2 VIDEO  RGB Movie 3 YIC input RGB Movie 3 input        v A4 A4        v A A        LA A    v  A4 V       j  v A A       A  A A     P4 A    v  A4 V v v V  v A A V A A  v y V y V v  A A A P4 A A  V A A v A A  A4 A A V A A    A     A  Sub window  EYED HDMI     Dual link  RGB  Movie  RGB  Movie  SEU Sp HD SDI 7  y A4 V y A4 v      v A V A A A      V A V A A A A  A4  A4 V A4  A4 V      A A V A A A      v A  4 A A A A        V y v                  y A A          v V           V      LA A         A    v A           A        V A  A                                       V  P IN P  picture in picture  combination is possible   A  P IN P  picture in picture  combination is possible through the same frequency      P IN P  picture in picture  combination is not possible    1 Only supports 480p  576p  720 60p  720 50p  1080 60i  1080 50i  1080 24sF  1080 24p  1080 25p  1080 30p  1080 50p  and 1080 60p    2 VGA  640 x 480    WUXGA  1 920 x 1 200   Non interlace signal  dot clock frequency  25 MHz to 162 MHz  The WUXGA signal is only compatible with VESA CVT RB  Reduced Blanking   signals      3 480i  480p  576i  576p  720 60p  720 50p  1080 60i  1080 50i  1080 24sF  1080 24
246. rection becomes 0   when  BRIGHTNESS CONTROL GAIN  is at 100        Luminance will be unsteady for eight minutes after a lamp is turned on  Make adjustments at least 8 minutes after starting projection      The result of  BRIGHTNESS CONTROL GAIN  adjustments is reflected on all image signals  internal test patterns  and on screen menus      The  BRIGHTNESS CONTROL GAIN  setting is enabled even if  BRIGHTNESS CONTROL SETUP  is  OFF      Setting  BRIGHTNESS CONTROL SETUP     Set brightness control operation   1  Press A V to select  BRIGHTNESS CONTROL      2  Press the   ENTER  button     The  BRIGHTNESS CONTROL  screen is displayed     3  Press A V to select  BRIGHTNESS CONTROL SETUP      112   ENGLISH    Chapter4 Settings      PROJECTOR SETUP  menu       4     5   6     7   8     9   10     11     12     13   14     15   16     Press the   ENTER  button   e The  BRIGHTNESS CONTROL SETUP  screen is displayed     Press A V to select  MODE      Press 4  to switch the item     The items will switch each time you press the button         OFF  Does not correct the brightness of the screen by the brightness sensor        Corrects the brightness of the screen by the brightness sensor      GREG  Automatically corrects screen brightness when lamp brightness changes         PC  Synchronizes nine or more projectors through a computer using the dedicated software  Multi             Projector Monitoring  amp  Control Software          1  Multi Projector Monitoring  amp  Control Software  i
247. reen flickers or outline blurs                 ENGLISH   93    Chapter 4 Settings      3D SETTINGS  menu           OFF  Hides the 3D waveform monitor    ON  Displays the 3D waveform monitor         3D WAVEFORM MONITOR                    Note    The  CLOCK PHASE  setting is enabled at simultaneous input of RGB1 and RGB2 to adjust the right eye image   This is disabled when  3D SYSTEM SETTING  is set to other than  SINGLE     This is disabled when  3D TEST PATTERN  is displayed    This is disabled when  3D TEST MODE  is set to other than  NORMAL  or  SIDE BY SIDE     The 3D waveform monitor is displayed only when the  3D PICTURE BALANCE  screen is displayed    The normal waveform monitor cannot be displayed in 3D images     Set the black display period to be displayed between the right eye image and the left eye image as necessary for the 3D system used     1  Press A V to select  DARK TIME SETTING    2  Press 4b to switch the item       The items will switch each time you press the button         0 5 ms    1 0 ms    1 5 ms    2 0 ms    2 5 ms    2 7 ms              Set so that the 3D setting is displayed correctly                       Note      This is disabled when  3D SYSTEM SETTING  is set to other than  SINGLE      When the setting does not correspond to the 3D system in use  phenomenon such as increased crosstalk and darkening of displayed  images may occur      SD FRAME DELAY                         Adjust the timing of the left right switch of an image   1  Press A V t
248. ren     Use the ceiling mount bracket specified by Panasonic   Using the ceiling mount bracket other than the specified one will result in falling accidents   e Attach the supplied safety cable to the ceiling mount bracket to prevent the projector from falling down     Installation work  such as ceiling mount bracket  should only be carried out by a qualified technician    If installation is not carried out and secured correctly it can cause injury or accidents  such as electric shocks    e Be sure to use the wire provided with the ceiling mount bracket as an extra safety measure to prevent the  projector from falling down   Install in a different location to the ceiling mount bracket         ENGLISH   5       Read this first           WARNING     B ACCESSORIES    Do not use or handle the batteries improperly  and refer to the following   Failure to observe this will cause burns  batteries to leak  overheat  explode or catch fire   e Use AA R6 batteries   e Do not use unspecified batteries   Do not use chargeable batteries   Do not disassemble dry cell batteries   Do not heat the batteries or place them into water or fire   Do not allow the   and     terminals of the batteries to come into contact with metallic objects such as  necklaces or hairpins   Do not store or carry batteries together with metallic objects   Store the batteries in a plastic bag and keep them away from metallic objects   Make sure the polarities    and      are correct when inserting the batteries   Do 
249. ress the    ENTER  button     5  Set  SUBNET MASK  and  IP ADDRESS  in each projector       To be able to communicate over the network  set the same value in  SUBNET MASK  for all projectors and set a different value in  IP  ADDRESS  for each projector     6  Wait for at least eight minutes after starting projection until the lamp brightness becomes steady   7  Setall items in the  PICTURE  menu of all projectors to the same values    8  Adjust  COLOR MATCHING  to match colors    9  Display the internal test pattern    All white  in all projectors    10  Set  BRIGHTNESS CONTROL GAIN  to 100   in all projectors    11  Set  BRIGHTNESS CONTROL GAIN  to 90   in the projector with the least brightness     12  Adjust  BRIGHTNESS CONTROL GAIN  in each projector       Adjust  BRIGHTNESS CONTROL GAIN  of all the other projectors so that the brightness is matched to the projector of which   BRIGHTNESS CONTROL GAIN  is set to 90 96     13  Set  MODE  of  BRIGHTNESS CONTROL SETUP  to  AUTO   and  LINK  to  GROUP A  in all projectors   14  Select  APPLY  of  BRIGHTNESS CONTROL SETUP  and press the   ENTER  button in all projectors       Brightness control starts     Note      Brightness is automatically corrected each time the lamp blinks when the power is switched on or off     Adjust brightness control again when variation in brightness has increased or a lamp is replaced      STANDBY MODE                           Set the power consumption during the standby   1  Press A V to select  S
250. rol contact control    Standby Lit  Lamp                      Installation locations in meeting rooms  etc  Remote control board in another location    Pin assignments and signal names                                     Poire qud Pin No  Signal name Open  H  Short  L    1  GND     GND   2  POWER OFF ON   5       1    3  RGB1 Other RGB1  x    4  RGB2 Other RGB2     TI     5  VIDEO Other VIDEO  O pees  e   6  HDMI Other HDMI  ES  7  DVI D Other DVI D   9      6   8  SHUTTER OFF ON   9  RST SET Controlled by remote   Controlled by external  control contact                         Attention      When controlling  make sure to short circuit pins  1  and  9       When pins  1  and  9  are short circuited  the following buttons on the control panel and the remote control cannot be used   The power on       button  the power standby  lt   gt  button  the  lt SHUTTER gt  button  and the RS 232C commands and network functions  corresponding to these functions cannot be used either      When pins  1  and  9  are short circuited  if any pins from  3  to  7  are short circuited with pin  1   the following buttons on the control panel  and the remote control cannot be used   The power on       button  the power standby   d   button   lt RGB1 gt  button   lt RGB2 gt  button   lt DVI D gt  button    VIDEO   button   lt HDMI gt   button    SDI 1 2   button    SHUTTER  button  and the RS 232C commands and network functions corresponding to these functions cannot  be used either     Note  e Fo
251. rs enclosed in  lt   gt  show the number of  accessories        Wireless wired remote control unit  lt 1 gt  CD ROM  lt 1 gt    N2QAYB000769   TXFQBO2VLF9           AAIR6 battery   2            Power cord   1       TXFSX01RGRZ   For remote control unit        Lens fixing screw   1     XYN4 J18FJ           S    Power cord  lt 1 gt    TXFSXO2RGRZ        Attention      After unpacking the projector  discard the power cord cap and packaging material properly     Do not use the supplied power cord for devices other than this projector      For missing accessories  consult your dealer       Store small parts in an appropriate manner  and keep them away from small children     Note    The model numbers of accessories are subject to change without prior notice     Contents of the supplied CD ROM    The contents of the supplied CD ROM are as follows                             Instruction list  PDF  Operating Instructions     Functional Manual  Multi Projector Monitoring  amp  Control Software Operating Instructions  Logo Transfer Software Operating Instructions  List of Compatible Projector   This is a list of projectors that are compatible with the software  Models contained in the CD ROM and their restrictions   Software license GNU GENERAL PUBLIC LICENSE  GNU LESSER GENERAL  PUBLIC LICENSE  Software Multi Projector Monitoring  amp    This software allows you to monitor and control multiple  Control Software  Windows    projectors connected to the LAN   Logo Transfer Software This 
252. s     1   Warning  2nd byte 0 2  e 2   Error  3rd byte Indicates temperature errors  and  returns 0   2   ERST  Error status query XXXXXX    Indicates cover open errors  and  4th byte  returns 0 or 2   5th byte Indicates filter errors  and returns  0 2   6th byte Indicates other errors  and returns  0 2   1st digits  1   5 digits   Lamp 1 runtime  2nd digit  0   Lamp 1 off  1   Lamp 1 on     LAMP  Lamp status query XXXXXXXXXXXX 3rd digits  1   5 digits   Lamp 2 runtime  Ath digit  0   Lamp 2 off  1   Lamp 2 on  11 12 21 31 32 33 34 Only for PT DZ13KE  PT DS12KE  INST  Input selection list query   11 12 21 31 32 Only for PT DW11KE  11 12 21 31 32 33 Only for PT DZ10KE  NAME  Projector name query     Returns the name set in  PROJECTOR NAME  of  NETWORK  SETUP    INF1  Manufacturername  Panasonic Returns manufacturer name   query  DZ13K  DS12K     INF2  Model name query DW11K Returns model name   DZ10K  INFO  er information XXXXX Returns information such as version number   queries  CLSS  Class information query   1 Returns class for PJLink                 ENGLISH   169    Chapter 6 Appendix     Technical information       PJLink security authentication    The password used for PJLink is the same as that of the password set for web control   When using the projector without security authentication  do not set a password for web control     For specifications related to PJLink  refer to the website of Japan Business Machine and Information System Industries Association     URL ht
253. s 4b to switch the item         OFF  Does not display the waveform monitor    ON  Displays the waveform monitor                    3  Press the   MENU  button two times to clear     4  Press A V to select any horizontal line     106   ENGLISH    Chapter 4 Settings      DISPLAY OPTION  menu       5  Press the   ENTER  button to switch the Select line to either luminance  red  green  or blue     Line selection items switch each time the   ENTER  is pressed only when the waveform monitor is displayed                       Select line  luminance     Displayed in white waveform      Select line  red     Displayed in red waveform      Select line  green     Displayed in green waveform      Select line  blue     Displayed in blue waveform              Note    e Setting is also available from  FUNCTION BUTTON   9 page 122       Waveform monitor cannot be displayed in  P IN P       The waveform monitor turns off when  P IN P  is executed during waveform monitoring      The waveform monitor is not displayed when on screen display is hidden  off       To display the waveform monitor in 3D images  use  3D WAVEFORM MONITOR    Only for PT DZ13KE  PT DS12KE  PT DW11KE     Adjusting the waveform    Project the luminance adjustment signal of a commercial test disk  0    0 IRE or 7 5 IRE      100    100 IRE   and adjust                 Image displayable area       Signal level                   X  Screen position    1  Select  Select line  luminance   on the waveform monitor     2  Adjust blac
254. s appliance may not correspond with the coloured markings  identifying the terminals in your plug  proceed as follows     The wire which is coloured GREEN   AND   YELLOW must be connected to the terminal in the    plug which is marked with the letter E or by the Earth symbol L or coloured GREEN or GREEN    AND   YELLOW     The wire which is coloured BLUE must be connected to the terminal in the plug which is marked  with the letter N or coloured BLACK     The wire which is coloured BROWN must be connected to the terminal in the plug which is marked  with the letter L or coloured RED     How to replace the fuse  Open the fuse compartment with a screwdriver and replace the fuse                 ENGLISH   3    Read this first           WARNING     E POWER    The wall outlet or the circuit breaker shall be installed near the equipment and shall be easily accessible  when problems occur  If the following problems occur  cut off the power supply immediately   Continued use of the projector in these conditions will result in fire or electric shock    e  f foreign objects or water get inside the projector  cut off the power supply    e  fthe projector is dropped or the cabinet is broken  cut off the power supply    e  f you notice smoke  strange smells or noise coming from the projector  cut off the power supply    Please contact an Authorized Service Center for repairs  and do not attempt to repair the projector yourself     During a thunderstorm  do not touch the projector or the ca
255. s displayed     3  Press A V to select  FADE IN  or  FADE OUT    4  Press 4b to switch the item              Item Adjustment   OFF  Does not set fade in or fade out    FADE IN  Allows you to set the fade in or fade out time    FADE OUT   0 5 s     10 0 s  Select an item from  0 5 s  to  4 0 s    5 0 s    7 0 s   and  10 0 s     0 5 s     4 0 s  can be selected in increments of 0 5                    Note    e Press the   SHUTTER  button on the remote control or the control panel during fade in or fade out to cancel the fade operation     Setting  STARTUP     1  Press A V to select  SHUTTER SETTING      2  Press the   ENTER  button     The  SHUTTER SETTING  screen is displayed     3  Press A V to select  STARTUP    4  Press 4b to switch the item         OPEN  Projection begins with the shutter open when the power is turned on    CLOSE  Projection begins with the shutter close when the power is turned on      FREEZE  yyy    Pause the projected image temporarily regardless of the playback of the external device                    1  Press A V to select  FREEZE      2  Press the   ENTER  button   e Press the   MENU  button to release     Note    e  FREEZE  is displayed on the screen when video is paused      WAVEFORM MONITOR  1 11    Use the input signals from a connected external device to display in a waveform  Check whether video output  luminance  signal level is within  the recommended range for the projector and adjust     1  Press A V to select  WAVEFORM MONITOR    2  Pres
256. s included in the supplied CD ROM     When  AUTO  is selected  proceed to Step 7      Press A V to select  LINK      Press 4P to switch the item     The items will switch each time you press the button           Performs corrections by the brightness sensor in one projector without synchronizing with the other   OFF  projectors   The period  in which the constant brightness kept by the small value of  BRIGHTNESS CONTROL  GAIN   is prolonged   ICROURAI Synchronizes corrections in multiple projectors by the brightness sensor    GROUP B  ae       GROUP C  You can set up to four groups  A to D  within the same subnet by using the network function    GROUP D  You can also register and synchronize up to eight projectors in one group                 Press A V to select  CALIBRATION TIME    Press the   ENTER  button       Enters adjustment mode  the display is blinking      Press 4P to select    hour    or    minute     and press A W or the number   lt 0 gt     lt 9 gt   buttons to set a  time     e Selecting    hour    allows setting of only the hour in increments of one hour  and selecting    minute    allows setting of only the minute in  increments of one minute between 00 and 59        f you do not specify the time  select  OFF  between 23 and 00 o clock or between 59 and 00 minutes     Press the   ENTER  button        CALIBRATION TIME  is set     Brightness is measured at the specified time  Dynamic iris is fixed to open during measurement     Press A V to select  CALIBRATION M
257. screen is displayed     L8 PICTURE       MENUSELECT  SUB MENU       2  Press A V to select an item from the main menu     The selected item is highlighted in yellow       MENU SELECT  SUB MENU       3  Press the   ENTER  button       The sub menu items of the selected main menu are displayed     POSITION  SHIFT  DEFAULT      MENU SELECT  SUB MENU       ENGLISH   65    Chapter 4 Settings     Menu navigation       4  Press A V to select a sub menu  and press        or the   ENTER   button to change or adjust settings      Some items will switch in order as follows each time you press q gt         Ls jle  c    LILL      I      For some items  press 4  to display an individual adjustment screen with a bar scale as shown below     CONTRAST EN E J     4 gt  ADJUST       Note    e Pressing the  lt MENU gt  button while the menu screen is displayed returns to the previous menu    e Some items may not be adjusted or used for certain signal formats to be input to the projector  The menu items that cannot be adjusted or  used are shown in gray characters  and they cannot be selected   DIGITAL CINEMA REALITY  and  FRAME LOCK  may not be displayed  depending on the input signal    Some items can be adjusted even if signals are not input    Individual adjustment screen is cleared automatically if no operation is performed for approximately five seconds    For menu items  refer to    Main menu    page 66  and  Sub menu   9 page 67     The cursor color depends on the settings of the  DISPLAY
258. shift operation  do not insert your hand in any opening around the lens   Your hand may be caught and result in injuries              Note    The zoom adjust menu will not be displayed when the projection lens without the zoom function is attached    Use the projection lens  Model No   ET D75LE5  ET D75LE50  with the lens position set to the home position    page 57    The adjustment can be performed faster by pressing and holding A Y 4P while adjusting the focus and shift    It is recommended that images be projected continuously for at least 30 minutes before the focus is adjusted    Only  FOCUS  is shown in yellow so that the displayed menu item can be recognized by color  even when the projector is not focused and   displayed characters are unreadable   Factory default    The display color of  FOCUS  depends on the setting of the  DISPLAY OPTION  menu      ON SCREEN DISPLAY      gt   OSD DESIGN       When the power is switched off during focus and shift adjustment  lens calibration needs to be performed the next time the power is  switched on    page 123      When the main power is switched off during focus adjustment  lens calibration is performed automatically during the next focus adjustment      When the main power is switched off during shift adjustment  a lens calibration error screen will be displayed during the next shift  adjustment  Execute the  PROJECTOR SETUP  menu      LENS CALIBRATION       When the lens calibration error is displayed even though  LENS CALIB
259. shing in red  consult your dealer        Install the projection lens before switching on the projector   Remove the lens cover first        POWER ON STANDBY    4                                                                                                                                          MAIN POWER  OFF ON    lo IJ    1  2  3     DVI D                            HDMI       Panasonic  PROJECTOR                                                                                  SDI 1 2                1  Connect the power cord to the projector body     2  Connect the power plug to an outlet      AC 220 V   240 V  50 Hz 60 Hz     3  Press the   ON    side of the   MAIN POWER  switch to turn on the power   e The power indicator   ON  G  STANDBY  R  gt  will light in red  and the projector will enter the standby mode     4  Press the power on       button     The power indicator   ON  G  STANDBY  R  gt  lights in green and the image is soon projected on the screen     Attention    Using the projector while the lens cover is attached may cause the device to heat up and result in a fire   Note    e  f the projector is switched on at around 0   C  32   F   a warm up period of approximately five minutes may be necessary until an image is  displayed    The temperature indicator   TEMP  lights during the warm up period  When the warm up is completed  the temperature indicator   TEMP    turns off and the projection starts  Refer to    When an indicator lights up    page 158  for th
260. software allows you to transfer original images  such as   Windows  company logos to be displayed when projection starts  to the  projector                 20   ENGLISH    Chapter1 Preparation     Precautions for use    Optional accessories   product name           Model No           zc lens ET D75LE6  ET D75LE8  ET D75LE10  ET D75LE20   Projection lens ET D75LE30  ET D75LE40  Fixed focus lens ET D75LE50          Ceiling Mount Bracketfor     ET_PKD310H  for High Ceilings   ET PKD310S  for Low Ceilings              Projectors   Projector ceiling mount ET PAD310   bracket   Projector Frame for ET PFD310   projectors   Replacement lamp unit ET LAD310A  1 pc   ET LAD310AW  2 pcs        Replacement lamp unit  for  portrait mode     Replacement Filter Unit ET EMF320  Smoke cut filter ET SFD320    Smoke cut filter   Replacement   Upgrade Kit ET UK20  only for PT DZ13KE  PT DS12KE     ET LAD320P  1 pc   ET LAD320PW  2 pcs              ET SFR320                   Note      The model numbers of optional accessories are subject to change without prior notice     ENGLISH   21    Chapter1 Preparation     Start up display       Start up display    When the projector is switched on for the first time after purchase  as well as when  ALL USER DATA  is executed from the  PROJECTOR  SETUP  menu  gt   INITIALIZE   the focus adjustment screen is displayed after projection starts  then the  INITIAL SETTING  screen is  displayed  Set them according to the circumstances     In other occasions  you 
261. splayed     3  Press A V to select  OSD MEMORY    4  Press 4b to switch the item       The items will switch each time you press the button            ON  Holds the cursor position              ENGLISH   103    Chapter 4 Settings      DISPLAY OPTION  menu                    OFF  Does not hold the cursor position        Note    e Even if  OSD MEMORY  is set to  ON   the cursor position will not be held when the   MAIN POWER  switch of the projector body is turned    OFF       Setting  INPUT GUIDE     Set whether to display the input guide  input terminal name  signal name  memory number  and  BACKUP INPUT STATUS  currently selected   in the position set in  OSD POSITION      1  Press A V to select  ON SCREEN DISPLAY      2  Press the  lt ENTER gt  button     The  ON SCREEN DISPLAY  screen is displayed     3  Press AY to select  INPUT GUIDE    4  Press 4b to switch the item       The items will switch each time you press the button         ON  Displays the input guide    OFF  Hides the input guide                    Setting  WARNING MESSAGE   Set the display hide of the warning message   1  Press A V to select  ON SCREEN DISPLAY      2  Press the   ENTER  button     The  ON SCREEN DISPLAY  screen is displayed     3  Press A V to select  WARNING MESSAGE    4  Press 4b to switch the item       The items will switch each time you press the button         ON  Displays the warning message    OFF  Hides the warning message      BACK COLOR      JJ  9 2 0    Set the display of the proj
262. ss A    to select a  COMMAND    e For  COMMAND  which requires detailed settings  the items of the detailed settings will switch each time you press q gt      12  Press the   ENTER  button       The command is fixed and   is displayed at the left of the selected command     After the command is fixed  press the   MENU  button to close the detailed setting screen     13  Press A V 4b to select  STORE   and press the   ENTER  button   Note       f you attempt to register the setting that would make the lamp turn on for a short time  an error message will be displayed on the screen   Set the time and command again      To delete a command already set  press the   DEFAULT  button on the Step 5  screen  or select  DELETE  on the Step 6  screen and press  the   ENTER  button       f multiple commands have been set for the same time  they are executed in chronological order starting from the smallest command  number      The operating time will be the local time    page 122    e  f an operation is executed with the remote control or control panel of the projector or with a control command before the command set in   SCHEDULE  is executed  the command set with this function may not be executed      STARTUP INPUT SELECT   gt     Set the input when the projector is switched on to start projection   1  Press A V to select  STARTUP INPUT SELECT    2  Press 4b to switch the item       The items will switch each time you press the button                  LAST USED  Keeps the input selected
263. ssing technology enables projection of a square image on a special screen shape     1  Press AY to select  GEOMETRY    2  Press 4b to switch the item       The items will switch each time you press the button                           OFF  Does not perform geometric adjustment    KEYSTONE  Adjusts any trapezoidal distortion in the projected image    CORNER CORRECTION    Adjusts any distortion in the four corners of the projected image    CURVED  Adjusts any curved distortion in the projected image        ENGLISH   81    Chapter4 Settings      POSITION  menu           PC 1          PC 2   Uses the computer to perform geometric adjustment               PC 3          1 Advanced skills are necessary to use a computer to control geometric adjustment  Consult your dealer  Up to three geometric adjustments    performed using the computer can be saved     Setting  KEYSTONE  or  CURVED     1   2   3     4   5     Press AY to select  GEOMETRY    Press 4P to select  KEYSTONE  or  CURVED    Press the   ENTER  button       The  GEOMETRY  KEYSTONE  or  GEOMETRY CURVED  screen is displayed     Press AY to select the item to adjust     Press q gt  to adjust            KEYSTONE    LENS THROW RATIO   Set the throw ratio for the lens used    VERTICAL KEYSTONE   HORIZONTAL KEYSTONE                          imu  111                 31     E SSS  Lt m   m                                                                                                                                                 
264. sss 126    P IN P  menu    neto rhe tede 127  Using P IN P function    127    TEST PATTERN  menu    129   TEST PATTERN     129    SIGNAL LIST  menu    130  Registering new signals    130  Renaming the registered signal    130  Deleting the registered signal    130  Protecting the registered signal                            131  Expanding signal lock in range    131  Sub memory                sss 132    SECURITY  menu    133   SECURITY PASSWORD     133   SECURITY PASSWORD CHANGE                      133   DISPLAY SETTING     134   TEXT CHANGE     nette tti 134   CONTROL DEVICE SETUP     134   CONTROL DEVICE PASSWORD CHANGE    T cm 135    NETWORK  menu    137   NETWORK SETUP     137   NETWORK CONTROL     137   NETWORK STATUS     sss 138   Ar  Net SE UP    e etre 138  Network connections    138  Accessing from the web browser                            140    ENGLISH   13    Contents       Lamp temperature filter indicators                           158  When an indicator lights up    158  Maintenance replacement                     ss 160  Before performing maintenance replacement       160  Maintenance  e 160  Replacing the unit    162  Troubleshooting    166  Chapter6 Appendix      gt           Technical information                     sssss 169  PJLink protocol         2    tette tede 169  Using Art Net function    170  Control commands via LAN    171    SERIAL IN gt   lt SERIAL OUT gt  terminal                   173   lt REMOTE 2 IN gt  terminal    177  Two window display 
265. stable feet                                                                   The positions of screw holes for ceiling mount and adjustable feet             Clearance  5 mm  3 16   or longer     Ensure the inflow of air into the air intake port  Otherwise  the projector may not work properly       The adjustable feet can be removed if not needed in the installation  However  do not use the screw holes where the  adjustable feet were removed to fix the projector in place   Also  do not install other screws in the screw holes of adjustable feet  Doing so may damage the projector   Note that the length of the front feet differ from that of the rear feet when attaching the removed adjustable feet  The ones  with a longer screw are for the front   Length of the screw for front feet  65 mm  2 9 16    length of the screw for rear feet   23 mm  29 32        Use the adjustable feet only for the floor standing installation and for adjusting the angle  Using them for other purposes may  damage the projector      Do not stack projectors on top of each other      Do not use the projector supporting it by the top    e Do not use the projector tilted at an angle that exceeds   15  from the horizontal plane      Do not block the ventilation ports  intake and exhaust  of the projector     ENGLISH   17    Chapter1 Preparation     Precautions for use         Prevent hot and cool air from the air conditioning system to blow directly to the ventilation ports  intake and exhaust  of the  projector
266. status is displayed   E      zi        DIXI ee     Projector Cont w    Projector status Network status Access error log Access log    DHCP OFF     IF ADDRESS  tatu    SUMNET MASK DEFAULT GATEWAY    Projector MAC ADDRESS  control    RATY Packets ine    Detailed  setup    Change  password        Access error log  page    Click  Status       Access error log      The error log on the web server is displayed such as access to the pages that do not exist or access with unauthorized user names or  passwords     TEUDUTYT    m   7  LE   CTS eee B  BOR  donee com mao    a     Projector Control Window    Projector status Network status Access log    Status    Projector  control    Detailed  set up    Change  password                 Access log  page    Click  Status       Access log      The log such as user name accessed to the WEB control page  accessed IP address  accessed time is displayed        Projecte rol Window    Projector status Network status Access error log Access log    Status  Projector  control    Detailed  set up    Change  password    Note       Access error log   Access log  will display the recent few thousand accesses requests  All information may not be displayed when many  accesses requests are made at one time       When  Access error log   Access log  exceeds a certain amount  old information will be deleted     Check  Access error log   Access log  periodically     144   ENGLISH    Chapter 4 Settings      NETWORK  menu        Basic control  page    Click  Pro
267. switched  the cutoff setting returns to its original setting  off      108   ENGLISH    Chapter4 Settings      PROJECTOR SETUP  menu        PROJECTOR SETUP  menu          On the menu screen  select  PROJECTOR SETUP  from the main menu  and select an item  from the sub menu    Refer to    Navigating through the menu    page 65  for the operation of the menu screen   e After selecting the item  press A V   b to set                 The projector has an ID number setting function that can be used when multiple projectors are used side by side to enable simultaneous  control or individual control via a single remote control     1  Press A V to select  PROJECTOR ID    2  Press 4b to switch the item       The items will switch each time you press the button      ALL  Select when controlling projectors without specifying an ID number               1     64  Select when specifying an ID number to control individual projector           Note      To specify an ID number for individual control  the ID number of a remote control must match the ID number of the projector      When the ID number is set to  ALL   the projector will operate regardless of the ID number specified during remote control or computer  control   If multiple projectors are set up side by side with IDs set to  ALL   they cannot be controlled separately from the projectors with other ID  numbers    e Refer to    Setting the remote control ID numbers    page 28  for how to set the ID number on the remote control      PR
268. t by the handle because its surface is pointed and its shape is protruded      The lamp contains mercury  When disposing of used lamp units  contact your local authorities or dealer for correct methods of disposal     Attention      Panasonic takes no responsibility for any damage or malfunction of the product resulting from use of lamp units which are not manufactured  by Panasonic  Use only specified lamp units    e For the portrait setting  be sure to use the optional Replacement lamp unit  for portrait mode       Do not use the Replacement lamp unit  for portrait mode  and normal lamp unit together      Use the Replacement lamp unit  for portrait mode  only when installing the projector in the portrait setting     162   ENGLISH    Chapter 5 Maintenance     Maintenance replacement       Note      The model numbers of accessories and optional accessories are subject to change without prior notice     When to replace the lamp unit    The lamp unit is a consumable component  Since its brightness gradually decreases over time  it is necessary to replace the lamp unit  regularly  The estimated duration before replacement is 2 500 hours     but the lamp may go off before 2 500 hours   has elapsed depending  on individual lamp characteristics  usage conditions  and the installation environment  It is recommended that the Replacement lamp unit be  prepared earlier     If you continue to use the lamp unit after 2 500 hours   has elapsed  the lamp turns off automatically after appro
269. t remove cover  No user serviceable parts inside  Refer servicing to qualified  service personnel    3  Do not remove the earthing pin on the mains plug  This apparatus is equipped with a three prong  earthingtype mains plug  This plug will only fit an earthing type mains socket  This is a safety feature  If you  are unable to insert the plug into the mains socket  contact an electrician  Do not defeat the purpose of the  earthing plug           WARNING   This is a class A product  In a domestic environment this product may cause radio interference in which case  the user may be required to take adequate measures           CAUTION  To assure continued compliance  follow the attached installation instructions  which include  using the provided power cord and shielded interface cables when connecting to computer or  peripheral device  If you use serial port to connect PC for external control of projector  you must  use a commercial RS 232C serial interface cable with ferrite core  Any unauthorized changes or   modifications to this equipment will void the user   s authority to operate        This is a device to project images onto a screen  etc   and is not intended for use as indoor lighting in a  domestic environment   Directive 2009 125 EC          Importer s name and address within the European Union  Panasonic Marketing Europe GmbH   Panasonic Testing Center   Winsbergring 15  22525 Hamburg  Germany             Product information  for Turkey only        EEE Y  netmeli  in
270. tend the life of the lamps by setting to  MIDDLE  rather than  HIGH   or by  setting to  ECO  rather than  MIDDLE  or  NORMAL       BRIGHTNESS CONTROL      1    The projector is equipped with a luminance sensor to measure brightness and functions to correct screen brightness resulting from changes in  lamp brightness    Use the projector when using multiple projectors to display on multiple screens to reduce changes in overall brightness of the multiple screens  due to lamp degradation and suppress variation in brightness to preserve uniformity     Setting  BRIGHTNESS CONTROL GAIN   Adjust the brightness when displaying multiple screens using multiple projectors   1  Press A V to select  BRIGHTNESS CONTROL      2  Press the   ENTER  button     The  BRIGHTNESS CONTROL  screen is displayed     3  Press A V to select  BRIGHTNESS CONTROL GAIN    4  Press 4b to adjust                                Adjustment  Operation E Maximum amount of Range of adjustment  Brightness E    brightness correction   Press the  gt  button  The screen becomes brighter  TRE maximum amountor   correction is reduced    Th   to 20     100    Press the     button  The screen becomes darker  li maximum AMOUNT   correction is increased        Note      When using only one projector  the value obtained by subtracting the value of the  BRIGHTNESS CONTROL GAIN  from 100   is the  maximum amount of brightness correction  Brightness cannot be corrected through brightness control since the maximum amount of  cor
271. the   ENTER    button     The  TINT  individual adjustment screen is displayed       Press 4b to adjust the level     C       Operation Adjustment    Range of adjustment       Press the  gt  button  Adjusts skin tone toward greenish color              Press the     button  Adjusts skin tone toward reddish purple         31    31       You can switch the color temperature if the white areas of the projected image are bluish or reddish     Adjusting with color temperature    1  Press AY to select  COLOR TEMPERATURE      72   ENGLISH                Chapter 4 Settings      PICTURE  menu       2  Press q gt  or the   ENTER    button     The  COLOR TEMPERATURE  individual adjustment screen is displayed     3  Press 4b to switch the item       The items will switch each time you press the button                           DEFAULT  Factory default setting    USER1  Adjusts white balance as desired  Refer to    Adjusting desired white balance       page 73  for   USER2  details    3200K     9300K  Allows you to set in increments of 100 K  Select so that images become natural        Note    e When  PICTURE MODE    page 71  is set to  USER  or  DICOM SIM     DEFAULT  cannot be selected   e When  COLOR MATCHING    page 96  adjustment is set to other than  OFF    COLOR TEMPERATURE  is fixed to  USER1      The color temperature numerical values are guidelines     Adjusting desired white balance    1  Press A V to select  COLOR TEMPERATURE      2  Press 4b or the   ENTER    button     The  C
272. tion lens   Attention      Turn the projection lens counterclockwise to confirm that it does not come out     Store the removed dust sponge in a safe place to transport or store        Remove the projection lens using the following procedure                             Lock button    1  Remove the lens fixing screw     Use a Phillips screwdriver to remove the first screw to the right of the projection lens mark  orange      2  While pressing the lock button  turn the projection lens counterclockwise to remove     Turn counterclockwise until the projection lens mark  orange  is at the mark on the projector body  O to the left of LOCK      Note    e Some lenses may not have a screw hole to use to secure the projection lens     46   ENGLISH    Chapter 2 Getting Started     Attaching removing the projection lens  optional        Attention      Store the removed projection lens where it will be free from vibration and impact     Store the removed lens fixing screw in a safe place     ENGLISH   47    Chapter 2 Getting Started     Connecting       Connecting  Before connecting                            7      Before connecting  carefully read the operating instructions for the external device to be connected   Turn off the power of all devices before connecting cables     Take note of the following points before connecting the cables  Failure to do so may result in malfunctions      When connecting a cable to a device connected to the projector or the projector itself  touch any ne
273. to replace the lamp installed  A problem is detected in the lamp or the power supply for  Status     F  unit    page 163  e The unspecified lamp unit   the lamp   is installed   e Was  REPLACE LAMP   displayed when you  turned on the power     The indicator lights up         Have you turned on the    Some eed nas occurred  Cause ahente runtime orhe e  s the specified lamp unit power again immediately in the lamp circuit  Check    installed  ae  for fluctuation  or drop  in  lamp unit has reached after turning it off  the source voltage   2 300 hours  when   LAMP POWER  is set to   HIGH     3      nstall the lamp unit if it is  not installed   e Install the specified lamp     Wait a while until the   Turn the   MAIN POWER     Solution    Replace the lamp unit unit  luminous lamp cools Switch to   OFF     f e  f the indicator is still off  and then turn on the     page 55   and  flashing in red even when power  consult your dealer   having installed the lamp  unit  consult your dealer                     1 The indicator lights up in red while the lamp is turned off  and lights up in orange while the lamp is turned on     2 For PT DZ13KE  PT DS12KE  PT DW11KE  3 300 hours  when  LAMP POWER  is set to  NORMAL   for PT DZ10KE     3 300 hours when using the optional Replacement lamp unit  for portrait mode   Model No   ET LAD320P  1 pc   ET LAD320PW  2 pcs    when   LAMP POWER  is set to  MIDDLE  or  NORMAL      Note    e  f the lamp indicators  lt LAMP1 gt   lt LAMP2 gt  are still
274. tp   pjlink jbmia or jp english     Since the network function of the projector supports the Art Net function  you can control the projector settings with the DMX controller or  application software using the Art Net protocol     Channel definition    The following table lists the channel definitions used for controlling the projector with the Art Net function                                                                                                                                            Channel Control details Performance Parameter Initial value Remark  100   0  1 Light volume 0 Can be set in 256 steps  adjustment         between 100   and 0     0  255  No operation 0 7  RGB1 8 15  RGB2 16 23  DVI D 24 31  HDMI 32 39  No operation 40 47  SDI1  only for PT DZ13KE  48 55  2 Input selection PT DS12KE  PT DZ10KE  0      SDI2  only for PT DZ13KE   PT DS12KE  3063  No operation 64 127  Execute P IN P  USER1 128 135  Execute P IN P  USER2 136 143  Execute P IN P  USER3 144 151  No operation 152 255  No operation 0 31  Move to the home position 32 63  us Move to  1 LENS MEMORY1    64 95  3 Lens position 0      Move to  2 LENS MEMORY2    96 127  Move to  3 LENS MEMORY3  128 159  No operation 160 191     High speed   0 31  4 Lens H shift See  Lens     Low speed   32 63  adjustment      Fi  l i oe 64 95  5 Lens V shift adjustment  Adjustment stop 96 159 128      FS 160 191  6 Lens focus Lens adjustment  adjustment     Low speed   192 223  7 Lens zoom     High speed   224 255  
275. ttach the projection lens   optional     9 page 46     3  Connect with external devices    9 page 48     4  Connect the power cord    9 page 52     5  Switch on the projector    9 page 53     6  Makeinitial settings     gt  page 22       Take this step when you switch on the power for the  first time after purchasing the projector     7  Select the input signal    9 page 56     8  Adjust the image    9 page 56     ENGLISH   11    Contents       Contents   Ieackthis firetl EE 2   Chapter1 Preparation   Precautions for use    16  Cautions when transporting    16  Cautions when installing    16  SEG  N nied  niece teet eie dete o mes 18  AN Net stet sedet tet ds 18  Disposal  aeter etie EUER dtum  18  Cautions on use    18  Software information regarding this product            19  Accessories             sssssssssssssseeeenee 20  Optional accessories    21   Start up display                sssssssssssssss 22  Focus adjustment    22  Initial setting  display language     22  Initial setting  installation setting         0  00 23  Initial setting  screen setting     23   About your projector    24  Remote control    24  Projector body    cett tede 25   Using the remote control    28  Inserting and removing the batteries                          28  Setting the remote control ID numbers                     28  Connecting to the projector with a cable                   29    Chapter2 Getting Started    Setting Up    eet nre etes 31  Installation mode    31  Parts for ceiling mount 
276. ure aspect ratio    63    Chapter 4 Settings    Menu navigation    65  Navigating through the menu    65  Maii MENU jesse o p dee o Por od d tate nba 66  Sub menu            ssssssssssssssssssseeeeneeees 67    PICTURE  menu    71   PICTURE MODE  eesti oda eee 71   CONTRAST  eta cotta teet e etras 71   BRIGHTNESS  reet ttes 72   COLEOR     5  5 orb teret esiti 72   TNT  iiiter rrt t Be hatte et 72   COLOR TEMPERATURE     sss 72   GAMMA   triti tette e e He 74   SYSTEM DAYLIGHT VIEW     75   SHARPNESS   eee tret tret ieee 75   NOISE REDUCTION     76   DYNAMIC IRIS     76   SYSTEM SELECTOR     TT  SRGB compliant video    sss 78    Contents        POSITION  men                  emet eso 79  PSTD T E shoeet oes ti casera ea beanonecseel ech ontsths hateaelneniee 79   ASPECT     onn te ente ted ise 79   ZOOM   niri ett iet Petite 80   CLOCK PHASE   e d enr ee etes 81  IGEOMETRY s oie o etos ep ete 81   KEXSTONE etna s 84    ADVANCED MENU  menu    85   DIGITAL CINEMA REALI  Y  85   BLANKING            sssssssssseees 85   INPUT RESOLUTION     86   CLAMP POSITION     86   EDGE BLENDING              ss 87   FRAME RESPONSE     88   FRAME LOCK  rete epi 89   RASTER POSITION     89    DISPLAY LANGUAGE  menu sss 90  Changing the display language    90    3D SETTINGS  menu    sss 91   3D SYSTEM SETTING     91   3D SYNC SETTING     91   BD SIMUL INPUT SETTING     92  I3D INPUT FORMAT     etes 92   LEFT RIGHT SWAP   t t eene 93   3D COLOR MATCHING                e 93   3D PICTURE BALANCE     
277. using the projector  at high altitudes between  1 400 m  4 593   or higher  and lower than 2 700 m    Remove any objects that  9 898   above sealevel     Clean or replace the air set  HIGH ALTITUDE      are blocking the air intake   filter unit    page 160  MODE   9 page 110  to  exhaust port   ON      Solution   Attach the air filter unit       Do not use the projector  at high altitudes of  2 700 m  8 858   or higher  above sea level                       Note    e  f the filter indicator   FILTER  is still lit or flashing after taking the preceding measures  ask your dealer for repair   e  f the filter is clogged  only one lamp may light even when  LAMP SELECT  is set to  DUAL   By cleaning the air filter unit or replacing it with  a new one  the lamp will light properly     ENGLISH   159    Chapter 5 Maintenance     Maintenance replacement       Maintenance replacement  Bef formi Gi    e Make sure to turn off the power before maintaining or replacing the unit    pages 52  55     When switching off the projector  make sure to follow the procedures in  Switching off the projector      page 55      Maintenance        2 DL D                     Outer case       Wipe off dirt and dust with a soft  dry cloth    e If the dirt is persistent  soak the cloth with water and wring it thoroughly before wiping  Dry off the projector with a dry cloth      Do not use benzene  thinner  or rubbing alcohol  other solvents  or household cleaners  Doing so may deteriorate the outer case     W
278. which contains nearly the same amount of mercury as fluorescent lamps  and the broken pieces will cause  injury    e  f you believe that you have absorbed the gas or that the gas has got into your eyes or mouth  seek medical   advice immediately   e Ask your dealer about replacing the lamp unit and check the inside of the projector     When not using the projector for an extended period of time  remove the batteries from the remote  control    Failure to observe this will cause the batteries to leak  overheat  catch fire or explode  which may result in fire  or contamination of surrounding area        ENGLISH   7       Read this first           CAUTION     B MAINTENANCE    Do not attach the air filter unit while it is wet   Doing so may result in electric shock or malfunctions   e After you clean the air filter units  dry them thoroughly before reattaching them     Do not touch the fan with your fingers or any other parts of your body when replacing the lamp unit   Doing so can cause injury     Ask your dealer about cleaning inside the projector once a year   Continuous use while dust is accumulated inside the projector may result in fire   e For cleaning fee  ask your dealer     B VIEWING 3D VIDEO  PT DZ13KE  PT DS12KE  and PT DW11KE only     Those with a medical history of oversensitivity to light  heart problems  or poor physical health should  not view 3D images   This may lead to a worsening of medical conditions     If you feel tiredness or discomfort  or other abnormal
279. xample  192 168 0 254     Back   Next    Click the  Back  button to return to the original screen  The  current settings are displayed by pressing the  Next  button   Click the  Submit  button to update the settings       When you use the  Forward  and  Back  functions of your browser  a warning message    Page has Expired    may appear  In that case  click     Network config  again since the following operation will not be guaranteed       Changing LAN settings while connected to the LAN may cause the connection to cut out     146   ENGLISH    Chapter 4 Settings      NETWORK  menu        Adjust clock  page    Click  Detailed set up       Adjust clock      rec ILIA op in muen ngii pagis TIE STR e Pa ROKI giur arti venim                                                                        Sae k GMT  09 00   1  2  3  l4  I 5  l 6  7  1  Time Zone  5  Date   Select the time zone  Enter the date to be changed   2  Set time zone  6  Time   Updates the time zone setting  Enter the time to be changed   3  NTP SYNCHRONIZATION  7  Set date and time   Set to  ON  to adjust the date and time automatically  Updates the date and time settings     4  NTP SERVER NAME   Enter the IP address or server name of the NTP server when  you set to adjust the date and time manually    To enter the server name  the DNS server needs to be set up      Note      The replacement of the battery inside the projector is required when the time goes out of alignment right after correcting the time  Consult  
280. ximately 10 minutes  as it will  cause malfunction of the projector     If the runtime of both of two lamp unit bulbs exceeds 2 500 hours   the power will be switch off after approximately 10 minutes        On screen display Lamp indicator       REPLACE LAMP Se Ne  GR Lame FJ       The message is displayed for 30 seconds  Pressing             Over 2 300 hours 2 any button on the control panel or remote control            within 30 seconds will clear the message  Sm lights in red even during the standby  z      mode   Over 2 500 hours   odd ed remains displayed until you press any        1 ForPT DZ13KE  PT DS12KE  PT DW11KE  3 500 hours for PT DZ10KE    2 ForPT DZ13KE  PT DS12KE  PT DW11KE  3 300 hours for PT DZ10KE     Note      To predict when to replace the lamp  check the lamp runtime displayed in  LAMP 1  and  LAMP2  in  STATUS    page 120      2 500 hours and 3 500 hours are estimated duration before replacement  and is not guaranteed       The estimated duration before replacing the Replacement lamp unit  for portrait mode  is 500 hours  The on screen message for replacing  the lamp appears after 300 hours     ENGLISH   163       Chapter 5 Maintenance     Maintenance replacement          How to replace the lamp unit    Attention    1     2     3     4     When the projector is mounted on the ceiling  do not conduct work while your face is near the lamp unit   Do not remove or loosen the screws other than specified ones when replacing the lamp unit    Use same type of la
281. y Sereop Built in test patterns are not displayed                 Note      Press the   ON SCREEN  button on the remote control while the test pattern is displayed to hide the menu screen     Changing color or a focus test pattern    When the    Menu Screen   Focus    test pattern is displayed  the color can be changed   1  Press   b to select the    Menu Screen   Focus  test pattern     2  Press the   ENTER  button     The  TEST PATTERN COLOR  screen is displayed     3  Press AY to select a color  and press the   ENTER  button     The test pattern color changed to the color selected     Note      The test pattern color settings return to  WHITE  when the projector is switched off     Colors of the test patterns other than focus test patterns cannot be changed     ENGLISH   129    Chapter 4 Settings      SIGNAL LIST  menu     SIGNAL LIST  menu    On the menu screen  select  SIGNAL LIST  from the main menu   Refer to    Navigating through the menu    page 65  for the operation of the menu screen                                  B Registered signal details    Memory number  A1  1 2     Sub memory number    When the address number  A1  A2      L7  L8  signal is registered      Aname can be set for each sub memory  9 page 132         After a new signal is input and the   MENU  button on the remote control or the control panel is pressed  the registration is completed and the   MAIN MENU  screen is displayed     Note      Up to 96 signals  including sub memories  can be registered
282. y or horizontally if the image position projected on the screen is shifted even when the relative position of the    projector and the screen is installed correctly     1  Press A V to select  SHIFT      2  Press the   ENTER  button     The  SHIFT  screen is displayed     3  Press A W 4b to adjust the position        Orientation    Operation    Adjustment       Vertical  up and down   adjustment    Press the A  button     The image position moves up        Press the W button     The image position moves down           Horizontal  right and left   adjustment       Note    Press the  gt  button     The image position moves to the right           Press the 4 button        The image position moves to the left        e For the portrait setting  image position is moved horizontally when    Vertical  up and down  adjustment    is made  Image position is moved  vertically when  Horizontal  right and left  adjustment  is made        You can switch the aspect ratio of the image   The aspect ratio is switched within the screen range selected in  SCREEN SETTING   Set  SCREEN SETTING  first    page 97     1  Press A V to select  ASPECT      2  Press 4b or the   ENTER    button     The  ASPECT  individual adjustment screen is displayed     3  Press 4b to switch the item       The items will switch each time you press the button     ENGLISH   79       Chapter4 Settings      POSITION  menu                       DEFAULT  Displays images without changing the aspect ratio of the input signals  
283. you press the button         OFF  Sets the edge blending function to off    ON  Use the setting value of the internal distortion of the set for the inclination of the edge blending area     Use the user setting value for the inclination of the edge blending area   Configuration registration  requires separate software  Consult your dealer                      USER          To adjust edge blending  proceed to Step 3      3  When  ON  or  USER  is selected  press the   ENTER  button     The  EDGE BLENDING  screen is displayed     4  Press A V to specify the location to be corrected     When joining at top  Set  UPPER  to  ON     When joining at bottom  Set  LOWER  to  ON     When joining at left  Set  LEFT  to  ON    When joining at right  Set  RIGHT  to  ON     5  Press 4b to switch between  ON  and  OFF      6  Press AY to select  START  and  WIDTH     7  Press 4b to adjust the starting position and correction width   8  Press A V to select  MARKER     9  Press 4b to switch to  ON        A marker for image position adjustment is displayed  The position where the red and green lines overlap for the projectors to be joined  will be the optimal point  Make sure to set the correction width for the projectors to be joined with the same value  Optimal joining is not  possible with projectors that have different correction widths     The opti overlap        10  Press A V to select  BRIGHTNESS ADJUST      11  Press the   ENTER  button       The  BRIGHTNESS ADJUST  screen is displayed
284. you use the projector without attaching the air filter unit  the filter indicator   FILTER  flashes in red and the message appears on the  projection screen for approximately 30 seconds     Note      The replacement cycle of the air filter unit varies greatly depending on the usage environment   Lamp unit    The lamp unit is a consumable component  Refer to  When to replace the lamp unit       page 163  for details about the replacement cycle   When purchasing the optional Replacement lamp unit  Model No   ET LAD310A  1 pc   ET LAD310AW  2 pcs   or the Replacement lamp unit   for portrait mode   Model No   ET LAD320P  1 pc   ET LAD320PW  2 pcs    consult your dealer     It is recommended that you request a qualified technician to replace the lamp unit  Consult your dealer        Warning       Replace the lamp unit after the lamp has cooled  after waiting at least one hour    The high temperature inside the cover will cause burns              Checking the lamp unit to be replaced    1  Check the status of the lamp indicators  lt LAMP1 gt   lt LAMP2 gt        The lamp unit corresponding to the lamp indicator that is lit in red is required to be replaced     Notes on the replacement of the lamp unit    e A Phillips screwdriver is necessary when replacing the lamp unit     Since the luminous lamp is made of glass  it may burst if dropped or hit with a hard object  Handle with care      Do not disassemble or modify the lamp unit      When replacing the lamp unit  be sure to hold i
285. your dealer      Ping test  page    Check whether the network is connected to the mail server  POP server  DNS server  etc   Click  Detailed set up       Ping test                                       PER  pent cage PRG ete el Be BOX  2c omonmi     PING 192 168 10 218  192 168 10 218   56 data bytes  64 bytes from 192 168 10 218  seq 0 tt  128 time 1 228 ms  64 bytes from 192 168 10 218  seq 1 ttl 128 time 0 942 ms  64 bytes from 192 168 10 218  seq 2 tt  128 time 0 854 ms  r1 64 bytes from 192 168 10 216  seq 3 ttl 128 time 0 962 ms     3  l    Submit    2     192 168 10 218 ping statistics       4 packets transmitted  4 packets received  0  packet loss  round trip min avg max   0 854 0 998 1 228 ms  PING 182 168 10 217  192 168 10 217   5B data bytes      182 188 10 217 ping statistics     MM  4 packets transmitted  0 packets received  100  packet loss   1  Input IP address  3 Example of display when the connection has succeeded   Enter the IP address of the server to be tested  4 Example of display when the connection has failed  2  Submit     Executes the connection test     ENGLISH   147    Chapter 4 Settings      NETWORK  menu        E mail set up  page    When there is a problem or the runtime of a lamp reaches a set value  an E mail can be sent to preset E mail addresses  up to two    addresses    Click  Detailed set up       E mail set up      Elms  m em ee eed    D 806X   2v antro mim          1          2             AO                5  6          1  ENABLE   Sel
286. ys the error status   4  Power Status  8  Exit   Displays the status of the power  Returns to the control page    Help  page    Click  Help  on the control page   The  Help Desk  window is displayed     ei  ae   Pr Sox  2 Crestron omen Con                         1  Help Desk   Send receive messages to from an administrator who uses  Crestron RoomView     156   ENGLISH    Chapter5 Maintenance       This chapter describes methods of inspection when there are problems  maintenance  and replacement of the units     ENGLISH   157    Chapter 5 Maintenance     Lamp temperature filter indicators       Lamp temperature filter indicators          If a problem should occur inside the projector  the lamp indicators  lt LAMP1 gt   lt LAMP2 gt   the temperature indicator  lt TEMP gt   and the filter  indicator   FILTER  will inform you by lighting or flashing  Check the status of the indicators and manage the indicated problems as follows     Attention      When switching off the projector to deal with problems  make sure to follow the procedure in    Switching off the projector       page 55    Lamp indicator  lt LAMP1 gt              Lamp indicator  lt LAMP2 gt     Temperature indicator   TEMP      oNG  amf Eve  STANDBY  R            FILTER       Filter indicator   FILTER               7     Lamp indicators  lt LAMP1 gt   lt LAMP2 gt                    indicator statis Lighting in red lighting in Flashing in red Flashing in red  orange    1 time   3 times     The lamp unit is not  Time 
    
Download Pdf Manuals
 
 
    
Related Search
    
Related Contents
mo Installation manual Model: Suzuki Jimny  10ft Round Offset Umbrella with T Base  Renseignements pour patients (télécharger PDF, 233KB)  LABORATORIO MECATRONICA  M2 Simulator Model  BB-View Cape    MANUAL DE INSTRUCCIONES 2013 85 SX 19/16 85 SX 17/14  Mini Modbus 1TE  Pocket Manual    Copyright © All rights reserved. 
   Failed to retrieve file